Yamaha RX-A820 de handleiding

Categorie
AV-ontvangers
Type
de handleiding
English
Read the supplied booklet “Safety Brochure” before using the unit.
AV Receiver
Owner’s Manual
En 2
CONTENTS
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
FEATURES 6
What you can do with the unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Part names and functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Front display (indicators) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
PREPARATIONS 12
General setup procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1 Placing speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
2 Connecting speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Input/output jacks and cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
3 Connecting a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4 Connecting playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Connecting to the jacks on the front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
5 Connecting the FM/AM antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
6 Connecting to a network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
7 Connecting other devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Connecting an external power amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Connecting recording devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Connecting a device that supports SCENE link playback (remote connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
8 Connecting the power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
9 Selecting an on-screen menu language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
10 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) . . . . . . . . . 35
Measuring at one listening position (single measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Checking the measurement results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Warning messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
PLAYBACK 43
Basic playback procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Selecting an HDMI output jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch
(SCENE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Configuring scene assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Selecting the sound mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Enjoying unprocessed playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Listening to FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Setting the frequency steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Selecting a frequency for reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Registering favorite radio stations (presets) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Radio Data System tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Operating the radio on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
En 3
Playing back iPod music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Connecting an iPod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Playback of iPod content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Connecting a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Playback of USB storage device contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Media sharing setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Playback of PC music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Listening to Internet radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Preparing Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Controlling Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Viewing the current status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Switching information on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Viewing the status information on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Configuring playback settings for different playback sources
(Option menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Option menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
CONFIGURATIONS 78
Configuring input sources (Input menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Input menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Scene menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Configuring sound programs/surround decoders
(Sound Program menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Sound Program menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Configuring various functions (Setup menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Setup menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Speaker (Manual Setup) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Multi Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
ECO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) . . . . . . . . . 100
Types of information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) . . . . . . 102
ADVANCED SETUP menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Changing the speaker impedance setting (SP IMP.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MON.CHK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Restoring the default settings (INIT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Updating the firmware (UPDATE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Checking the firmware version (VERSION) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Controlling external devices with the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Registering the remote control code for a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Registering the remote control codes for playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Programming from other remote controls (learning) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Clearing functions learned from other remote controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Resetting remote control codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Updating the unit’s firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
En 4
APPENDIX 111
Frequently asked questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Power and system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
USB and network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Error indications on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Ideal speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Audio information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
HDMI and video information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Yamaha technologies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Video signal flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Information on HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
HDMI Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
HDMI signal compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Reference diagram (rear panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Accessories En 5
Accessories
Check that the following accessories are supplied with the product.
Remote control Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) (x2)
AM antenna FM antenna
*One of the above is supplied depending on the region of
purchase.
YPAO microphone Power cable
*The supplied power cable varies depending on the region
of purchase.
CD-ROM
(Owner’s Manual)
Easy Setup Guide Safety Brochure
Insert the batteries the right
way round.
Operating range of the remote control
Point the remote control at the remote control sensor on the unit and remain within the operating range
shown below.
The illustrations of the main unit and remote control used in this manual are of the U.S.A. model,
unless otherwise specified.
Some features are not available in certain regions.
Due to product improvements, specifications and appearance are subject to change without notice.
This manual explains operations using the supplied remote control.
This manual describes all the “iPod”, “iPhone” and “iPad” as the “iPod”. “iPod” refers to “iPod”, “iPhone”
and “iPad”, unless otherwise specified.
indicates precautions for use of the unit and its feature limitations.
indicates supplementary explanations for better use.
30° 30°
Within
6 m (20 ft)
FEATURES What you can do with the unit En 6
FEATURES
What you can do with the unit
Speakers
BD/DVD player
HDMI Control
Audio/Video
The unit’s
remote control
TV remote control
Audio
HDMI Control
Audio
Video
TV
Sequential operation of a TV,
AV receiver, and BD/DVD
player (HDMI Control)
. p.123
Supports 2- to 7.1-channel (plus presence)
speaker system. Allows you to enjoy your favorite
acoustic spaces in various styles.
• Automatically optimizing the speaker
settings to suit your room (YPAO)
. p.35
• Reproducing stereo or multichannel
sounds with the sound fields like
actual movie theaters and concert halls
(CINEMA DSP)
. p.46
• Enjoying compressed music with
enhanced sound (Compressed Music
Enhancer)
. p.50
• Playing back music in multiple rooms
(multi-zone)
. p.70
Operating external
devices with the supplied
remote control
. p.105
iPod/iPhone/iPad
USB device
Audio
Network contents
Wide variety of supported content
• iPod/iPhone/iPad
. p.56
•USB
. p.60
• Media server (PC/NAS)
. p.63
• Internet radio
. p.66
•AirPlay
. p.68
3D and 4K signals supported
AV receiver (the unit)
Change the input source and favorite
settings with one touch (SCENE)
. p.44
FEATURES What you can do with the unit En 7
Full of useful functions!
Connecting various devices (p.26)
A number of HDMI jacks and various input/output jacks
on the unit allow you to connect video devices (such as
BD/DVD players), audio devices (such as CD players),
game consoles, camcorders, and other devices.
Playing back TV audio in surround sound
with a single HDMI cable connection
(Audio Return Channel: ARC) (p.21)
When using an ARC -compatible TV, you only need one
HDMI cable to enable video output to the TV, audio
input from the TV, and the transmission of HDMI Control
signals.
Creating 3-dimensional sound fields (p.46)
Connecting presence speakers allows you to create a
natural 3-dimensional sound field in your own room
(CINEMA DSP 3D). Even when no presence speakers
are connected, the Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS)
function produces 3D surround sound.
Listening to FM/AM radio (p.51)
The unit is equipped with a built-in FM/AM tuner. You
can register up to 40 favorite radio stations as presets.
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (p.49)
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the unit plays
back the selected source with the least circuitry, which
lets you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality.
Easy operation with a TV screen
You can navigate through different types of content
(such as iPod, USB, and network), view information, or
easily configure the settings using the on-screen menu.
Low power consumption
The ECO mode (power saving function) reduces the
unit’s power consumption (p.99).
BD/DVD
player
Game
console
Camcorder
Set-top box
TV
CD player
HDMI Control
TV audio
Video from
external device
Useful tips
The combination of video/audio input jacks does not
match an external device...
Use “Audio In” in the “Input” menu to change the
combination of video/audio input jacks so that it
matches the output jack(s) of your external device
(p.27).
Video and audio are not synchronized...
Use “Lipsync” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the delay
between video and audio output (p.91).
I want to hear audio from the TV speakers...
Use “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu to select the
output destination of signals input into the unit (p.94).
Your TV speakers may be selected as an output
destination.
I want to change the on-screen menu language...
Use “Language” in the “Setup” menu to select a
language from English, Japanese, French, German,
Spanish, Russian and Chinese (p.34).
I want to update the firmware...
Use “UPDATE” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to
update the unit’s firmware (p.104). If the unit is
connected to the Internet, a message will be displayed
on the TV when a firmware update is available (p.110).
Many other settings are available that let you to
customize the unit. For details, see the following
pages.
Input settings (p.78)
Scene settings (p.81)
Sound program and surround decoder settings (p.83)
Various function settings (p.86)
Information view (such as audio signal and video
signal) (p.101)
System settings (p.102)
FEATURES Part names and functions En 8
Front panel
1 MAIN ZONE z key
Turns on/off (standby) the unit.
2 Standby indicator
Lights up when the unit is in standby mode under any of the
following conditions.
HDMI Control is enabled (p.93)
Standby Through is enabled (p.94)
Network Standby is enabled (p.95)
An iPod is being charged (p.56)
3 ZONE 2 key
Enables/disables the audio output to Zone2 (p.72).
4 ZONE CONTROL key
Changes the zone (main zone or the Zone2) that is controlled
by the keys and knobs on the front panel (p.72).
5 INFO key
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.74).
6 MEMORY key
Registers FM/AM radio stations as preset stations (p.52).
7 PRESET keys
Select a preset FM/AM radio station (p.52).
8 FM and AM keys
Switch between FM and AM (p.51).
9 Front display
Displays information (p.9).
0 Remote control sensor
Receives remote control signals (p.5).
A TUNING keys
Select the radio frequency (p.51).
B PURE DIRECT key
Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.49).
C INPUT knob
Selects an input source.
D SCENE keys
Select the registered input source, sound program, and
various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when
it is in standby mode (p.44).
E PHONES jack
For connecting headphones.
F USB jack
For connecting a USB storage device (p.60) or an iPod
(p.56).
G TONE CONTROL key
Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range
of output sounds (p.76).
H PROGRAM keys
Select a sound program or a surround decoder (p.45).
I STRAIGHT key
Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.48).
J VIDEO AUX jacks
For connecting devices, such as camcorders and game
consoles (p.29).
K YPAO MIC jack
For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.35).
L VOLUME knob
Adjusts the volume.
Part names and functions
INFOZONE 2
ZONE CONTROL
MEMORY
PRESET
FM AM
TUNING
TV
BD/DVD
NET
RADIO
INPUT
SCENE
MAIN ZONE
PHONES
TONE CONTROL
SILENT
CINEMA
STRAIGHTPROGRAM
PURE DIRECT
HDMI IN
VOLU ME
YPAO MIC
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
VIDEO AUX
USB
RL AUDIOVIDEO
:9 B2 34561 78 A
C
LF
E GH I KJD
Opening the front panel door
To use controls or jacks behind the front panel door, gently press the
bottom of the door to open it. Keep the door closed when not using
controls or jacks behind the front panel door.
FEATURES Part names and functions En 9
Front display (indicators)
1 HDMI
Lights up when HDMI signals are being input or output.
OUT1/OUT2
Indicates the HDMI OUT jacks currently outputting an HDMI
signal
2 CINEMA DSP
Lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.46) is working.
CINEMA DSP n
Lights up when CINEMA DSP 3D (p.48) is working.
3 ENHANCER
Lights up when Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50) is
working.
4 ADAPTIVE DRC
Lights up when Adaptive DRC (p.76) is working.
5 STEREO
Lights up when the unit is receiving a stereo FM radio signal.
TUNED
Lights up when the unit is receiving an FM/AM radio station
signal.
6 PA RT Y
Lights up when the unit is in the party mode. (p.73)
7 SLEEP
Lights up when the sleep timer is on.
8 ZONE2
Lights up when audio output to Zone2 is enabled (p.72).
9 MUTE
Blinks when audio is muted.
0 Volume indicator
Indicates the current volume.
A Cursor indicators
Indicate the remote control cursor keys currently operational.
B Information display
Displays the current status (such as input name and sound
mode name). You can switch the information by pressing
INFO (p.74).
C Speaker indicators
Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output.
A Front speaker (L)
S Front speaker (R)
D Center speaker
F Surround speaker (L)
G Surround speaker (R)
H Surround back speaker (L)
J Surround back speaker (R)
K Surround back speaker
Z Presence speaker (L)
X Presence speaker (R)
L Subwoofer
SW
C
LR
PL PR
SL SR
VOL.
MUTE
ENHANCER
ADAPTIVE DRC
STEREO
PARTY
3
2
TUNED
SLEEP
ZONE
SBL SB SBR
OUT 1 2
1 623 4 7 98:5
A AB C
FEATURES Part names and functions En 10
Rear panel
1 DC OUT jack
For connecting to an optional accessory.
2 NETWORK jack
For connecting to a network (p.30).
3 PHONO jacks
(Except for U.S.A. and Canada models)
For connecting to a turntable (p.29).
4 HDMI OUT 1–2 jacks
For connecting to HDMI-compatible TVs and outputting
video/audio signals (p.21). When using ARC, TV audio signal
can also be input through the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
5 ANTENNA jacks
For connecting to FM and AM antennas (p.30).
6 HDMI 1–7 jacks
For connecting to HDMI-compatible playback devices and
inputting video/audio signals (p.26).
7 RS-232C terminal
This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation.
Consult your dealer for details.
8 SPEAKERS terminals
For connecting to speakers (p.17).
9 VOLTAGE SELECTOR
(General model only)
Selects the switch position according to your local voltage
(p.33).
0 AV 1–6 jacks
For connecting to video/audio playback devices and
inputting video/audio signals (p.26).
A AV OUT jacks
For outputting video/audio to a recording device (such as a
VCR) (p.31).
B AUDIO 1–2 jacks
For connecting to audio playback devices and inputting
audio signals (p.29).
C MONITOR OUT jacks
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
For connecting to a TV that supports component video and
outputting video signals (p.25).
VIDEO jack
For connecting to a TV that supports composite video and
outputting video signals (p.25).
D REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
For connecting to a Yamaha product that supports SCENE
link playback (p.32) or for connecting to an infrared signal
receiver/emitter that allows you to operate the unit and other
devices from another room (p.71).
E TRIGGER OUT jack
For connecting to a device that supports the trigger function
(p.32).
F AUDIO OUT jacks
For outputting audio to a recording device (such as tape
deck) (p.31).
G ZONE2 OUT jacks
For connecting to the external amplifier used in Zone2 and
for outputting audio (p.71).
H PRE OUT jacks
For connecting to a subwoofer with built-in amplifier or to an
external power amplifier (p.31).
I AC IN jack
For connecting the supplied power cable (p.33).
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDI O
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5 HDMI 6
HDMI 7
RS-232C
HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
SPEAKERS
12V
0.1A
B F G H IECDA
41
2 65
:
7389
* The area around the video/audio output jacks is
marked in white on the actual product to
prevent improper connections.
(U.S.A. model)
FEATURES Part names and functions En 11
Remote control
1 Remote control signal transmitter
Transmits infrared signals.
2 SOURCE z key
Turns on/off an external device.
SOURCE key
Sets the remote control to operate external devices (p.106).
This key lights up in green after pressed.
RECEIVER key
Sets the remote control to operate the unit (p.106). This key
lights up in orange after pressed.
RECEIVER z key
Turns on/off (standby) the unit.
3 Input selection keys
Select an input source for playback.
HDMI 1–7 HDMI 1–7 jacks
V-AUX VIDEO AUX jack (on the front panel)
AV 16 AV 1–6 jacks
AUDIO 1–2 AUDIO 1–2 jacks
TUNER FM/AM radio
USB USB jack (on the front panel)
NET NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a
desired network source)
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)
Changes the external device to be controlled
without switching the input source.
PHONO (Except for U.S.A. and Canada models)
PHONO jacks
4 MAIN/ZONE2 switch
Changes the zone (main zone or Zone2) that is controlled by
the remote control (p.72).
5 SCENE keys
Select the registered input source, sound program, and
various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when
it is in standby mode (p.44).
6 PROGRAM keys
Select a sound program (p.45).
7 External device operation keys
Select menus for external devices (p.106).
8 ON SCREEN key
Displays the on-screen menu on the TV.
9 Menu operation keys
Cursor keys Select a menu or a parameter.
ENTER Confirms a selected item.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
0 MODE key
Switches the iPod operation modes (p.58).
A Radio keys
Operate the FM/AM radio when “TUNER” is selected as the
input source (p.51).
BAND Switches between FM and AM radio
PRESET Select a preset station.
TUNING Select the radio frequency.
External device operation keys
Let you play back and perform other operations for external
devices when an input source other than “TUNER” is
selected (p.106).
B Sound mode keys
Select a sound mode (p.45).
C INFO key
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.74).
D SLEEP key
Switches the unit to standby mode automatically after a
specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press
repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off).
E Numeric keys
Let you enter numerical values, such as radio frequencies.
MEMORY key
Registers FM/AM radio stations as presets (p.52).
F TV operation keys
Let you select TV input and volume, and perform other TV
operations (p.105).
G HDMI OUT key
Selects HDMI OUT jacks to be used for video/audio output
(p.43).
H PA RT Y k e y
Turns on/off the party mode (p.73).
I VOLUME keys
Adjust the volume.
J MUTE key
Mutes the audio output.
K OPTION key
Displays the option menu (p.75).
L DISPLAY key
Displays status information on the TV (p.74).
M CODE SET key
Registers remote control codes of external devices on the
remote control (p.105).
To operate external devices with the remote control, register a
remote control code for each device before using (p.105).
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
6 87
123 4
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
123 4
12
12
3 4
SUR. DECODE
H
J
G
K
L
M
1
3
2
5
4
6
I
7
E
D
F
8
A
B
:
C
9
(U.S.A. model)
PREPARATIONS General setup procedure En 12
PREPARATIONS
This completes all the preparations. Enjoy playing movies, music, radio and other content with the unit!
General setup procedure
1 Placing speakers (p.13)
Select the speaker layout for the number of speakers that you are using and place them in your room.
2 Connecting speakers (p.17)
Connect the speakers to the unit.
3 Connecting a TV (p.21)
Connect a TV to the unit.
4 Connecting playback devices (p.26)
Connect video devices (such as BD/DVD players) and audio devices (such as CD players) to the unit.
5 Connecting the FM/AM antennas (p.30)
Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit.
6 Connecting to a network (p.30)
Connect the unit to a network.
7 Connecting other devices (p.31)
Connect external devices, such as an external power amplifier and recording devices.
8 Connecting the power cable (p.33)
After all the connections are complete, plug in the power cable.
9
Selecting an on-screen menu language
(p.34)
Select the desired on-screen menu language (default: English).
10
Optimizing the speaker settings
automatically (YPAO) (p.35)
Optimize the speaker settings, such as volume balance and acoustic parameters, to suit your room
(YPAO).
PREPARATIONS Placing speakers En 13
Select the speaker layout for the number of speakers that you are using and place the speakers and subwoofer (with built-in amplifier) in your room. This section describes the
representative speaker layout examples.
For information on the ideal speaker layout, see “Ideal speaker layout” (p.118).
If you have seven speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers or presence speakers.
To reinforce the rear right/left sounds, use them as surround back speakers.
To create a natural 3-dimensional sound field, use them as presence speakers.
Two subwoofers connected to the unit output the same sounds.
1 Placing speakers
Caution
Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the unit’s speaker impedance to “6 MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
For details, see “Setting the speaker impedance” (p.16).
Speaker type Abbr. Function
Speaker system (the number of channels)
7.1+2 7.1 7.1 6.1 5.1 4.1 3.1 2.1
Front (L) 1
Produce front right/left channel sounds (stereo sounds).
●●●●●●●
Front (R) 2 ●●●●●●●
Center 3 Produces center channel sounds (such as movie dialogue and vocals). ●●
Surround (L) 4
Produce surround right/left channel sounds. Surround speakers also produce surround back channel sounds when
no surround back speakers are connected.
●●●●●
Surround (R) 5 ●●●●●
Surround back (L) 6
Produce surround back left/right channel sounds.
●●
Surround back (R) 7 ●●
Surround back 8 Produces sounds mixed from surround back left/right channel sounds.
Presence (L) Q
Produce CINEMA DSP effect sounds. In combination with CINEMA DSP 3D (p.48), the presence speakers create a
natural 3-dimensional sound field in your room.
●●
Presence (R) W ●●
Subwoofer 9
Produces LFE (low-frequency effect) channel sounds and reinforces the bass parts of other channels.
This channel is counted as “0.1”. You can connect 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to the unit.
●●●●●●●
1
Speaker placement
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Placing speakers En 14
7.1+2-channel system
The surround back speakers and presence speakers do not produce sounds simultaneously. The unit
automatically changes the speakers to be used, depending on the selected CINEMA DSP (p.46).
7.1-channel system (using presence speakers)
7.1-channel system (using surround back speakers)
6.1-channel system
45
1
2
39
67
QW
9
45
1
2
39
QW
45
1
2
39
67
45
1
2
39
8
1
Speaker placement
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Placing speakers En 15
5.1-channel system
4.1-channel system
3.1-channel system
2.1-channel system
45
12
39
45
12
9
12
39
12
9
1
Speaker placement
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Placing speakers En 16
Setting the speaker impedance
Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting
6-ohm speakers, set the speaker impedance to “6
MIN”. In this case, you can also
use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
1
Before connecting speakers, connect the power cable to an AC wall
outlet.
2
While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press
MAIN ZONE z.
3
Check that “SP IMP.” is displayed on the front display.
4
Press STRAIGHT to select “6 MIN”.
5
Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and remove the
power cable from the AC wall outlet.
You are now ready to connect the speakers.
MAIN ZONE z
STRAIGHT
SPIMP.8MIN
1
Speaker placement
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting speakers En 17
Connect the speakers placed in your room to the unit.
The following diagrams provide connections for 7.1+2-,
7.1-, and 6.1-channel systems as examples. For other
systems, connect speakers while referring to the
connection diagram for the 6.1-channel system.
Cables required for connection
(commercially available)
Speaker cables (x the number of speakers)
Audio pin cable (two for connecting two subwoofers)
7.1+2-channel system 7.1-channel system
(using surround back speakers)
2 Connecting speakers
Caution
Remove the unit’s power cable from an AC wall outlet and turn
off the subwoofer before connecting the speakers.
Ensure that the core wires of the speaker cable do not touch
one another or come into contact with the unit’s metal parts.
Doing so may damage the unit or the speakers. If the speaker
cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will appear on the front
display when the unit is turned on.
+
+
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
1
67
2
3
45
9
9
QW
The unit (rear)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
1
67
2
3
45
9
The unit (rear)
1 2
Speaker connections
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting speakers En 18
7.1-channel system
(using presence speakers)
6.1-channel system
Connecting speaker cables
Speaker cables have two wires. One is for connecting
the negative (-) terminal of the unit and the speaker, and
the other is for the positive (+) terminal. If the wires are
colored to prevent confusion, connect the black wire to
the negative and the other wire to the positive terminal.
a Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8”) of insulation from
the ends of the speaker cable and twist the bare wires of
the cable firmly together.
b Loosen the speaker terminal.
c Insert the bare wires of the cable into the gap on the side
(upper right or bottom left) of the terminal.
d Tighten the terminal.
Using a banana plug
(U.S.A., Canada, China, Australia and General models only)
a Tighten the speaker terminal.
b Insert a banana plug into the end of the terminal.
Connecting the subwoofer
Use an audio pin cable to connect the subwoofer.
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
12
3
45
9
QW
The unit (rear)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
12
3
45
9
8
The unit (rear)
When using only one surround back speaker, connect it
to the SINGLE jack (L side).
FRONT
aa
b
d
c
+ (red)
- (black)
FRONT
a
b
Banana plug
Audio pin cable
1 2
Speaker connections
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting speakers En 19
Connecting front speakers that
support bi-amp connections
When using front speakers that support bi-amp
connections, connect them to the FRONT jacks and
SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP jacks.
To enable the bi-amp function, set “Power Amp Assign”
(p.88) in the “Setup” menu to “5ch BI-AMP” after
connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet.
12
3
45
9
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
The unit (rear)
Caution
Before making bi-amp connections, remove any brackets or
cables that connect a woofer with a tweeter. Refer to the
instruction manual of the speakers for details. If you are not
making bi-amp connections, make sure that the brackets or
cables are connected before connecting the speaker cables.
Surround back speakers cannot be used during bi-amp
connections.
1 2
Speaker connections
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Input/output jacks and cables En 20
Video/audio jacks
HDMI jacks
Transmit digital video and digital sound through a single
jack. Use an HDMI cable.
Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. We recommend using
a cable less than 5.0 m (16.4 ft) long to prevent signal quality
degradation.
To connect a device that has a DVI jack, an HDMI/DVI-D cable is
required.
The unit’s HDMI jacks support the HDMI Control, Audio Return
Channel (ARC), and 3D and 4K video transmission features.
Use high speed HDMI cables to enjoy 3D or 4K videos.
Video jacks
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
Transmit video signals separated into three
components: luminance (Y), chrominance blue (P
B),
and chrominance red (P
R). Use a component video
cable with three plugs.
VIDEO jacks
Transmit analog video signals. Use a video pin cable.
Audio jacks
OPTICAL jacks
Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital optical
cable. Remove the tip protector (if available) before
using the cable.
COAXIAL jacks
Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital coaxial
cable.
AUDIO jacks
Transmit analog stereo audio signals. Use a stereo pin
cable.
Input/output jacks and cables
HDMI cable
Component video cable
Video pin cable
AV 4
OPTICAL
(
TV
)
Digital optical cable
Digital coaxial cable
Stereo pin cable
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 21
Connect a TV to the unit so that video input to the unit can be output to the TV.
You can also enjoy playback of TV audio on the unit.
The connection method varies depending on the functions and video input jacks
available on your TV.
Refer to the instruction manual of the TV and choose a connection method.
Connection Method 1 (HDMI Control/ARC-compatible TV)
Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable.
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters
(p.93) in the “Setup” menu.
HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
Use an HDMI cable that supports ARC.
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV
(except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the
unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.122).
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and
network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV.
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.25).
3 Connecting a TV
About HDMI Control
HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV
that supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit’s
power and volume with the TV’s remote control. You can also control playback
devices (such as an HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD player) connected to the
unit with an HDMI cable. For details, see “HDMI Control” (p.123).
About Audio Return Channel (ARC)
ARC allows audio signals to travel both ways under HDMI Control. If you connect a
TV that supports HDMI Control and ARC to the unit with a single HDMI cable, you
can output video/audio to the TV or input TV audio to the unit.
Does your TV support
Audio Return Channel (ARC)?
Does your TV support
HDMI Control?
Does your TV have an
HDMI input jack?
Connection Method 3 (p.24)
Connection Method 2 (p.23)
Connection Method 1 (p.21)
Connection Method 4 (p.25)
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
HDMI
ARC
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI OUT 1 jack
HDMI input
(ARC-compatible)
The unit
(rear)
TV
1 2 3
TV connection
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 22
Necessary settings
To use HDMI Control and ARC, you need to configure the following settings.
For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV.
1
After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback devices)
and the power cable to the unit, turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices.
2
Configure the settings of the unit.
a Check that ARC is enabled on the TV.
b Switch the TV input to display video from the unit.
c Press ON SCREEN.
d Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
e Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”.
f Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER.
g Use the cursor keys to select “On”.
h Press ON SCREEN.
3
Configure the settings for HDMI Control.
a Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as HDMI
Control-compatible BD/DVD player).
b Turn off the TV’s main power and then turn off the unit and playback devices.
c Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV’s main power.
d Switch the TV input to display video from the unit.
e Check the following.
On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not,
select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
f Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or
adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
This completes the necessary settings.
If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of the unit will be
automatically switched to “AV 4” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit.
If you cannot hear the TV’s audio, check that “ARC” (p.94) in the “Setup” menu is set to
“On”.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and then plugging in again)
the devices. It may solve the problem.
If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on
the TV.
If the audio is interrupted while using ARC, set “ARC” (p.94) in the “Setup” menu to “Off” and use a digital
optical cable to input TV audio to the unit (p.23).
“AV 4” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks,
use “TV Audio Input” (p.93) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the
SCENE function (p.44), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
DISPLA
Y
R
ETUR
N
OPTION
ON SCREEN
Cursor keys
ENTER
1 2 3
TV connection
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 23
Connection Method 2 (HDMI Control-compatible TV)
Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and a digital optical cable.
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters
(p.93) in the “Setup” menu.
HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV
(except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the
unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.122).
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and
network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV.
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.25).
Necessary settings
To use HDMI Control, you need to configure the following settings.
For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV.
1
After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback
devices) and power cable of the unit, turn on the unit, TV, and
playback devices.
2
Configure the settings of the unit.
a Switch the TV input to display video from the unit.
b Press ON SCREEN.
c Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
d Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”.
e Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER.
f Use the cursor keys to select “On”.
g Press ON SCREEN.
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
HDMI
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
HDMI
HDMI
AV 4
(
TV
)
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
OO
The unit
(rear)
HDMI OUT 1 jack
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack Audio output
(digital optical)
TV
HDMI input
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
DISPLA
Y
R
ETUR
N
OPTION
ON SCREEN
Cursor keys
ENTER
1 2 3
TV connection
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 24
3
Configure the settings for HDMI Control.
a Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as a HDMI
Control-compatible BD/DVD player).
b Turn off the TV’s main power and then turn off the unit and playback devices.
c Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV.
d Switch the TV input to display video from the unit.
e Check the following.
On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not,
select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
f Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or
adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
This completes the necessary settings.
If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of the unit will be
automatically switched to “AV 4” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and then plugging in again)
the devices. It may solve the problem.
If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on
the TV.
“AV 4” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or
if you want to use another input jack (other than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, use “TV Audio Input”
(p.93) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.44),
you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
Connection Method 3 (TV with HDMI input jacks)
Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and a digital optical cable.
If you switch the input source of the unit to “AV 4” using the AV 4 or SCENE(TV) keys,
the TV audio will be played back on the unit.
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV
(except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the
unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.122).
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and
network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV.
If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or if you want to use another input jack (other
than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, connect the TV to one of the AV 1–6 and AUDIO 1–2 jacks. To use
the SCENE function (p.44), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.25).
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
HDMI
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
HDMI
HDMI
AV 4
(
TV
)
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
OO
The unit
(rear)
HDMI OUT 1 jack
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack Audio output
(digital optical)
TV
HDMI input
1 2 3
TV connection
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 25
Connection Method 4 (TV without HDMI input jacks)
When connecting any video device to the AV 1–2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks of the
unit, connect the TV to the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks.
When connecting any video device to the AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jacks or the front VIDEO jack
of the unit, connect the TV to the MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack.
If you select “AV 4” as the input source by pressing AV 4 or SCENE(TV), the TV audio
will be played back on the unit.
If you connect your TV to the unit with a cable other than HDMI, video input to the unit via HDMI cannot be
output to the TV.
Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI.
If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or if you want to use another input jack (other
than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, connect the TV to one of the AV 1–6 and AUDIO 1–2 jacks. To use
the SCENE function (p.44), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
COMPONENT VIDEO connection (with a component video cable)
VIDEO (composite video) connection (with a video pin cable)
Connecting another TV or a projector
The unit has two HDMI output jacks. If you connect another TV or a projector to the unit
with an HDMI cable, you can switch the TV (or projector) to be used for watching
videos with the remote control (p.43).
HDMI Control is not available on the HDMI OUT 2 jack.
AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOT
TRIGGER O
U
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HD
M
HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
AV 4
(
TV
)
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
P
R
P
B
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
OO
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
MONITOR O
U
P
B
Y
P
R
The unit (rear)
MONITOR OUT
(COMPONENT VIDEO)
jacks
Video input
(component video)
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack
Audio output
(digital optical)
TV
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
RE
TRIGG
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
1
VIDEO
V
V
AV 4
(
TV
)
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
OO
VIDEO
N
ITOR OUT
The unit (rear)
MONITOR OUT
(VIDEO) jack
Video input
(composite video)
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack Audio output
(digital optical)
TV
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
HDMI
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
HDMI
HDMI
The unit
(rear)
HDMI OUT 2 jack
HDMI input
Projector
TV (already connected)
TV
1 2 3
TV connection
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting playback devices En 26
The unit is equipped with a variety of input jacks including HDMI input jacks to allow
you to connect different types of playback devices. For information on how to connect
an iPod or a USB storage device, see the following pages.
Connecting an iPod (p.56)
Connecting a USB storage device (p.60)
Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players)
Connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, set-top boxes (STBs) and game
consoles to the unit. Depending on the video/audio output jacks available on your video
device, choose one of the following connections. We recommend using an HDMI
connection if the video device has an HDMI output jack.
If the combination of video/audio input jacks available on the unit does not match your video device, change
its combination according to the output jacks of your device (p.27).
HDMI connection
Connect a video device to the unit with an HDMI cable.
If you select the input source by pressing HDMI 1–7, the video/audio played back on
the video device will be output from the unit.
To watch videos input to the HDMI 1–7 jacks, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack of the
unit (p.21 to 24).
Component video connection
Connect a video device to the unit with a component video cable and an audio cable
(digital optical or digital coaxial). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on
the audio output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–2, the video/audio played back on the
video device will be output from the unit.
The component video signals (other than 480i/576i signals) input to AV 1–2 jacks of the unit can be output
from the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks only. To watch those videos, you need to connect
your TV to the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks of the unit (p.25).
4 Connecting playback devices
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SURRO
U
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
A
V
O
UT
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTE
R
SU
B
1
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5 HDMI 6
HDMI 7
RS-232C
HDMI 3HDMI 2
E
NNA
D
IO
)
FM
SPEAKERS
12V
0.1A
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
The unit (rear)
HDMI output
Video device
HDMI 1–7 jacks
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on the unit
Video Audio
Component video
Digital optical AV 1 (COMPONENT VIDEO + OPTICAL)
Digital coaxial AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + COAXIAL)
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
P
R
P
B
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
COMPONENT
AV1 AV 2
VIDEO
OPTICAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
O
O
C
C
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
The unit (rear)
AV 1–2
(COMPONENT VIDEO)
jacks
Video output
(component video)
Video device
Audio output
(digital optical or digital coaxial)
AV 1 (OPTICAL) jack or
AV 2 (COAXIAL) jack
1 2 3 4
Playback device connections
5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting playback devices En 27
Composite video connection
Connect a video device to the unit with a video pin cable and an audio cable (digital
coaxial, digital optical, or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit)
depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 3–6, the video/audio played back on the
video device will be output from the unit.
To watch videos input to the AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jacks, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack
(p.21 to 24) or to the MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack (p.25) of the unit.
Changing the combination of video/audio input jacks
If the combination of video/audio input jacks available on the unit does not match your
video device, change its combination according to the output jacks of your device. You
can connect a video device that has the following video/audio output jacks.
Necessary setting
For example, if you have connected a video device to AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) and
AV 5 (AUDIO) jacks of the unit, change the combination setting as follows.
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on the unit
Video Audio
Composite video
Digital coaxial AV 3 (VIDEO + COAXIAL)
Digital optical AV 4 (VIDEO + OPTICAL)
Analog stereo AV 5–6 (VIDEO + AUDIO)
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
(TV)
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
VIDEO
VIDEO
CC
L
R
L
R
OO
V
V
The unit (rear)
AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jack
Video output
(composite video)
Video device
Audio output
(either digital optical,
digital coaxial, or analog stereo)
Any of AV 3 (COAXIAL) jack,
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack,
AV 5–6 (AUDIO) jacks
Output jacks on video device Input jacks on the unit
Video Audio Video Audio
HDMI
Digital optical HDMI 1–7
AV 1 (OPTICAL)
AV 4 (OPTICAL)
Digital coaxial HDMI 1–7 AV 2–3 (COAXIAL)
Analog stereo HDMI 1–7
AV 5–6 (AUDIO)
AUDIO 1–2
Component video Analog stereo
AV 1–2
(COMPONENT
VIDEO)
AV 5–6 (AUDIO)
AUDIO 1–2
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
A
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
A
M
AV 5
R
L
R
L
AUDIO
L
R
L
R
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks
Video output
(component video)
AV 5 (AUDIO) jacks
Video device
Audio output
(analog stereo)
The unit (rear)
1 2 3 4
Playback device connections
5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting playback devices En 28
The following operation is available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI.
1
After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback
devices) and power cable of the unit, turn on the unit.
2
Press AV 2 to select “AV 2” (video input jack to be used) as the input
source.
3
Press ON SCREEN.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “AV2” (video input jack to be
used) and press the cursor key (q).
6
Use the cursor keys to select “Audio In” and press ENTER.
7
Use the cursor keys to select “AV5” (audio input jack to be used).
8
Press ON SCREEN.
This completes the necessary settings.
If you select “AV 2” as the input source by pressing AV 2, the video/audio played back
on the video device will be output from the unit.
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MENU
DISPLA
Y
RETURN
OPTION
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MEN
U
NET
TUNER
USB
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
12
12
34
N
TUNE
R
US
B
AV
A
UDI
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-AU
X
1
1
2
3
4
ON SCREEN
ENTER
AV 2
Cursor keys
1 2 3 4
Playback device connections
5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting playback devices En 29
Connecting audio devices (such as CD players)
Connect audio devices such as CD players, MD players, and a turntable to the unit.
Depending on the audio output jacks available on your audio device, choose one of the
following connections.
* Except for U.S.A. and Canada models
If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2 or PHONO*, the audio
played back on the audio device will be output from the unit.
Connecting to the jacks on the front panel
Use the VIDEO AUX jack to temporarily connect devices such as game consoles and
camcorders to the unit.
Use the USB jack to connect an iPod or a USB storage device. For details, see
“Connecting an iPod” (p.56) or “Connecting a USB storage device” (p.60).
Before making a connection, stop playback on the device and turn down the volume on
the unit.
If you select “V-AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the video/audio played
back on the device will be output from the unit.
To watch videos input to the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT
jack of the unit (p.21 to 24).
You need to prepare an HDMI cable that match the output jacks on your device.
If you connect video devices to both the HDMI IN jack and VIDEO/AUDIO jacks, the unit outputs
video/audio input through the HDMI IN jack.
When “USB” is selected as the input source, video signals input to the VIDEO AUX (VIDEO) jack are output
from the HDMI OUT and MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jacks.
Audio output jacks on audio device Audio output jacks on the unit
Digital optical
AV 1 (OPTICAL)
AV 4 (OPTICAL)
Digital coaxial AV 2–3 (COAXIAL)
Analog stereo
AV 5–6 (AUDIO)
AUDIO 1–2
Turntable (PHONO) PHONO*
When connecting a turntable
(Except for U.S.A. and Canada models)
The PHONO jack of the unit is compatible with an MM cartridge. To connect a turntable with a
low-output MC cartridge, use a boosting transformer.
Connecting the turntable to the GND terminal of the unit may reduce noise in the signal.
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
HD
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
L
PHONO
GND
PHONO
GND
CC
L
R
L
R
OO
L
R
L
R
Audio output
(either digital optical,
digital coaxial, or analog stereo)
AV 1–6 jacks
AUDIO 1–2 jacks
The unit
(rear)
Audio device
PHONO jacks*
Audio output (PHONO)
Turntable
Ground lead
PHONES
TONE CONTROL
SILENT
CINEMA
STRAIGHTPROGRAM
HDMI IN
YPAO MIC
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
VIDEO AUX
USB
RL AUDIOVIDEO
V RL
HDMI
Game console
Camcorder
The unit (front)
1 2 3 4
Playback device connections
5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting the FM/AM antennas En 30
Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit.
Fix the end of the FM antenna to a wall, and place the AM antenna on a flat surface.
Assembling and connecting the AM antenna
Unwind only the length of cable needed from the AM antenna unit.
The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity.
Connect the unit to your router with a commercially-available STP network cable (CAT-5
or higher straight cable).
You can enjoy Internet radio or music files stored on media servers, such as PCs and
Network Attached Storage (NAS), on the unit.
If you are using a router that supports DHCP, you do not need to configure any network settings for the unit,
as the network parameters (such as the IP address) will be assigned automatically to it. You only need to
configure the network settings if your router does not support DHCP or if you want to configure the network
parameters manually (p.95).
You can check whether the network parameters (such as IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in
“Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu.
Some security software installed on your PC or the firewall settings of network devices (such as a router)
may block the access of the unit to the network devices or the Internet. In these cases, configure the
security software or firewall settings appropriately.
Each server must be connected to the same subnet as the unit.
To use the service via the Internet, broadband connection is strongly recommended.
5 Connecting the FM/AM antennas
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5 HDMI 6
HDMI 7
RS-2
3
HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
SPE
A
12V
0.1A
FM antenna
AM antenna
The unit (rear)
Hold down Insert Release
6 Connecting to a network
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
LAN
WAN
Network Attached Storage
(NAS)
Internet
Modem
Router
Network cable
PC
The unit (rear)
Mobile device
(such as iPod touch
and iPhone)
1 2 3 4 5
FM/AM antenna connections
6
Network connections
7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting other devices En 31
Connecting an external power amplifier
When connecting an external power amplifier (pre-main amplifier) to enhance speaker
output, connect the input jacks of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks of the unit.
The same channel signals are output from the PRE OUT jacks as from their
corresponding SPEAKERS terminals.
1 FRONT jacks
Output front channel sounds.
2 SURROUND jacks
Output surround channel sounds.
3 SUR. BACK jacks
Output surround back channel sounds. When using only one external amplifier for the surround
back channel, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side).
4 SUBWOOFER1–2 jacks
For connecting a subwoofer with built-in amplifier. When 2 subwoofers are connected, the same
sound is output from them.
5 CENTER jack
Outputs center channel sounds.
Connecting recording devices
You can connect video/audio recording devices to the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks.
These jacks output analog video/audio signals selected as the input.
To copy video/audio from a video device, connect the video device to the AV 5–6 jacks of the unit.
To copy audio from an audio device, connect the audio device to the AV 5–6 jacks or AUDIO 1–2 jacks of
the unit.
Be sure to use the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks only for connecting recording devices.
7 Connecting other devices
Caution
To prevent the generation of loud noises or abnormal sounds, make sure the followings before making
connections.
Remove the power cable of the unit and turn off the external power amplifier before connecting them.
When using the PRE OUT jacks, do not connect speakers to the corresponding SPEAKERS
terminals.
When using an external amplifier that does not have the volume control bypass, do not connect other
devices (except the unit) to the amplifier.
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5 HDMI 6
HDMI 7
RS-232C
HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
2
OUT
C
FM
AM
SPEAKERS
12V
0.1A
1 2 3 4
5
The unit (rear)
FRONT CENT
E
AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
R
L
AUDIO
R
L
AUDIO
AUDIO
OUT
AV
OUT
VIDEO
V
V
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
The unit (rear)
AV OUT jacks
Video/audio input
Video recording
device
Audio recording
device
Audio inputAUDIO OUT jacks
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Other connections
8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting other devices En 32
Connecting a device that supports
SCENE link playback (remote connection)
If you have a Yamaha product that supports SCENE control signal transmission, you
can operate it remotely by connecting it to the REMOTE OUT jack, using a monaural
mini-jack cable, and linking with the SCENE function (p.44).
If you connect a Yamaha product that supports the SCENE link playback function, to the REMOTE OUT
jack, you can remotely start playback on it by linking with a scene selection (p.44). To enable the SCENE
link playback function, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.81) in the “Scene” menu.
You can also connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to operate devices in the main zone from Zone2
(p.71).
Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function
The trigger function can control an external device in conjunction with operating the
unit (such as powering on/off and input selection). If you have a Yamaha subwoofer that
supports a system connection or a device with a trigger input jack, you can use the
trigger function by connecting the external device to the TRIGGER OUT jack.
You can configure the trigger function settings in “Trigger Output” (p.98) in the “Setup” menu.
FR
O
AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
K
HDMI 4HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
IN
OUT
REMOTE
REMOTE
IN
The unit
(rear)
REMOTE OUT jack
Yamaha product
(such as a DVD player)
Remote input
FRONT C
E
AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
2
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
TRIGGER OUT
12V
0.1A
The unit (rear)
TRIGGER OUT jack
System connection
input
Yamaha subwoofer that
supports a system connection
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Other connections
8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting the power cable En 33
After all the connections are complete, connect the supplied power cable to the unit
and then to an AC wall outlet.
8 Connecting the power cable
Before connecting the power cable (General model only)
Set the switch position of VOLTAGE SELECTOR according to your local voltage.
Voltages are AC 110–120/220–240 V, 50/60 Hz.
Make sure you set VOLTAGE SELECTOR of the unit BEFORE plugging the power cable into an AC
wall outlet. Improper setting of VOLTAGE SELECTOR may cause damage to the unit and create a
potential fire hazard.
O
UND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
R
ROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
HDMI 7
RS-232C
SPEAKERS
VOLTAGE
SELECTOR
220V
-
240V 110V
-
120V
The unit (rear)
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
NE 2
O
UT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
D
MI 5 HDMI 6
HDMI 7
RS-232C
SPEAKERS
To an AC wall outlet
The unit (rear)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Power cable connection
9 10
PREPARATIONS Selecting an on-screen menu language En 34
Select the desired on-screen menu language from English
(default), Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian and
Chinese.
1
Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display
video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
3
Press ON SCREEN.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press
ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Language” and
the cursor keys (q/w) to select the desired
language.
6
To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
7
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
The information on the front display is provided in English only.
9 Selecting an on-screen menu language
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Language setting
10
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ON SCREEN
ENTER
RECEIVER z
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 35
The Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) function
detects speaker connections, measures the distances from them to
your listening position(s), and then automatically optimizes the
speaker settings, such as volume balance and acoustic
parameters, to suit your room.
Please note the following when using YPAO.
Use YPAO after connecting a TV and speakers to the unit.
During the measuring process, test tones are output at high volume. Ensure that
the test tones do not frighten small children. Also, refrain from using this function
at night when it may be a nuisance to others.
During the measuring process, you cannot adjust the volume.
During the measuring process, keep the room as quiet as possible.
Do not connect headphones.
1
Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display
video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
3
Turn on the subwoofer and set the volume to half. If
the crossover frequency is adjustable, set it to
maximum.
If you are using bi-amp connection or Zone2 speakers, set “Power Amp
Assign” (p.88) in the “Setup” menu to the appropriate setting before starting
YPAO.
4
Place the YPAO microphone at your listening
position (same height as your ears) and connect it
to the YPAO MIC jack on the front panel.
10 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO)
VOLUME HIGH CUT
CROSSOVER/
MIN MAXMIN MAX
9
YPAO MIC
9
12
3
45
The unit (front)
YPAO
microphone
Ear height
Place the YPAO microphone at
your listening position (same height
as your ears). We recommend the
use of a tripod as a microphone
stand. You can use the tripod
screws to stabilize the microphone.
YPAO MIC
jack
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Automatic speaker setup
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
RECEIVER z
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 36
The following screen appears on the TV.
To cancel the operation, disconnect the YPAO microphone before starting
the measurement.
5
If desired, change the measuring method
(multi/single).
a Use the cursor keys to select “Multi Position” and press ENTER.
b Use the cursor keys to select a setting and then press ENTER.
Settings
If you perform the multi measure, the speaker settings will be optimized for you to
enjoy surround sound in a wider space.
If you perform the multi measure, first place the YPAO microphone at the listening
position you will be seated most frequently.
This completes the preparations. See the following page to start the
measurement.
When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”:
“Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)” (p.38)
When “Multi Position” is set to “No”:
“Measuring at one listening position (single measure)” (p.37)
Yes
Select this option if you will have several listening
positions or if you want others to enjoy surround sound.
You can take measurements at up to 8 different
positions in the room. The speaker settings will be
optimized to suit the area defined by those positions
(multi measure).
No (default)
Select this option if your listening position will always be
fixed. Take the measurements at only one position. The
speaker settings will be optimized to suit that position
(single measure).
a b
a
a
b
c
d
e
c
d
de
bac
Multi measure
(5 listening positions)
Multi measure
(2 listening positions + front/back)
Multi measure
(1 listening position + front/back/left/right)
Single measure
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Automatic speaker setup
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 37
Measuring at one listening position
(single measure)
Follow the procedure below for measurement.
Do not stand between the speakers and the YPAO microphone during the
measurement process (about 3 minutes).
Move to the corner of the room or leave the room.
1
To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Measure” and press ENTER.
The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER
again to start the measurement immediately.
To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN.
The following screen appears on the TV when the
measurement finishes.
If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1)
appears, see “Error messages” (p.41) or “Warning messages” (p.42).
To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see
“Checking the measurement results” (p.39).
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and
press ENTER.
3
To save the measurement results, use the cursor
keys (e/r) to select “SAVE” and press ENTER.
The adjusted speaker settings are applied.
To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”.
4
Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit.
This completes optimization of the speaker settings.
Caution
The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere
where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on
top of AV equipment).
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 38
Measuring at multiple listening positions
(multi measure)
When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”, follow the procedure below for
measurement.
Do not stand between the speakers and the YPAO microphone during the
measurement process. It takes about 10 minutes to measure 8 listening positions.
Move to the corner of the room or leave the room.
If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears,
see “Error messages” (p.41) or “Warning messages” (p.42).
1
To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Measure” and press ENTER.
The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER
again to start the measurement immediately.
To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN.
The following screen appears on the TV when the
measurement at the first position finishes.
2
Move the YPAO microphone to the next listening
position and press ENTER.
Repeat step 2 until measurements at all listening positions
(up to 8) have been taken.
3
When the measurements at the positions you want
to measure are completed, use the cursor keys to
select “CANCEL” and press ENTER.
When you have taken measurements at 8 listening
positions, the following screen appears automatically.
To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see
“Checking the measurement results” (p.39).
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and
press ENTER.
5
To save the measurement result, use the cursor
keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER.
The adjusted speaker settings are applied.
To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 39
6
Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit.
This completes optimization of the speaker settings.
Checking the measurement results
You can check the YPAO measurement results.
1
After the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Result” and press ENTER.
You can also select “Result” from “Auto Setup” (p.86) in the “Setup” menu,
which displays the previous measurement results.
The following screen appears.
1 Measurement result items
2 Measurement result details
3 The number of measured positions (when multi
measure is performed)
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item.
A speaker with a problem is indicated with a message enclosed in a red box.
3
To finish checking the results and return to the
previous screen, press RETURN.
Caution
The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere
where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on
top of AV equipment).
1
2
3
Wiring
Polarity of each speaker
Normal: The speaker cable is connected with the
correct polarity (+/-).
Reverse: The speaker cable may be connected with the
reverse polarity (+/-).
Size
Size of each speaker (cross-over frequency of the
subwoofer)
Large: The speaker can reproduce low-frequency
signals effectively.
Small: The speaker cannot reproduce low-frequency
signals effectively.
Distance Distance from the listening position to each speaker
Level Output level adjustment for each speaker
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 40
Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments
When the speaker settings you have configured manually are not
suitable, follow the procedure below to discard the manual settings
and reload the previous YPAO adjustments.
1
In the “Setup” menu, select “Speaker”, “Auto
Setup”, and then “Result” (p.85).
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup Reload” and
press ENTER.
3
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ON SCREEN
ENTER
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 41
Error messages
If any error message is displayed during the measurement, resolve the problem and perform YPAO again.
Error message Cause Remedy
E-1: No Front SP Front speakers are not detected.
Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then check the speaker connections.E-2: No Sur. SP One of the surround speakers cannot be detected.
E-3: No F.PRNS SP One of the presence speakers cannot be detected.
E-4: SBR SBL A surround back speaker is connected to the R side only.
When using only one surround back speaker, you need to connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Follow the
on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speaker.
E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud.
Keep the room quiet and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If you select
“PROCEED”, YPAO takes the measurement again and ignores any noise detected.
E-6: Check Sur.
Surround back speakers are connected, but no surround
speakers are connected
Surround speakers need to be connected in order to use surround back speakers. Follow the on-screen
instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speakers.
E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed.
Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the
measurement again.
E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone cannot detect test tones.
Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the
measurement again. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service
center.
E-9: User Cancel The measurement has been canceled. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. To cancel the measurement, select “EXIT”.
E-10: Internal Error An internal error has occurred.
Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off and on the unit. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact
the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Automatic speaker setup
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 42
Warning messages
If a warning message is displayed after the measurement, you can still save the measurement results by following on-screen instructions.
However, we recommend you perform YPAO again in order to use the unit with the optimal speaker settings.
Warning message Cause Remedy
W-1: Out of Phase
A speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity
(+/-).
Select “Wiring” in “Result” (p.39) and check the cable connections (+/-) of the speaker identified by
“Reverse”. If the speaker is connected incorrectly, turn off the unit and then reconnect the speaker cable.
Depending on the type of speakers or room environment, this message may appear even if the speakers are
connected correctly.
W-2: Over Distance
A speaker is placed more than 24 m (80 ft) from the listening
position.
Select “Distance” in “Result” (p.39) and move the speaker identified by “>24.0m (>80.0ft)” within 24 m (80 ft)
of the listening position.
W-3: Level Error
There are significant volume differences between the
speakers.
Check the usage environment and cable connections (+/-) of each speaker, and the volume of the
subwoofer. We recommend using the same speakers or speakers with specifications that are as similar as
possible.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Automatic speaker setup
PLAYBACK Basic playback procedure En 43
PLAYBACK
1
Turn on the external devices (such as a TV or
BD/DVD player) connected to the unit.
2
Use the input selection keys to select an input
source.
3
Start playback on the external device or select a
radio station.
Refer to the instruction manual for the external device.
For details on the following operations, see the
corresponding pages.
Listening to FM/AM radio (p.51)
Playing back iPod music (p.56)
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device
(p.60)
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)
(p.63)
Listening to Internet radio (p.66)
Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay)
(p.68)
4
Press VOLUME to adjust the volume.
To mute the audio output, press MUTE. Press MUTE again to unmute.
To adjust the treble/bass settings, use the “Option” menu or TONE
CONTROL on the front panel (p.76).
On-screen input selection
a Press ON SCREEN.
b Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
c Use the cursor keys to select the desired input source and
press ENTER.
Selecting an HDMI output jack
1
Press HDMI OUT to select an HDMI OUT jack.
Each time you press the key, the HDMI OUT jack to be
used for signal output changes.
You can also select an HDMI output jack by selecting a scene (p.44).
When “HDMI OUT 1+2” is selected, the unit outputs video signals at the highest
resolution supported by both TVs (or projectors) connected to the unit. (For
example, if you have connected a 1080p TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack and a 720p
TV to the HDMI OUT 2 jack, the unit outputs 720p video signals.)
Basic playback procedure
HDMI OUT 1+2
Outputs the same signal at both the HDMI OUT 1
and HDMI OUT 2 jacks.
HDMI OUT 1
Output the signals at the selected HDMI OUT jack.
HDMI OUT 2
HDMI OUT Off Does not output the signals at the HDMI OUT jacks.
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
HDMIOUT1+2
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
PR
OG
RAM
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
P
AR
T
Y
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ON SCREEN
ENTER
VOLUME
MUTE
HDMI OUT
Cursor keys
Input selection keys
PLAYBACK Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) En 44
The SCENE function allows you to select the assigned input source,
sound program, Compressed Music Enhancer on/off, and HDMI
output jack with just one touch.
1
Press SCENE.
The input source and settings registered to the
corresponding scene are selected. The unit turns on
automatically when it is in standby mode.
By default, the following settings are registered for each scene.
Configuring scene assignments
1
Perform the following operations to prepare the
settings you want to assign to a scene.
Select an input source (p.43)
Select a sound program (p.45)
Enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50)
Selecting an HDMI output jack (p.43)
2
Hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET
Complete” appears on the front display.
3
If you want to control the corresponding playback
device after selecting the scene, hold down the
corresponding SCENE key and input selection key
together for more than 3 seconds.
Once the setting is completed successfully, SOURCE blinks twice.
If you have not registered the remote control code of the playback device yet, see
“Registering the remote control codes for playback devices” (p.106) to register it.
You can also configure scene assignments in the “Scene” menu (p.80).
The SCENE link playback function allows you to start playback of an external
device connected to the unit via HDMI or of a Yamaha product connected to the
REMOTE OUT jack. To enable SCENE link playback, specify the device type in
“Device Control” (p.81) in the “Scene” menu.
Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE)
SCENE Input
Sound
program
Compressed
Music Enhancer
HDMI output jack
BD/DVD HDMI 1
MOVIE
(Sci-Fi)
Off HDMI OUT 1+2
TV AV 4 STRAIGHT On HDMI OUT 1+2
NET
NET
RADIO
MUSIC
(7ch Stereo)
On HDMI OUT 1+2
RADIO TUNER
MUSIC
(7ch Stereo)
On HDMI OUT 1+2
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SETComplete
VOL.
SBL SBR
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
MO
D
E
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
SCENE
SOURCE
Input selection keys
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 45
The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs and
surround decoders that allow you to enjoy playback sources with
your favorite sound mode (such as sound field effect or stereo
playback).
Selecting a sound program suitable for movies (p.46)
Press MOVIE repeatedly.
Selecting a sound program suitable for music or stereo
playback (p.47)
Press MUSIC repeatedly.
Selecting a surround decoder (p.49)
Press SUR.DECODE repeatedly.
Switching to the straight decode mode (p.48)
Press STRAIGHT.
Switching to the Pure Direct mode (p.49)
Press PURE DIRECT.
Enable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50)
Press ENHANCER.
On-screen sound program/surround decoder selection
a Press ON SCREEN.
b Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press
ENTER.
c Use the cursor keys to select a sound program/surround
decoder and press ENTER.
You can also switch the sound programs and surround decoder by pressing
PROGRAM.
You can change the settings of the surround programs and surround decoders in
the “Sound Program” menu (p.82).
The sound mode can be applied separately to each input source.
When you play back audio signals with a sampling rate of higher than 96 kHz, the
straight decode mode (p.48) is automatically selected.
You can check which speakers are currently outputting sound by looking at the
speaker indicators on the unit’s front panel (p.9) or at the “Audio Signal” screen in
the “Information” menu (p.100).
Selecting the sound mode
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
ENE
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
MOVIE
MUSIC
SUR.DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER
PURE DIRECT
ON SCREEN
ENTER
PROGRAM
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 46
Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP)
The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs that utilize Yamaha’s original DSP
technology (CINEMA DSP). It allows you to easily create sound fields like actual movie
theaters or concert halls in your room.
Sound programs suitable for movies (MOVIE)
The following sound programs are optimized for viewing video sources, such as
movies, TV programs, and games.
MOVIE THEATER
ENTERTAINMENT
Standard
This program creates a sound field that emphasizes the surround feeling
without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multichannel audio,
such as Dolby Digital and DTS. Its design is based on the concept of the
ideal movie theater, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful
reverberations from the left, right, and rear.
Spectacle
This program delivers the scale and grandeur of spectacular movie
productions. It delivers an expansive sound space to match the
cinemascope wide-screen, and boasts a broad dynamic range, providing
everything from small delicate sounds to powerful loud booms.
Sci-Fi
This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the
latest Sci-Fi and SFX movies. You can enjoy a variety of
cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear
separation between dialogue, sound effects, and background music.
Adventure
This program is ideal for reproducing the sound design of action and
adventure movies precisely. The sound field restrains reverberations, but
puts emphasis on reproducing a sensation of expansiveness on both sides,
powerful space expanded widely to the left and right. The restrained depth
creates a clear and powerful space, while also maintaining the articulation
of the sounds and the separation of the channels.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Sci-Fi
VOL.
Sound program category
Sound program
“CINEMA DSP” lights up
Drama
This program features stable reverberations that match a wide range of
movie genres, from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The
reverberations are modest, but suitably stereophonic. The sound effects
and background music are reproduced with a gentle echo that does not
impinge on the articulation of the dialogue. You’ll never get tired listening for
long periods.
Mono Movie
This program reproduces monaural video sources, such as classic movies,
in an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program creates a
pleasant space with depth, by adding breadth and the appropriate
reverberation to the original audio.
Sports
This program allows listeners to enjoy the rich vividness of sport broadcasts
and light entertainment programs. In sports broadcasts, the commentators’
voices are positioned clearly at the center, while the atmosphere inside the
stadium is realistically conveyed by the peripheral delivery of the sounds of
the fans in a suitable space.
Action Game
This program is suitable for action games, such as car racing and fighting
games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player
feel like they are right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater
concentration. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music
Enhancer for a more dynamic and strong sound field.
Roleplaying Game
This program is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This
program adds depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction
of background music, special effects, and dialogue from a wide variety of
scenes. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music
Enhancer for a clearer and more spatial sound field.
Music Video
This program allows you to enjoy videos of pop, rock, and jazz concerts, as
if you were there yourself. Immerse yourself in the hot concert atmosphere
thanks to the vividness of the singers and solos on stage, a presence
sound field that emphasizes the beat of rhythm instruments, and a surround
sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall.
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 47
Sound programs suitable for music/stereo playback
(MUSIC)
The following sound programs are optimized for listening to music sources.
You can also select stereo playback.
CLASSICAL
LIVE/CLUB
STEREO
Hall in Munich
This program simulates a Munich concert hall with approximately 2,500
seats that uses stylish wood for the interior finishing. Fine, beautiful
reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s
virtual seat is at the center left of the arena.
Hall in Vienna
This program simulates a 1,700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a
shoebox shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings
create extremely complex reverberations from all around the audience,
producing a very full, rich sound.
Chamber
This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling, like an
audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable
for courtly music and chamber music.
Cellar Club
This program simulates an intimate concert venue with a low ceiling and
homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field delivers powerful sounds
that make you feel as if you are sitting in the front row in front of a small
stage.
The Roxy Theatre
This program creates the sound field of a 460-seat rock music concert
venue in Los Angeles. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the
hall.
The Bottom Line
This program creates the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a
famous New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left
and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound.
2ch Stereo
Use this program to mix down multichannel sources to 2 channels. When
multichannel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2 channels and
output from the front speakers (this program does not utilize CINEMA DSP).
7ch Stereo
Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back
multichannel sources, the unit mixes down the source to 2 channels, and
then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger
sound field and is ideal for background music at parties.
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 48
Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields
(CINEMA DSP 3D)
CINEMA DSP 3D creates a natural stereoscopic sound field in your
room.
CINEMA DSP 3D functions when both of the following conditions
are met.
• One of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is
selected (p.46).
“CINEMA DSP 3D Mode” (p.76) in the “Option” menu is set to
“On”.
We recommend using presence speakers in order to experience the full effect of
the stereoscopic sound fields. However, even when no presence speakers are
connected, the unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front,
center, and surround speakers to produce stereoscopic sound fields.
Enjoying sound field effects without
surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA DSP)
If you select one of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and
7ch Stereo) when no surround speakers are connected, the unit
automatically creates the surround sound field using the front-side
speakers.
Enjoying unprocessed playback
You can play back input sources without any sound field effect
processing.
Playing back in original channels
(straight decode)
When the straight decode mode is enabled, the unit produces
stereo sound from the front speakers for 2-channel sources such as
CDs, and produces unprocessed multichannel sounds for
multichannel sources.
1
Press STRAIGHT.
Each time you press the key, the straight decode mode is
enabled or disabled.
To enable 6.1/7.1-channel playback from 5.1-channel sources when surround
back speakers are used, set “Extended Surround” (p.77) in the “Option” menu to a
setting other than “Off”.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
3
Hall in Vienna
VOL.
PL PR
“CINEMA DSP n” lights up
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
STRAIGHT
VOL.
SBL SBR
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
STRAIGHT
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 49
Playing back 2-channel sources in
multichannel (surround decoder)
The surround decoder enables unprocessed multichannel
playback from 2-channel sources. When a multichannel source is
input, it works the same way as the straight decode mode.
For details on each decoder see “Glossary” (p.119).
1
Press SUR.DECODE to select a surround decoder.
Each time you press the key, the surround decoder
changes.
You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoders when headphones are
connected or when “Surround Back” in the “Setup” menu is set to “None”.
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct)
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the unit plays back the
selected source with the least circuitry in order to reduce the
electrical noise from other circuitry (such as the front display). It
allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality.
1
Press PURE DIRECT.
Each time you press the key, the Pure Direct mode is
enabled or disabled.
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the following functions are not available.
– Some settings for the speakers or sound programs
– Operating the on-screen menu
– Using the multi-zone function
– Audio output from the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks
– Viewing information on the front display (when not in operation)
bPro Logic
Uses the Dolby Pro Logic decoder suitable for all
sources.
bPLIIx Movie
Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for movies.
bPLII Movie
bPLIIx Music
Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for music.
bPLII Music
bPLIIx Game
Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for games.
bPLII Game
Neo:6 Cinema Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder suitable for movies.
Neo:6 Music Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder suitable for music.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
ProLogic
VOL.
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
PUREDIRECT
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
ENE
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
PURE DIRECT
SUR.DECODE
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 50
Enjoying compressed music with enhanced
sound (Compressed Music Enhancer)
Compressed Music Enhancer adds depth and breadth to the
sound, allowing you to enjoy a dynamic sound close to the original
sound before it was compressed. This function can be used along
with any other sound modes.
1
Press ENHANCER.
Each time you press the key, Compressed Music Enhancer
is enabled or disabled.
Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on signals whose sampling
rate is over 48 kHz.
You can also use “Enhancer” (p.77) in the “Option” menu to enable/disable
Compressed Music Enhancer.
Enjoying surround sound with headphones
(SILENT CINEMA)
You can enjoy surround or sound field effects, like a multichannel
speaker system, with stereo headphones by connecting the
headphones to the PHONES jack and selecting a sound program
or a surround decoder.
SW
C
L
SL SR
ENHANCER
R
Enhancer On
VOL.
SBL SBR
“ENHANCER” lights up
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENHANCER
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 51
You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or
selecting from registered radio stations.
The radio frequencies differ depending on the country or region where the unit is
being used. The explanation of this section uses a display with frequencies used
in U.K. and Europe models.
If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the FM/AM
antennas.
Setting the frequency steps
(Asia and General models only)
At the factory, the frequency step setting is set to 50 kHz for FM and
9 kHz for AM. Depending on your country or region, set the
frequency steps to 100 kHz for FM and 10 kHz for AM.
1
Set the unit to standby mode.
2
When holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel,
press MAIN ZONE z.
3
Press PROGRAM repeatedly to select “TU”.
4
Press STRAIGHT to select “FM100/AM10”.
5
Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby
mode and turn it on again.
Selecting a frequency for reception
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
2
Press BAND to select a band (FM or AM).
3
Use the following keys to set a frequency.
TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the
key for about a second to search stations automatically.
Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to
select 98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT).
“TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio
station.
“STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received.
“Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of
reception range.
You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM
radio reception in “FM Mode” (p.77) in the “Option” menu. When the signal
reception for an FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may
improve it.
Listening to FM/AM radio
MAIN ZONE z
STRAIGHTPROGRAM
TUFM50/AM9
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
VOL.
SBL SBR
FM87.50MHz
VOL.
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
FM98.50MHz
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
PRE
S
ET
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
TUNING
BAND
TUNER
Numeric keys
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 52
Registering favorite radio stations (presets)
You can register up to 40 radio stations as presets. Once you have
registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their
preset numbers.
You can automatically register FM radio stations that have strong signals by using
“Auto Preset” (p.55).
Registering a radio station
Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number.
1
Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.51)
to tune into the desired radio station.
2
Hold down MEMORY for more than 2 seconds.
The first time that you do register a station, the selected
radio station will be registered to the preset number “01”.
Thereafter, each radio station you select will be registered
to the next empty (unused) preset number after the most
recently registered number.
To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning
into the desired radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and
then press MEMORY again.
Selecting a preset station
Tune into a registered radio station by selecting its preset number.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
2
Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired radio
station.
You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by
using the numeric keys after pressing PRESET once.
“No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered.
“Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered.
“Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered.
To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.55).
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
VOL.
01:FM98.50MHz
SBL SBR
Preset number
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
STEREO
TUNED
VOL.
02:Empty
SBL SBR
“Empty” (not in use) or the frequency currently registered
STEREO
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
01:FM98.50MHz
PRESET
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
MEMORY
PRESET
TUNER
Numeric keys
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 53
Radio Data System tuning
(U.K. and Europe models only)
Radio Data System is a data transmission system used by FM
stations in many countries. The unit can receive various types of
Radio Data System data, such as “Program Service”, “Program
Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time”, when it is tuned into a Radio
Data System broadcasting station.
Displaying the Radio Data System
information
1
Tune into the desired Radio Data System
broadcasting station.
We recommend using “Auto Preset” to tune into the Radio Data System
broadcasting stations (p.55).
2
Press INFO.
Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes.
About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for
the displayed item appears.
“Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text”, and “Clock Time” are not
displayed if the radio station does not provide the Radio Data System
service.
Receiving traffic information
automatically
When “TUNER” is selected as the input source, the unit
automatically receives traffic information. To enable this function,
follow the procedure below to set the traffic information station.
1
When “TUNER” is selected as the input source,
press OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Traffic Program”
(TrafficProgram) and press ENTER.
The traffic information station search will start in 5 seconds.
Press ENTER again to start the search immediately.
To search upward/downward from the current frequency, press the cursor
keys (q/w) while “READY” is displayed.
To cancel the search, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display.
The following screen appears for about 3 seconds when the
search finishes.
“TP Not Found” appears for about 3 seconds when no traffic information
stations are found.
Program Service Program service name
Program Type Current program type
Radio Text Information on the current program
Clock Time Current time
DSP Program Sound mode name
Audio Decoder Decoder name
Frequency Frequency
STEREO
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
ProgramType
INFO
Item name
STEREO
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
CLASSICS
9850
Information
STEREO
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
TPFM101.30MHz
FINISH
Traffic information station (frequency)
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
INFO
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 54
Operating the radio on the TV
You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the
TV.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
The playback screen is displayed on the TV.
Playback screen
1 Radio station information
Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected
band (FM/AM) and frequency.
(U.K. and Europe models only)
When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.53), the
Radio Data System information (“Program Service”, “Program Type,”
“Radio Text” and “Clock Time”) is also displayed.
2 Band icon
(Except for U.K. and Europe models)
Select this icon and press ENTER to switch between FM and AM.
3 TUNED/STEREO indicators
“TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station.
“STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received.
4 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
2
1
3
4
Menu Submenu Function
Manual Tuning
FM
(U.K. and Europe models only)
Switches to FM/AM.
AM
Tuning (+/-) Selects a frequency.
Auto (+/-) Selects a radio station automatically.
Memory
Registers the selected station as
presets.
Direct Enters a frequency directly.
Browse
Moves to the browse screen (preset
station list).
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows
the background. Press one of the
menu operation keys to redisplay it.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
TUNER
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 55
Browse screen
1 Preset station list
Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys to select a preset
station and press ENTER to tune into it.
2 Preset number
3 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
Menu Submenu Function
Utility
Memory
Registers the current station to the
preset number selected in the list.
Auto Preset
Automatically registers FM radio
stations with strong signals (up to 40
stations).
Clear Preset
Clear the preset station selected in the
list.
Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations.
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the
list.
1 Page Down
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows
the background. Press one of the
menu operation keys to redisplay it.
3
2
1
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back iPod music En 56
You can play back iPod music on the unit using a USB cable
supplied with the iPod.
Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or software
version of the iPod.
To play back iPod videos on the unit, an Apple Composite AV Cable (not supplied)
is required. Connect the USB and composite video plugs of the Apple Composite
AV cable to the USB jack and VIDEO AUX (VIDEO) jack on the front panel. To
select a video, operate the iPod itself in the simple play mode (p.58).
Connecting an iPod
Connect your iPod to the unit with the USB cable supplied with the
iPod.
1
Connect the USB cable to the iPod.
2
Connect the USB cable to the USB jack.
The iPod charges while it is connected to the unit. If you set the unit to standby
mode while the iPod is charging, the iPod continues to charge up to 4 hours. If
“Network Standby” (p.95) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, it continues to change
until full.
Disconnect the iPod from the USB jack when it is not in use.
Playing back iPod music
Supported iPods (as of January 2012)
iPod touch, iPod nano (2nd gen. to 6th gen.)
iPhone 4S, iPhone 4, iPhone 3GS, iPhone 3G, iPhone
iPad2, iPad
BD/DVD
PHONES
TONE CONTROL
SILENT
CINEMA
PROGRAM
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
USB
The unit (front)
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
Connected
USB
PLAYBACK Playing back iPod music En 57
Playback of iPod content
Follow the procedure below to operate the iPod contents and start
playback.
You can control the iPod with the menu displayed on the TV screen.
1
Press USB to select “USB” as the input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
If playback is ongoing on your iPod, the playback screen is displayed.
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
To operate the iPod manually to select content or control playback, switch to the
simple play mode (p.58).
Browse screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.59) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2 List name
3 Contents list
Displays the list of iPod content. Use the cursor keys to select an item and
press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4 Item number/total
5 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
1
5
3
2
4
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
USB
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back iPod music En 58
Playback screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.59) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2 Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining
time.
Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information.
3 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys on the remote control to
control playback.
Operating the iPod itself or remote control
(simple play)
1
Press MODE to switch to the simple play mode.
The TV menu screen turns off and iPod operations are
enabled.
To display the TV menu screen, press MODE again.
2
Operate your iPod itself or the remote control to
start playback.
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
a Resumes playback from pause.
s Stops playback.
d Stops playback temporarily.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
h
Searches forward/backward (by holding
down).
j
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
1
3
2
Operational remote control
keys
Function
Cursor keys Select an item.
ENTER Confirms the selection.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
External device
operation keys
a
Starts playback or stops playback
temporarily.
d
s Stops playback.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
h
Searches forward/backward (by holding
down).
j
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
MODE
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Playing back iPod music En 59
Repeat/shuffle settings
You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings of your iPod.
During simple play, configure the repeat/shuffle settings directly on your iPod or
press MODE to display the TV menu screen and then follow the procedure below.
1
When “USB” is selected as the input source, press
OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
Songs (Songs)
Plays back songs in random order. “x
appears in the TV screen.
Albums
(Albums)
Plays back albums in random order. “x
appears in the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One)
Plays back the current song repeatedly.
c” appears in the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs repeatedly. “v
appears in the TV screen.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
MODE
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 60
You can play back music files stored on a USB storage device on
the unit. Refer to the instruction manuals for the USB storage
device for more information.
The unit supports USB mass storage class devices (FAT16 or
FAT32 format).
The unit supports WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC and FLAC
files.
The unit is compatible with sampling rate of up to 96 kHz for WAV and FLAC files,
and 48 kHz for other files.
Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or manufacturer
of the USB storage device.
Connecting a USB storage device
1
Connect the USB storage device to the USB jack.
If the USB storage device contains many files, it may take time to load the them. In
this case, “Loading...” appears in the front display.
Disconnect the USB storage device from the USB jack when it is not in use.
Playback of USB storage device contents
Follow the procedure below to operate the USB storage device
contents and start playback.
You can control the USB memory device with the menu displayed
on the TV screen.
1
Press USB to select “USB” as the input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
If playback is ongoing on your USB storage device, the playback screen is
displayed.
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device
BD/DVD
PHONES
TONE CONTROL
SILENT
CINEMA
PROGRAM
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
USB
USB
The unit (front)
USB storage device
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
Connected
USB
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
USB
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 61
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected.
Browse screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.62) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2 List name
3 Contents list
Displays the list of USB storage device contents. Use the cursor keys to
select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4 Item number/total
5 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
1
5
3
2
4
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 62
Playback screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.62) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2 Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information.
3 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on
the remote control to control playback.
Repeat/shuffle settings
You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings for playback of USB
storage device contents.
1
When “USB” is selected as the input source, press
OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
a Resumes playback from pause.
s Stops playback.
d Stops playback temporarily.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
1
3
2
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
On (On)
Plays back songs in the current album
(folder) in random order. “x” appears on
the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One)
Plays back the current song repeatedly.
c” appears on the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs in the current album
(folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the
TV screen.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 63
You can play back music files stored on your PC or
DLNA-compatible NAS on the unit.
To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router
(p.30). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address)
are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu.
The unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC
and FLAC files.
The unit is compatible with sampling rates of up to 96 kHz for WAV and FLAC files,
and 48 kHz for other files.
To play back FLAC files, you need to install server software that supports sharing
of FLAC files via DLNA on your PC or use a NAS that supports FLAC files.
Media sharing setup
To play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible
NAS, first you need to configure the media sharing setting on each
music server.
For a PC with Windows Media Player
installed
1
Check that Windows Media Player 11 or later is
installed on your PC.
2
In the media sharing settings, enable media sharing
and allow media to be shared with the device.
For a PC or a NAS with other DLNA server
software installed
Refer to the instruction manual for the device or software and
configure the media sharing settings.
Playback of PC music contents
Follow the procedure below to operate the PC music contents and
start playback.
You can control the PC/NAS with the menu displayed on the TV
screen.
1
Press NET repeatedly to select “SERVER” as the
input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
If playback of a music file selected from the unit is ongoing on your PC, the
playback screen is displayed.
2
Use the cursor keys to select a music server and
press ENTER.
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
NET
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 64
3
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected.
Browse screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.65) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2 List name
3 Contents list
Displays the list of PC content. Use the cursor keys to select an item and
press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4 Item number/total
5 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
1
5
3
2
4
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 65
Playback screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.65) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2 Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information.
3 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on
the remote control to control playback.
You can also use a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control
playback. For details, see “DMC Control” (p.80).
Repeat/shuffle settings
You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings for the playback of PC
music content.
1
When “SERVER” is selected as the input source,
press OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
a Resumes playback from pause.
s Stops playback.
d Stops playback temporarily.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation
keys to redisplay it.
1
3
2
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
On (On)
Plays back songs in the current album
(folder) in random order. “x” appears on
the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One)
Plays back the current song repeatedly.
c” appears on the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs in the current album
(folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the
TV screen.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Listening to Internet radio En 66
You can listen to Internet radio stations from all over the world.
You can control the Internet radio with the menu displayed on the
TV screen.
To use this function, the unit must be connected to the Internet (p.30). You can
check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly
assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu.
This service may be discontinued without notice.
You may not be able to receive some Internet radio stations.
The unit uses the vTuner Internet radio station database service.
1
Press NET repeatedly to select “NET RADIO” as the
input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If an Internet radio station is selected, playback starts and
the playback screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
Listening to Internet radio
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
NET
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Listening to Internet radio En 67
Browse screen
1 Playback indicator
2 List name
3 Contents list
Displays the list of Internet radio content. Use the cursor keys to select an
item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4 Item number/total
5 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
You can register your favorite Internet radio stations to the “Bookmarks” folder by
accessing the following website with the web browser on your PC. To use this
feature, you need the unit’s vTuner ID and your e-mail address in order to create
your personal account. You can find the vTunerID (MAC address of the unit) in
“Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu.
http://yradio.vtuner.com/
Playback screen
1 Playback indicator
2 Playback information
Displays the station name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
3 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s) on the remote
control to control playback.
Some information may not be available depending on the station.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
1
5
3
2
4
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control s Stops playback.
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
1
3
2
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) En 68
The AirPlay function allows you to play back iTunes/iPod music on
the unit via network.
To use this function, the unit and your PC or iPod must be connected to the same
router (p.30). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP
address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.101) in the “Information”
menu.
Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents
Follow the procedure below to play back iTunes/iPod music
contents on the unit.
1
Turn on the unit, and start iTunes on the PC or
display the playback screen on the iPod.
If the iTunes/iPod recognizes the unit, the AirPlay icon
( ) appears.
If the icon does not appear, check whether the unit and PC/iPod are
connected to the router properly.
2
On the iTunes/iPod, click (tap) the AirPlay icon and
select the unit (network name of the unit) as the
audio output device.
3
Select a song and start playback.
The unit automatically selects “AirPlay” as the input source and
starts playback.
The playback screen is displayed on the TV.
Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay)
Supported iTunes/iPods (as of January 2012)
iTunes 10.2.2 or later (Windows/Mac)
iPod touch, iPhone or iPad with iOS 4.3.3 or later
PC
iTunes
Router
Playback starts
iPod
Starts playback
on iTunes
or iPod
The unit
iTunes (example) iPod (example)
iTunes (example) iPod (example)
Network name of the unit
PLAYBACK Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) En 69
The playback screen is available only when your TV is connected to the unit via
HDMI.
You can turn on the unit automatically when starting playback on iTunes or iPod by
setting “Network Standby” (p.95) in the “Setup” menu to “On”.
You can edit the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on
iTunes/iPod in “Network Name” (p.96) in the “Setup” menu.
If you select the other input source on the unit during playback, playback on the
iTunes/iPod stops automatically.
To adjust the unit’s volume from the iTunes/iPod, set “Volume Interlock” (p.80) in
the “Input” menu to “Limited” (default) or “Full”.
Playback screen
1 Playback indicator
2 Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining
time.
3 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on
the remote control to control playback.
To control iTunes playback with the remote control of the unit, you need to
configure the iTu nes preferences to enable iTunes control from remote speakers
in advance.
Caution
When you use iTunes/iPod controls to adjust volume, the volume may be
unexpectedly loud. This could result in damage to the unit or speakers. If the
volume suddenly increases during playback, stop playback on the iTunes/iPod
immediately.
1
3
2
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
a Resumes playback from pause.
d Stops playback temporarily.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation
keys to redisplay it.
iTunes (example of English version)
Check this box
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 70
The multi-zone function allows you to play back different input
sources in the room where the unit is installed (main zone) and in
another room (Zone2).
For example, while you are watching TV in the living room (main
zone), another person can listen to radio in the study room (Zone2).
Analog audio sources (including FM/AM radio), and USB and network sources
can be output to Zone2. To listen to the playback of an external device in Zone2,
you need to connect the device to the AUDIO jacks (AV 5–6 or AUDIO 1–2 jacks)
of the unit. The party mode (p.73) allows you to play back the same audio output
in main zone as Zone2, whatever the input audio signal type.
Preparing Zone2
Connect the device that will be used in Zone2 to the unit. The
connection method varies depending on the amplifier being used
(the unit or an external amplifier).
Using the units internal amplifier
Connect the speakers placed in Zone2 to the unit with speaker
cables.
To utilize the EXTRA SP terminals for Zone2 speakers, set “Power
Amp Assign” (p.88) in the “Setup” menu to “7ch +1ZONE” after
connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet.
When Zone2 output is enabled (p.72), the surround back speakers in the main
zone do not output sound.
Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone)
Caution
Remove the unit’s power cable from the AC wall outlet before connecting
speakers or an external amplifier.
Ensure that the core wires of the speaker cable do not touch one another or
come into contact with the unit’s metal parts. Doing so may damage the unit
or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will
appear on the front display when the unit is turned on.
Living room (main zone)
Study room (Zone2)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
12
3
45
76
9
The unit (rear)
Main zone
Zone2
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 71
Using an external amplifier
Connect the external amplifier (with volume control) placed in
Zone2 to the unit with a stereo pin cable.
Operating the unit from Zone2
(remote connection)
You can operate the unit and external devices from Zone2 using the
supplied remote control if you connect an infrared signal
receiver/emitter to the unit’s REMOTE IN/OUT jacks.
To operate external devices with the supplied remote control, you must register a
remote control code for each device before using (p.105).
FRONT CEN
T
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
FM
12V
0.1A
ZONE2
OUT
L
R
AUDIO
L
R
12
3
45
76
9
QW
The unit (rear)
ZONE2 OUT jacks
Zone2
Main zone
External amplifier
Audio input
(analog stereo)
3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
O
OPTICAL
(
TV
)
X
IAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
IN
OUT
REMOTE
The unit (rear)
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
Infrared signal
transmitter
External device
(such as a CD player)
Remote control
Infrared signal
receiver
Zone2
Main zone
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 72
Remote connections between Yamaha products
An infrared signal transmitter is not required if you are using
Yamaha products that support remote connections, as the unit
does. You can transmit remote control signals by connecting the
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks with monaural mini-jack cables and an
infrared signal receiver.
Controlling Zone2
1
Set MAIN/ZONE2 to “ZONE2”.
2
Press RECEIVER z.
Each time you press the key, Zone2 output is enabled or
disabled.
When Zone2 output is enabled, “ZONE2” lights up in the
front display.
3
Use the following keys to select an input source.
V-AUX: VIDEO AUX (AUDIO) jacks (on the front panel)
AV 5–6: AV 5–6 (AUDIO) jacks
AUDIO 1–2: AUDIO 1–2 jacks
TUNER: FM/AM radio
USB: USB jack (on the front panel)
NET: NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a desired
network source)
PHONO: PHONO jacks (except for U.S.A. and Canada
models)
You cannot select USB and network sources exclusively for each zone. For
example, if you select “SERVER” for Zone2 when “USB” is selected for the
main zone, the input source for the main zone also switches to “SERVER”.
IN
OUT
REMOTE
IN
OUT
REMOTE
Remote control
Infrared signal
receiver
Yamaha products
(up to six, including the unit)
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
Zone2
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
5
6
7
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
AV 5–6
AUDIO 1–2
TUNER
USB
NET
MAIN/ZONE2
RECEIVER z
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 73
4
Start playback on the external device or select a
radio station.
Refer to the instruction manual for the external device.
For details on the following operations, see the
corresponding pages.
Listening to FM/AM radio (p.51)
Playing back iPod music (p.56)
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device
(p.60)
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)
(p.63)
Listening to Internet radio (p.66)
Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay)
(p.68)
The on-screen operations are not available for Zone2. Use the front display
to control Zone2.
AirPlay is available in Zone2 only when Airplay playback is ongoing in the
main zone.
To set the sleep timer (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off), press SLEEP
repeatedly. The Zone2 output will be disabled after a specified period of
time.
To adjust the Zone2 volume, press VOLUME or MUTE (when using the
unit’s internal amplifier). When using an external amplifier, use the volume
control on it.
Enjoying the same source in multiple
rooms (party mode)
The party mode allows you to play back in Zone2 the same music
that is being played back in the main zone. During the party mode,
stereo playback is automatically selected for all zones. Utilize this
function when you want to use main zone music as background
music for a house party.
1
Pr ess PARTY.
Each time you press the key, the party mode is turned on or
off.
When the party mode is turned on, “PARTY” lights up in the
front display.
If the party mode does not work on Zone2, set “Party Mode Set” (p.97) in
the “Setup” menu to “Enable” (default).
Caution
To avoid unexpected noise, never play back DTS-CDs in Zone2.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
PR
OG
RAM
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
MUSI
C
NE
T
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
SLEEP
VOLUME
MUTE
PARTY
PLAYBACK Viewing the current status En 74
Switching information on the front display
1
Press INFO.
Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes.
About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for
the displayed item appears.
Available items vary depending on the selected input source. The displayed
item can also be applied separately to each input source group.
Viewing the status information on the TV
1
Press DISPLAY.
The following information is displayed on the TV.
2
To close the information display, press DISPLAY.
Viewing the current status
Input source group Item
HDMI 1–5
V-AUX
AV 16
AUDIO 1–2
Input (input source name), DSP Program (sound
mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
TUNER
Frequency (frequency), DSP Program (sound mode
name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
* (U.K. and Europe models only)
Radio Data System data is also available when the unit is
tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.53).
USB
SERVER
AirPlay
Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album
name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio
Decoder (decoder name)
* During simple playback of iPod:
Input (input source name), DSP Program (sound mode
name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
VOL.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
AudioDecoder
Item name
VOL.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
ProLogic
Information
NET RADIO
Song (song title), Album (album name), Station
(station name), DSP Program (sound mode name),
Audio Decoder (decoder name)
PHONO
(Except for U.S.A. and Canada models)
Input (input source name), DSP Program (sound
mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
Input source group Item
Input source/
Party mode
status
Audio format/
Decoder
Compressed Music Enhancer status
CINEMA DSP status
Sound
mode
Volume
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
INFO
DISPLAY
PLAYBACK Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 75
You can configure separate playback settings for different playback sources. This
menu is available on the front panel (or on the TV screen), allowing you to easily
configure settings during playback.
1
Press OPTION.
Front display
TV screen
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Option menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected input source.
Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display.
Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu)
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
ToneControl
OPTION
Item Function Page
Tone Control
(Tone Control)
Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency
range of sounds.
76
Adaptive DRC
(Adaptive DRC)
Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to
minimum) is automatically adjusted when the volume
is adjusted.
76
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode
(CINEMA DSP 3D)
Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D. 76
Dialogue Adjust
(Dialog Adjust)
Dialogue Level
(Dialog Lvl)
Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. 76
Dialogue Lift
(Dialog Lift)
Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. 76
Extended Surround
(EXTD Surround)
Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources
when surround back speakers are used.
77
Volume Trim
(Volume Trim)
Input Trim
(In.Trim)
Corrects volume differences between input sources. 77
Subwoofer
Trim (SW.Trim)
Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. 77
Enhancer
(Enhancer)
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer. 77
Video Mode
(Video Mode)
Enables/disables the video signal processing
settings configured in the “Setup” menu.
77
FM Mode
(FM Mode)
Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio
reception.
77
Traffic Program
(TrafficProgram)
(U.K. and Europe models only)
Automatically searches for a traffic information
station.
53
Repeat
(Repeat)
Configures the repeat setting for the iPod (p.59),
USB storage device (p.62), or media server (p.65).
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Configures the shuffle setting for the iPod (p.59),
USB storage device (p.62), or media server (p.65).
PLAYBACK Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 76
Tone Control (Tone Control)
Adjusts the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) of sounds.
Choices
Treble (Treble), Bass (Bass)
Setting range
-6.0 dB to Bypass (Bypass) to +6.0 dB, *0.5 dB increments
Default
Bypass (Bypass)
If you set an extreme value, sounds may not match those from other channels.
Adjusting with the front panel controls
a Press TONE CONTROL to select “Treble” or “Bass”.
b Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment.
Adaptive DRC (Adaptive DRC)
Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted
when the volume level is adjusted. When it is set to “On”, it is useful for listening to
playback at a low volume at night.
Settings
If “On” is selected, the dynamic range becomes narrow at a low volume and wide at a
high volume.
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (CINEMA DSP 3D)
Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D (p.48). If this function is set to “On”, CINEMA DSP
3D functions with the selected sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo).
Settings
Dialogue Adjust (Dialog Adjust)
Adjusts the volume or perceive height of dialogue sounds.
Dialogue Level (Dialog Lvl)
Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. If dialogue sounds cannot be heard clearly, you
can turn up its volume by increasing this setting.
Setting range
0 to 3
Default
0
Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift)
Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. If the dialogue sounds as if it is
coming from below the TV screen, you can raise its perceived height by increasing this
setting.
This setting is available only when one of the following conditions is met.
One of the sound programs (except for 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is selected when presence speakers
are used.
Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) (p.48) is working.
Setting range
0 to 5 (The bigger the value the higher the position)
Default
0
On (On) Automatically adjusts the dynamic range.
Off (Off) (default) The dynamic range is not automatically adjusted.
Volume: low Volume: high
Input level Input level
On
Off
On
Off
Output level
Output level
On (On) (default) Enables CINEMA DSP 3D.
Off (Off) Disables CINEMA DSP 3D.
Ideal position
PLAYBACK Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 77
Extended Surround (EXTD Surround)
Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources when surround back speakers
are used.
Settings
Some Dolby Digital EX or DTS-ES sources do not contain a flag for reproducing surround back channel. In
this case, the unit reproduces the signals in 5.1-channel if “Extended Surround” is set to “Auto”. To
reproduce the signals in 6.1 or 7.1-channel, set it to “bPLIIx Movie”, “bPLIIx Music”, or “EX/ES”.
Volume Trim (Volume Trim)
Fine-adjusts volume difference between input sources or subwoofer volume.
Input Trim (In.Trim)
Corrects volume differences between input sources. If you are bothered by volume
differences when switching between input sources, use this function to correct it.
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
Setting range
-6.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Default
0.0 dB
Subwoofer Trim (SW.Trim)
Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume.
Setting range
-6.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Default
0.0 dB
Enhancer (Enhancer)
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50).
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
You can also use ENHANCER on the remote control to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer
(p.50).
Settings
Default
TUNER, USB, (network sources): On (On)
Others: Off (Off)
Video Mode (Video Mode)
Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio) settings
configured in “Processing” (p.92) in the “Setup” menu.
Settings
FM Mode (FM Mode)
Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception.
Settings
Auto (Auto)
(default)
Automatically selects the most suitable decoder if signals that contain
surround back channel signals are input, and reproduces the signals
in 6.1- or 7.1-channel. If two surround back speakers are connected,
the unit reproduces the 5.1-channel signals in 7.1-channel.
bPLIIx Movie
(bPLIIxMo)
Always reproduces signals in 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic
IIx Movie decoder. This setting is available only when two surround
back speakers are connected.
bPLIIx Music
(bPLIIxMu)
Always reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro
Logic IIx Music decoder. This setting is available only when one or two
surround back speakers are connected.
EX/ES (EX/ES)
Automatically selects the Dolby EX or DTS-ES decoder, and
reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel.
Off (Off)
Always reproduces signals in their original channels. (Even when
DTS-ES or Dolby Digital EX signal is input, the unit reproduces the
signal in 5.1-channel.)
Off (Off) Disables Compressed Music Enhancer.
On (On) Enables Compressed Music Enhancer.
Processing
(Processing)
Enables the video signal processing.
Direct (Direct)
(default)
Disables the video signal processing.
Stereo (Stereo)
(default)
Receives FM radio in stereo sounds.
Mono (Mono) Receives FM radio in monaural sounds.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) En 78
CONFIGURATIONS
You can change the input source settings using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an input source to be configured
and press the cursor key (q).
The input source of the unit also changes.
You can still switch the input source by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
4
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Input menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected input source.
Configuring input sources (Input menu)
Item Function Page
Rename/Icon Select Changes the input source name and icon. 79
Audio In
Combines the video jack of the selected input source with an
audio jack of others.
79
Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. 79
Volume Interlock
Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via
AirPlay.
80
Video Out Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. 80
DMC Control
Selects whether to allow a DLNA-compatible Digital Media
Controller (DMC) to control playback.
80
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) En 79
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the input source name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Input sources
HDMI 1–7, V-AUX, AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2, USB, PHONO*
* Except for U.S.A. and Canada models
Setup procedure
1
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a template and press the cursor key (w).
You cannot change the template or icon for “USB” when an iPod is connected.
2
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w).
3
Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
4
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
5
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Audio In
Combines the video jack of the selected input source with an audio jack of others. For
example, use this function in the following cases.
Connecting a playback device that supports HDMI video output, but not HDMI audio
output
Connecting a playback device that has component video jacks and analog stereo
jacks (such as game consoles)
Input sources
HDMI 1–7, AV 1–2
Setup procedure
(To input audio through a digital optical jack)
Select “AV1” or “AV4” and connect the device to the unit’s corresponding audio jacks
with a digital optical cable.
(To input audio through a digital coaxial jack)
Select “AV2” or “AV3” and connect the device to the unit’s corresponding audio jacks
with a digital coaxial cable.
(To input audio through analog audio jacks)
Select “AV5”, “AV6”, “AUDIO1”, or “AUDIO2”, and connect the device to the unit’s
corresponding audio jacks with a stereo pin cable.
Decoder Mode
Sets the format of digital audio playback to “DTS”.
For example, if the unit does not detect DTS audio and outputs noise, set “Decoder
Mode” to “DTS”.
Input sources
HDMI 1–7, V-AUX, AV 1–4
Settings
Auto (default) Automatically selects an audio format to match the input audio signal.
DTS Selects DTS only. (Other audio signals are not reproduced.)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) En 80
Volume Interlock
Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay.
Input sources
AirPlay
Settings
Video Out
Selects a video to be output with the audio input source.
Input sources
TUNER, (network sources), USB
Settings
Default
USB: V-AUX
Others: Off
DMC Control
Selects whether to allow DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control
playback.
Input source
SERVER
Settings
A Digital Media Controller (DMC) is a device that can control other network devices through the network.
When this function is enabled, you can control playback of the unit from DMCs (such as Windows Media
Player 12) on the same network.
You can change the settings of the SCENE function (p.44) using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a scene to be configured and
press the cursor key (q).
You can still switch the scene by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
Off Disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod.
Limited (default)
Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod within the limited range
(-80 dB to 0 dB and mute).
Full
Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod in the full range (-80 dB to
+16.5 dB and mute).
Off Does not output video.
HDMI 1–7, AV 1–6,
V-AUX
Outputs video input through the corresponding video input jacks.
Disable Does not allow DMCs to control playback.
Enable (default) Allows DMCs to control playback.
Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) En 81
4
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to change the setting.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Scene menu items
Save
Registers the unit’s current settings (input source, sound program/surround decoder,
Compressed Music Enhancer on/off, and HDMI output jack) in the selected scene.
If you have changed the input assignment for a scene, you also need to change the external device
assigned to the corresponding SCENE key (p.44).
Load
Loads the settings registered for the selected scene.
Select “DETAIL” to configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the scene
assignments.
Device Control
Recalls a selected scene and starts its playback on an external device connected to
the unit via HDMI or on a Yamaha product connected to the REMOTE OUT jack.
(SCENE link playback)
Settings
Default
SCENE1 (BD/DVD), SCENE2 (TV): HDMI Control
SCENE3 (NET), SCENE4 (RADIO): Off
To control playback of an HDMI Control-compatible device by SCENE link playback, you need to set “HDMI
Control” in the “Setup” menu to “On” and perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.123).
Detail
Displays the assignments of the selected scene.
Item Function Page
Save Registers the current settings in the selected scene. 81
Load
Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. You can
also configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the
scene assignments.
81
Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon. 82
Reset Restores the default settings for the selected scene. 82
Off Disables the SCENE link playback function.
HDMI Control
Enables SCENE link playback using HDMI Control signals. Select this
if an HDMI Control-compatible device (such as a BD/DVD player) is
connected to the unit via HDMI. It also turns on the TV if it supports
HDMI Control.
IR:
Yam aha B D/DVD 1
Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack.
IR:
Yam aha B D/DVD 2
Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack
and “IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1” does not work properly.
IR: Yamaha CD
Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha CD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack.
Input Input source to be used
HDMI Output HDMI OUT jack to be used
Mode Sound program/surround decoder to be used
Enhancer Compressed Music Enhancer on/off
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 82
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Setup procedure
1
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w).
2
Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
3
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the
entry.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
5
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Reset
Restores the default settings (p.44) for the selected scene.
You can change the settings of the sound programs and surround decoders using the
TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a sound program to be
configured and press the cursor key (q).
You can still switch the sound program by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
Configuring sound programs/surround
decoders (Sound Program menu)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 83
4
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
To restore the default settings for the selected sound program, select “Reset”.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Sound Program menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected sound program or surround decoder.
Settings for sound programs
Item Function Settings
Decode Type
Selects a surround decoder to be used
in combination with the selected sound
program.
bPLIIx Movie (bPLII
Movie), Neo:6 Cinema
DSP Level Adjusts the sound field effect level.
-6 dB to +3 dB (default: 0 dB)
Higher to enhance the sound
field effect, and lower to
reduce it.
Initial Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and presence sound field
generation.
1 ms to 99 ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Surround Initial Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and surround sound field
generation.
1ms to 49ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Surround Back Initial
Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and surround back sound field
generation.
Room Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
presence sound field.
0.1 to 2.0
Higher to enhance the
broadening effect, and lower
to reduce it.
Surround Room Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
surround sound field.
Surround Back Room
Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
surround back sound field.
Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the presence sound
field.
0 to 10
Higher to enhance the
reflectivity, and lower to
reduce it.
Surround Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the surround sound
field.
Surround Back
Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the surround back
sound field.
Reverb Time
Adjust the decay time of the rear
reverberant sound.
1.0 s to 5.0 s
Higher to enrich the
reverberant sound and lower
to have clear sound.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 84
The following items are available when you select “2ch Stereo” or “7ch Stereo”.
Available items in “7ch Stereo” vary depending on the speaker system being used.
Settings for decoders
The following items are available when you set “Decode Type” of “Surround Decoder”
to “bPLIIx Music” or “Neo:6 Music”.
Reverb Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and reverberant sound
generation.
0 ms to 250 ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Reverb Level
Adjusts the volume of the reverberant
sound.
0% to 100%
Higher to strengthen the
reverberant sound, and lower
to weaken it.
Sound program
Item Function Settings
2ch Stereo Direct
Selects whether to
automatically bypass the
DSP and tone control
circuits when an analog
audio source is played
back.
Auto (default), Off
Select “Auto” to bypass the
circuits (when both “Treble”
and “Bass” are set to
“Bypass”).
7ch Stereo
Level Adjusts the entire volume. -5 to +5 (default: 0)
Front / Rear Balance
Adjusts the front and rear
volume balance.
-5 to +5 (default: 0)
Higher to enhance the front
side, and lower to enhance
the rear side.
Left / Right Balance
Adjusts the right and left
volume balance.
-5 to +5 (default: 0)
Higher to enhance the right
side, and lower to enhance
the left side.
Height Balance
Adjust the height volume
balance using the
presence speakers.
0 to 10 (default: 5)
Higher to enhance the
upside, and lower to
enhance the downside. (The
presence speakers do not
produce sounds when
“Height Balance” is set to
“0”.)
Monaural Mix
Enables/disables
monaural sound output.
Off (default), On
Item Function Settings
Decode Type Item Function Settings
bPLIIx Music
Panorama
Adjusts the broadening
effect of the front sound
field.
Off (default), On
Select “On” to wrap front right/left
channel sounds around the field
and generate a spacious sound
field in combination with the
surround sound field.
Center Width
Adjusts the broadening
effect of the center
sound field.
0 to 7 (default: 3)
Higher to enhance the broadening
effect, and lower to reduce it
(closer to center).
Dimension
Adjusts the difference in
level between the front
and surround sound
fields.
-3 to +3 (default: 0)
Higher to strengthen the front
sound field and lower to strengthen
the surround sound field.
Neo:6 Music Center Image
Adjusts the center
orientation level
(broadening effect) of
the front sound field.
0.0 to 1.0 (default: 0.3)
Higher to strengthen the center
orientation level (less broadening
effect) and lower to weaken (more
broadening effect).
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 85
You can configure the unit’s various function with the menu displayed on the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a menu.
4
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Configuring various functions (Setup menu)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 86
Setup menu items
Menu Item Function Page
Speaker
Auto Setup Automatically optimizes the speaker settings (YPAO). 35
Manual Setup
Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. 88
Configuration
Front Selects the size of the front speakers. 88
Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. 88
Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their size. 88
Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their size. 89
Front Presence Selects whether or not presence speakers are connected. 89
Subwoofer Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. 89
Extra Bass Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components. 89
Bass Cross Over Sets the lower limit of the low-frequency component that can be output from speakers whose size is set to “Small”. 89
Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position. 90
Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. 90
Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. 90
Test Tone Enables/disables the test tone output. 90
Sound
Lipsync
Delay Enable Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. 91
Auto/Manual Select Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. 91
Adjustment Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually. 91
Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. 91
Max Volume Sets the maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness. 91
Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. 92
Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level when the volume is adjusted. 92
Video Video Mode Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). 92
HDMI
HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control. You can also configure the relevant settings (such as ARC and TV audio input). 93
Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. 94
Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in standby mode. 94
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 87
Network
IP Address Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). 95
Network Standby Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from other network devices. 95
MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. 95
Network Name Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. 96
Multi Zone
Main Zone Set Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 96
Zone2 Set
Max Volume Sets the Zone2 maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness in the second zone. 97
Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. 97
Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 97
Party Mode Set Enables/disables switching to the party mode. 97
Function
Display Set
Dimmer (Front Display) Adjusts the brightness of the front display. 97
Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated. 97
Wall Paper Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. 98
Trigger Output
Trigger Mode Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. 98
Target Zone Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. 98
Memory Guard Prevents accidental changes to the settings. 99
ECO
Auto Power Down Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. 99
Eco Mode Enables/disables the eco mode (power saving mode). 99
Language Select an on-screen menu language. 100
Menu Item Function Page
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 88
Speaker (Manual Setup)
Configures the speaker settings manually.
Power Amp Assign
Selects a speaker system.
In addition to the 5.1- or 7.1-channel speaker system, various speaker configurations
are possible using the presence speakers, Zone2 speakers, or bi-amp connection.
Settings
Configuration
Configures the output characteristics of the speakers.
When you configure the speaker size, select “Large” if the woofer diameter of your speaker is 16 cm
(6-1/4”) or larger or “Small” if it is smaller than 16 cm (6-1/4”).
Front
Selects the size of the front speakers.
Settings
“Front” is automatically set to “Large” when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”.
Center
Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size.
Settings
Surround
Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their sizes.
Settings
Basic (default)
Select this option when you use a normal speaker system (not using
Zone2 speakers or a bi-amp connection).
7ch +1ZONE
Select this option when you use Zone2 speakers (p.70) in addition to
the speaker system in the main zone.
5ch BI-AMP
Select this option when you connect front speakers that support
bi-amp connections (p.19).
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency
components.
Small (default)
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components
(configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The center speaker will produce all of the center channel frequency
components.
Small (default)
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce center channel
low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None
Select this option when no center speaker is connected.
The front speakers will produce center channel audio.
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The surround speakers will produce all of the surround channel
frequency components.
Small (default)
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround channel
low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None
Select this option when no surround speakers are connected.
The front speakers will produce surround channel audio. Virtual
CINEMA DSP works when you select a sound program.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 89
Surround Back
Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their sizes.
Settings
This setting is not available when “Power Amp Assign” is set to “5ch BI-AMP”, or when “Surround” is set to
“None”.
Front Presence
Selects whether or not presence speakers are connected.
Settings
Subwoofer
Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase.
Settings
When the bass sound is lacking or unclear, switch the subwoofer phase.
Extra Bass
Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components.
Settings
This setting is not available when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”, or when “Front” is set to “Small”.
Bass Cross Over
Sets the lower limit of the low-frequency components that can be output from a speaker
whose size is set to “Small”. A frequency sound lower than the specified value will be
produced from the subwoofer or front speakers
Settings
40 Hz, 60 Hz, 80 Hz (default), 90 Hz, 100 Hz, 110 Hz, 120 Hz, 160 Hz, 200 Hz
If the volume and crossover frequency are adjustable on your subwoofer, set the volume to half and
crossover frequency to maximum.
Large x1
Select this option when one large speaker is connected.
The surround back speaker will produce all of the surround back
channel frequency components.
Large x2
Select this option when two large speakers are connected.
The surround back speakers will produce all of the surround back
channel frequency components.
Small x1
Select this option when one small speaker is connected.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel
low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
Small x2 (default)
Select this option when two small speakers are connected.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel
low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None
Select this option when no surround back speakers are connected.
The surround speakers and subwoofer (or front speakers) will
produce surround back channel audio.
Use (default) Select this option when presence speakers are connected.
None Select this option when no presence speakers are connected.
Use
Normal
(default)
Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase not
reversed). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect)
channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels.
Reverse
Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase reversed).
The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio
and low-frequency components from other channels.
None
Select this option when no subwoofer is connected. The front
speakers will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and
low-frequency components from other channels.
Off (default)
Depending on the size of the front speakers, either the subwoofer or
front speakers produce the front channel low-frequency components.
On
Both the front speakers and subwoofer produce the front channel
low-frequency components.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 90
Distance
Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position so that sounds from the
speakers reach the listening position at the same time. First, select the unit of distance
from “Meter” or “Feet”.
Choices
Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R,
Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer
Setting range
0.30 m to 24.00 m (1.0 ft to 80.0 ft), *0.05 m (0.2 ft) increments
Default
3.00 m (10.0 ft)
Level
Adjusts the volume of each speaker.
Choices
Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R,
Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer
Setting range
-10.0 dB to +10.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Default
0.0 dB
Parametric EQ
Adjusts the tone with an equalizer.
Settings
“YPAO:Flat”, “YPAO:Front”, and “YPAO:Natural” are available only when the measurement results of “Auto
Setup” have already been saved (p.35). Press ENTER again to view the measurement results.
Manual equalizer adjustment
1
Set “Parametric EQ” to “Manual” and press ENTER.
2
Press ENTER again to enter the edit screen.
3
Use the cursor keys to select a speaker and press ENTER.
To restore the default settings for all speakers, select “PEQ Data Clear” and then “OK”.
To copy the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” (p.35) to the “Manual” fields for
fine adjustment, select “PEQ Data Copy” and then an equalizer type.
4
Press ENTER to select an item.
Band: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a center frequency from the preset 7 bands
and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Frequency: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the center frequency of the selected
band and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Q: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the Q factor (bandwidth) of the selected band and
the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Setting range
Gain: -20.0 dB to +6.0 dB
Center frequency: 31.3 HZ to 16.0 kHz
Q factor: 0.500 to 10.08
5
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Test Tone
Enables/disables the test tone output. Test tone output helps you to adjust the speaker
balance or equalizer while confirming its effect.
Settings
Manual
Select this option when you want to adjust the equalizer manually.
For details, see “Manual equalizer adjustment”.
YPAO:Flat Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics.
YPAO:Front
Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics as
the front speakers.
YPAO:Natural Adjusts all speakers to achieve a natural sound.
Through Does not use the equalizer.
Off (default) Does not output test tones.
On
Outputs test tones automatically when you adjust the speaker balance
or equalizer.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 91
Sound
Configures the audio output settings.
Lipsync
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output.
Delay Enable
Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source.
Choices
HDMI 1–7, AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2
Settings
Auto/Manual Select
Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output.
Setting range
“Auto/Manual Select” is automatically set to “Manual” depending on the TV connected to the unit.
Adjustment
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually when “Auto/Manual
Select” is set to “Manual”. You can fine-adjust the audio output timing when
“Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”.
Setting range
0 ms to 500 ms (1 ms increments)
Default
0 ms
“Offset” shows the difference between automatic adjustment and fine adjustment.
Dynamic Range
Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and
DTS signals) playback.
Settings
Max Volume
Sets the maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness.
Setting range
-30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB
Default
+16.5 dB
Disable Disable the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source.
Enable (default) Enables the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source.
Auto (default)
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output automatically when
a TV that supports an automatic lipsync function is connected to the
unit via HDMI.
If necessary, you can fine-adjust the audio output timing in
“Adjustment”.
Manual
Select this option when you want to adjust the delay between video
and audio output manually.
Adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”.
Maximum (default) Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range.
Standard Optimizes the dynamic range for regular home use.
Minimum/Auto
Sets the dynamic range for clear sound even at night or at low
volumes.
When playing back Dolby TrueHD signals, the dynamic range is
automatically adjusted based on the input signal information.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 92
Initial Volume
Sets the initial volume when the receiver is turned on.
Settings
Adaptive DSP Level
Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level when the volume
is adjusted.
Settings
Video
Configures the video output settings.
Video Mode
Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio).
Settings
When “Video Mode” is set to “Direct”, the unit transmits video signals with the least circuitry in order to
reduce video output delay.
Resolution
Selects a resolution to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to
“Processing”.
Settings
If you need to select a resolution that is not supported by your TV, set “MON.CHK” (p.103) in the
“ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “SKIP” and try again. (Note that the output video may not be displayed on
your TV normally.)
Off (default)
Sets the level to the volume level of the unit when it last entered
standby mode.
On
Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB
increments).
(This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max
Volume.)
Off Does not adjust the effect level automatically.
On (default) Adjusts the effect level automatically.
Direct (default) Disables the video signal processing.
Processing
Enables the video signal processing.
Select a resolution and an aspect ratio in “Resolution” and “Aspect”.
Through Does not convert the resolution.
Auto (default) Selects a resolution automatically in accordance with TV resolution.
480p/576p, 720p,
1080i, 1080p, 4K
Output video signals with a selected resolution.
(Only the resolutions supported by your TV are selectable.)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 93
Aspect
Selects an aspect ratio to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to
“Processing”.
Settings
This setting functions only when 480i/576i or 480p/576p signals are converted into 720p, 1080i, 1080p, or
2160p (4K) signals.
HDMI
Configures the HDMI settings.
HDMI Control
Enables/disables HDMI Control (p.123).
Settings
To use HDMI control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.123) after connecting HDMI
Control-compatible devices.
TV Audio Input
Selects an audio input jack of the unit to be used for TV audio input when “HDMI
Control” is set to “On”. The unit’s input source automatically switches to TV audio when
the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner.
Settings
AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2
Default
AV 4
When using ARC to input TV audio to the unit, you cannot use the input jacks selected here for connecting
an external device because the input will be used for TV audio input.
Through (default) Does not convert the aspect ratio.
16:9 Normal
Outputs 4:3 video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either side
of the screen.
Off (default) Disables HDMI Control.
On
Enables HDMI Control.
Configure the settings in “TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and “Standby
Sync”.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 94
ARC
Enables/disables ARC (p.21) when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
Settings
You do not need to change this setting normally. In case noises are produced from the speakers connected
to the unit because TV audio signals input to the unit via ARC are not supported by the unit, set “ARC” to
“Off” and use the TV’s speakers.
Standby Sync
Select whether to use HDMI control to link the standby behavior of the TV and the unit
when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
Settings
Audio Output
Selects a device to output audio.
The “Amp” and “HDMI OUT1” settings are available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”.
Amp
Enables/disables the audio output from the speakers connected to the unit.
Settings
HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2
Enables/disables the audio output from a TV connected to the HDMI OUT jack.
Settings
Standby Through
Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the
unit is in standby mode. If this function is set to “On”, you can use the input selection
keys (HDMI 1–7) to select an HDMI input even when the unit is in standby mode (the
standby indicator on the unit blinks).
Settings
This setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”.
Off Disables ARC.
On (default) Enables ARC.
Off Does not set the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off.
On Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off.
Auto (default)
Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off only when the
unit is receiving TV audio or HDMI signals.
Off Disables the audio output from the speakers.
On (default) Enables the audio output from the speakers.
Off (default) Disables the audio output from the TV.
On Enables the audio output from the TV.
Off (default) Does not output videos/audio to the TV.
On
Outputs videos/audio to the TV.
(The unit consumes approximately 3 W of power.)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 95
Network
Configures the network settings.
IP Address
Configures the network parameters (such as IP address).
DHCP
Select whether to use a DHCP server.
Settings
Manual network settings
1
Set “DHCP” to “Off”.
2
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a parameter type and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to
select a value.
4
To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
5
To configure another network parameter, repeat steps 2 to 4.
6
To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
7
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Network Standby
Selects whether the unit can be turned on from other network devices (network
standby).
Settings
MAC Address Filter
Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices.
Filter
Enables/disables the MAC address filter.
Settings
MAC Address 1–10
Specifies the MAC addresses (up to 10) of the network devices that will be permitted
access to the unit when “Filter” is set to “On”.
Procedure
1
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “MAC Address 1–5” or “MAC Address 6–10”
and press ENTER.
2
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an MAC address number and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to
select a value.
4
To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
5
To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Off
Does not use a DHCP server. Configure the network parameters
manually. For details, see “Manual network settings”.
On (default)
Uses a DHCP server to automatically obtain the unit’s network
parameters (such as IP address).
IP Address Specifies an IP address.
Subnet Mask Specifies a subnet mask.
Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway.
DNS Server (P) Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server.
DNS Server (S) Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS server.
Off (default) Disables the network standby function.
On
Enables the network standby function.
(The unit consumes approximately 2 W of power.)
Off (default) Disables the MAC address filter.
On
Enables the MAC address filter. In “MAC Address 1–10”, specify the
MAC addresses of the network devices that will be permitted access
to the unit.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 96
Network Name
Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network
devices.
Procedure
1
Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
2
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the
entry.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Multi Zone
Configures the multi zone settings.
Main Zone Set
Configures the main zone setting.
Zone Rename
Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Procedure
1
Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
2
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the
entry.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 97
Zone2 Set
Configures the Zone2 settings.
Max Volume
Sets the Zone2 maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness.
Setting range
-30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB
Default
+16.5 dB
This setting is available only when “Power Amp Assign” (p.88) is set to “7ch +1ZONE”.
Initial Volume
Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on.
Settings
This setting is available only when “Power Amp Assign” (p.88) is set to “7ch +1ZONE”.
Zone Rename
Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen.
You can change the zone name in the same manner as “Zone Rename” in “Main Zone
Set” (p.96).
Party Mode Set
Enables/disables switching to the party mode (p.73).
Choice
Target: Zone 2
Settings
Function
Configures the functions that make the unit easier to use.
Display Set
Configures the settings related to the front display and TV screen display.
Dimmer (Front Display)
Adjusts the brightness of the front display.
Setting range
-4 to 0 (higher to brighten)
Default
0
The front display may become dark when “ECO Mode” (p.99) is set to “On”.
Short Message
Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated
(such as input selection and volume adjustment).
Settings
Off (default)
Sets the level at the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby
mode.
On
Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB
increments).
(This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max Volume”.)
Disable Disables switching to the party mode.
Enable (default)
Enables switching to the party mode. You can turn on/off the party
mode by pressing PARTY on the remote control.
On (default) Displays short messages on the TV screen.
Off Does not display short messages on the TV screen.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 98
Wall Paper
Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV.
Settings
Trigger Output
Sets the TRIGGER OUT jack to function in sync with the power status of each zone or
input switching.
Trigger Mode
Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function.
Settings
Source
Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input, switching
when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”.
Choices
HDMI 1–7, AV 1–6, V-AUX, AUDIO 1–2, TUNER, PHONO*, (network sources), USB
* Except for U.S.A. and Canada models
Settings
Manual
Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually when “Trigger
Mode” is set to “Manual”. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of
the external device connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack.
Choices
Target Zone
Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized.
Settings
Picture 1 (default),
Picture 2, Picture 3
Displays the selected image on the TV screen when there is no video
signal.
Gray
Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there is no video
signal.
Power (default)
The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the power status of the
zone specified with “Target Zone.”
Source
The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the input switching in
the zone specified with “Target Zone.”
An electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in
“Source.”
Manual
Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal
transmission with “Manual.”
Low
Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input
source specified in this option.
High (default)
Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source
specified in this option.
Low Stops the electronic signal transmission.
High (default) Transmits the electronic signal.
Main
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the power status of the main zone.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone.
Zone2
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the power status of Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the input switching in Zone2.
All (default)
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the power status of the main zone or Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone or Zone2.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 99
Memory Guard
Prevents accidental changes to the settings.
Settings
When “Memory Guard” is set to “On”, the lock icon (o) is displayed on the menu screen.
ECO
Configures the power supply settings.
Auto Power Down
Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. If you do not operate the unit for
the specified time, the unit will automatically go into standby mode.
Settings
Default
U.K. and Europe models: 8 hours
Other models: Off
Just before the unit enters standby mode, “AutoPowerDown” appears and then countdown starts in the
front display.
ECO Mode
Enables/disables the eco (power saving) mode.
When the eco mode is enabled, you can reduce the unit’s power consumption.
Settings
The new setting will take effect after the unit is restarted.
When “ECO Mode” is set to “On”, the front panel display may become dark.
If you want to play audio at high volume, set “ECO Mode” to “Off”.
Off (default) Does not protect the settings.
On Protects the settings until “Off” is selected.
Icon
Off Does not set the unit to standby mode automatically.
2 hours, 4 hours,
8 hours, 12 hours
Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit for
the specified time. For example, when “2 hours” is selected, the unit
will switch to standby mode if you do not operate it for 2 hours.
Off (default) Disables the eco mode.
On Enables the eco mode.
CONFIGURATIONS Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) En 100
Language
Select an on-screen menu language.
Settings
The information on the front display is provided in English only.
You can view information about the unit using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Information” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an information type.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
English (default) English
Japanese
French
German
Spanish
Russian
Chinese
Français
Deutsch
Español
Viewing information about the unit (Information
menu)
CONFIGURATIONS Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) En 101
Types of information
Audio Signal
Displays information about the current audio signal.
Even when the unit is set to output bitstream signals directly, the signal may be converted depending on the
specifications and settings of the playback device.
Video Signal
Displays information about the current video signal.
HDMI Monitor
Displays information about the TVs connected to the HDMI OUT jacks.
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to switch between “OUT1” and “OUT2”.
Network
Displays the network information on the unit.
System
Displays the system information on the unit.
If the unit detects a newer firmware over the network, “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of
the “Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in this screen. You
can update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in this screen and following the procedure in “Updating
the unit’s firmware” (p.110).
Zone
Displays information about Zone2.
Input
Format Audio format of the input signal
Channel
The number of source channels in the input signal
(front/surround/LFE)
For example, “5.1 (3/2/0.1)” means 5.1ch in total
(3 front channels, 2 surround channels, and LFE).
Sampling The number of samples per second of the input digital signal
Bitrate The amount of data per second of the input bitstream signal
Dialogue The dialogue normalization level of the input bitstream signal
Output The speaker terminals from which signals are output
HDMI Signal Presence or absence of HDMI signal input/output
HDMI Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI)
Analog Resolution
Resolutions of input signal (analog) and signal output at the MONITOR OUT
jacks (analog)
Interface TV interface
Video Resolution Resolutions supported by the TV
IP Address IP address
Subnet Mask Subnet mask
Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway
DNS Server (P) The IP address of the primary DNS server
DNS Server (S) The IP address of the secondary DNS server
MAC Address MAC address
Network Name Network name (the unit’s name on the network)
Status The connection status of the NETWORK jack
Remote ID The unit’s remote control ID setting (p.102)
TV Format The unit’s video signal type (p.103)
Speaker Impedance The speaker impedance setting of the unit (p.102)
System ID System ID number
Firmware Version The version of firmware installed on the unit
Input The input source selected for Zone2
Volume The volume setting for Zone2
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 102
Configure the system settings of the unit while viewing the front display.
1
Set the unit to standby mode.
2
While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE
z.
3
Press PROGRAM to select an item.
4
Press STRAIGHT to select a setting.
5
Press
MAIN ZONE
z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on
again.
The new settings take effect.
ADVANCED SETUP menu items
Changing the speaker impedance setting (SP IMP.)
Change the unit’s speaker impedance settings depending on the impedance of the
speakers connected.
Settings
Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID)
Change the unit’s remote control ID so that it matches the remote control’s ID (default:
ID1). When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each remote control with a
unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver.
Settings
ID1 (default), ID2
Changing the remote control ID of the remote control
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be
automatically canceled.
1
Press CODE SET on the remote control.
2
Press RECEIVER.
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “5019” (ID1) or “5020” (ID2).
Once the remote control ID is registered successfully, SOURCE blinks twice.
If it blinks six times, registration failed. Repeat from Step 1.
The registered remote control codes (p.105) are not cleared even if you change the remote control ID.
Configuring the system settings
(ADVANCED SETUP menu)
Item Function Page
SP IMP. Changes the speaker impedance setting. 102
REMOTE ID Selects the unit’s remote control ID. 102
TU
(Asia and General models only)
Changes the FM/AM tuning frequency setting.
103
TV FORMAT Switches the video signal type. 103
MON.CHK Removes the limitation on HDMI video output. 103
INIT Restores the default settings. 103
UPDATE Updates the firmware. 104
VERSION Checks the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. 104
MAIN ZONE z
STRAIGHTPROGRAM
6 MIN
Select this option when you connect 6-ohm speakers to the unit. You
can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
8 MIN (default)
Select this option when you connect 8-ohm or higher speakers to the
unit.
SPIMP.8MIN
REMOTEIDID1
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 103
Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TU)
(Asia and General models only)
Change the FM/AM tuning frequency setting of the unit depending on your country or
region.
Settings
Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT)
Switch the video signal type of the unit so that it matches to the format of your TV.
Settings
NTSC, PAL
Default
U.S.A., Canada, Korea and General models: NTSC
Other models: PAL
Removing the limitation on HDMI video output
(MON.CHK)
The unit automatically detects resolutions supported by a TV connected to the HDMI
OUT jack.
Disable the monitor check function if you want to specify a resolution in “Resolution”
(p.92) when the unit cannot detect the TV’s resolution or when you want to specify a
different resolution than the detected resolution.
Settings
Reset to “YES” if the unit becomes inoperable because video from the unit cannot be displayed on the TV
after “MON.CHK” has been set to “SKIP”.
Restoring the default settings (INIT)
Restores the default settings for the unit.
Choices
FM100/AM10
Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 100-kHz
steps and AM by 10-kHz steps.
FM50/AM9 (default)
Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 50-kHz steps
and AM by 9-kHz steps.
TUFM50/AM9
TVFORMATNTSC
YES (default)
Enables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a
resolution supported by the TV only.)
SKIP
Disables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a
specified resolution regardless of compatibility with the TV.)
VIDEO Restores the default settings for video configurations.
ALL Restores the default settings for the unit.
CANCEL Does not perform an initialization.
MON.CHKYES
INITCANCEL
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 104
Updating the firmware (UPDATE)
New firmware that provides additional features or product improvements will be
released as needed. Updates can be downloaded from our website. If the unit is
connected to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network. For details,
refer to the information supplied with updates.
Firmware update procedure
Do not perform this procedure unless firmware update is necessary. Also, make sure
you read the information supplied with updates before updating the firmware.
1
Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “USB” or “NETWORK” and press INFO to
start firmware update.
Choices
If the unit detects newer firmware over the network, the corresponding message will be displayed after
ON SCREEN is pressed. In this case, you can also update the unit’s firmware by following the procedure in
“Updating the unit’s firmware” (p.110).
Checking the firmware version (VERSION)
Check the version of firmware currently installed on the unit.
You can also check the firmware version in “System” (p.101) in the “Information” menu.
USB Update the firmware using a USB memory device.
NETWORK Update the firmware via the network.
UPDATEUSB
VERSIONxx.xx
CONFIGURATIONS Controlling external devices with the remote control En 105
You can use the unit’s remote control to operate external devices
(such as BD/DVD players) if you have registered the remote control
code of the external device.
You cannot control an external device that does not have a remote control sensor.
Ensure that the remote control ID of the external device is set to “ID1”. If any other
ID is selected, the remote control operations may not work properly.
If the unit’s remote control is without batteries for more than 2 minutes, the
registered codes may be cleared. If this happens, insert new batteries and register
the codes again.
Under the unit’s default settings, the amplifier code (Yamaha: 5098) is set for all
the input selection keys. With this setting, you can control HDMI
Control-compatible devices connected to the unit with the remote control. (This
function may not work depending on the specification of the external device.)
Registering the remote control code for a TV
You can use the unit’s remote control to operate a TV if you have
registered its remote control code.
You can also register your TV’s remote control code to the unit’s input selection
keys (p.106). This would allow you to use the cursor keys or numeric keys to
operate the TV (this function may not be available on some TV models).
(China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only)
You can also assign a function to each key using the learning function (p.107).
1
Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM
to find your TV’s remote control code.
If there are multiple remote control codes, register the first code in the list.
If that does not work, try the other codes.
2
Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 2.
3
Press TV z.
4
Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote
control code.
Once the remote control code is successfully registered, SOURCE
blinks twice.
If it blinks six times, registration has failed. Repeat from Step 2.
TV operations
Once you have registered the remote control code for your TV, you
can control it using the TV operation keys, regardless of the input
source selected on the unit.
Controlling external devices with the remote control
TV operation keys
INPUT Switches the video inputs of the TV.
MUTE Mutes the audio output of the TV.
TV VOL Adjust the volume of the TV.
TV CH Switch the channels of the TV
TV z Turns on/off the TV.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
CODE SET
TV z
SOURCE
Numeric keys
TV operation keys
CONFIGURATIONS Controlling external devices with the remote control En 106
Registering the remote control codes for
playback devices
You can use the unit’s remote control to operate playback devices if
you have registered their remote control codes. You can also use
the input selection keys to change the playback devices that are
controlled by the remote control, because their remote control
codes are assigned to the input selection keys.
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)
If you assign the remote control code for an external device to the star () key, you
can operate the device with the remote control without switching the input source
after pressing the star key.
(China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only)
You can also assign a function to each key using the learning function (p.107).
1
Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM
to find the remote control code for your playback
device.
If there are multiple remote control codes, register the first code in the list. If
that does not work, try the other codes.
2
Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 2.
3
Press the input selection key.
For example, press HDMI 1 to set the remote control code
for the playback device connected to the HDMI 1 jack.
4
Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote
control code.
Once the remote control code is registered successfully, SOURCE
blinks twice.
If it blinks six times, registration has failed. Repeat from Step 2.
For details on how to register a remote control code to a SCENE key, refer to
“Configuring scene assignments” (p.44).
Playback device operations
Once you have registered the remote control code for your
playback device, you can control it using the following keys after
selecting the input source or scene.
By pressing SOURCE or RECEIVER, you can switch the devices (the unit or
external device) that are operated by the menu operation keys, DISPLAY and
numeric keys. You can operate the unit after pressing RECEIVER (lights up in
orange), and an external device after pressing SOURCE (lights up in green). For
example, if you register the remote control code of your external device on
TUNER, you can operate the unit’s built-in FM/AM radio after pressing RECEIVER
and the external device after pressing SOURCE.
These keys work only if the corresponding function is available on your playback
device and if the device can be operated with an infrared remote control.
SOURCE z Turns on/off the playback device.
Menu operation
keys
Cursor keys Select an item.
ENTER Confirms a selected item.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
DISPLAY Switches information on the display.
External device
operation keys
TOP MENU Displays the top menu.
POP-UP/MENU Displays the pop-up menu.
s Stops playback.
d Stops playback temporarily.
a
Starts playback of the selected
song/video.
h
Searches forward/backward (by
holding down).
j
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
Numeric keys Enter numerical values.
TV operation keys Control the TV (p.105).
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
CODE SET
DISPLAY
SOURCE z
SOURCE
RECEIVER
Numeric keys
TV operation keys
Menu operation keys
External device
operation keys
Input selection keys
External device
operation keys
CONFIGURATIONS Controlling external devices with the remote control En 107
Programming from other remote controls
(learning)
(China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only)
The remote control of the unit can receive remote control signals
from other remote controls and learn the remote control operation. If
you cannot find a remote control code for your playback device or if
any key on the remote control does not work after you register the
remote control code, use the learning function to assign a function
to each key.
1
Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 1.
2
Press one of the following keys depending on the
type of your device.
For playback device: press the input selection key
(corresponding to the input jacks where the device is
connected).
For TV: press TV z.
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “9990”.
4
Aim the infrared transmitters of the remote controls
at each other.
5
Perform the following steps within 10 seconds.
a On this unit, press one of the following keys to which you want to
assign a function.
For playback device: SOURCE z, menu operations keys,
external device operation keys
For TV: TV operation keys
b On the external device, press the key from which the operation is
learned.
Once the operation is learned successfully, SOURCE blinks
twice.
If it blinks six times, learning has failed. Repeat Step 5.
6
Repeat step 5 until all desired operations are
learned.
7
Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks once.
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
123 4
12
12
3 4
Remote control of external device
5 to 10 cm apart
Note
If you press RECEIVER in step 2, you can assign functions of an external
receiver to the menu operation keys, external device operation keys or
numeric keys. However, it makes these keys to control the unit impossible. If
you need to restore the remote control code for the unit, perform the following
steps.
a Press CODE SET.
b Press RECEIVER.
c Use the numeric keys to enter “9992”.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
CODE SET
TV z
SOURCE z
SOURCE
TV operation keys
Menu operation keys
External device
operation keys
External device
operation keys
CONFIGURATIONS Controlling external devices with the remote control En 108
Clearing functions learned from other
remote controls
(China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only)
Clearing the assignment for each key
1
Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 1.
2
Press one of the following keys to select the device
for which key assignments will be cleared.
For playback device: press the input selection key.
For TV: press TV z.
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “9991”.
4
Press the key that you want to reset.
Once the key assignment is cleared successfully, SOURCE
blinks twice.
If it blinks six times, clearing failed. Repeat from Step 2.
5
Repeat step 4 until all desired key assignments are
cleared.
6
Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks once.
Clearing the assignments for each input
source
1
Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 1.
2
Press one of the following keys to select the device
for which key assignments will be cleared.
For playback device: press the input selection key.
For TV: press TV z.
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “9992”.
Once the key assignment is cleared successfully, SOURCE
blinks twice.
If it blinks six times, clearing failed. Repeat from Step 1.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
RE
C
EIV
E
R
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
CODE SET
TV z
SOURCE
Numeric keys
Input selection keys
CONFIGURATIONS Controlling external devices with the remote control En 109
Resetting remote control codes
You can reset a remote control code registered to each input
selection key.
1
Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 1.
2
Press the input selection key.
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “5098”.
Once the remote control code is reset successfully, SOURCE blinks
twice.
If it blinks six times, resetting has failed. Repeat from Step 1.
To reset the remote control to factory default settings
a Press CODE SET.
b Press RECEIVER.
c Use the numeric keys to enter “9981”.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
CODE SET
RECEIVER
SOURCE
Numeric keys
Input selection keys
CONFIGURATIONS Updating the unit’s firmware En 110
New firmware that provides additional features or product
improvements will be released as needed. If the unit is connected
to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network and
update it.
You can also update the firmware using the USB memory device from the
“ADVANCED SETUP” menu (p.104).
A firmware update is available if the following message is displayed
after ON SCREEN is pressed.
1
Read the on-screen description.
2
To start the firmware update, use the cursor keys to
select “START” and press ENTER.
The on-screen display turns off.
3
If “Update Success Please Power Off!” appears on
the front display, press MAIN ZONE z on the front
panel.
The firmware update is complete.
If you want to update the firmware later, select “CLOSE” in Step 2. “!” (exclamation
mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and a
message will be displayed in the “System” screen (p.101). You can update the
unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in the “System” screen.
Updating the unit’s firmware
Note
Do not operate the unit or disconnect the power cable or network cable during
firmware update. Firmware update takes about 20 minutes or more
(depending on your Internet connection speed).
Information
icon
Message
System Icon
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5
687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN
OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD
TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5 6 7
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
V
O
L
T
V
CH
TV
I
NPU
T
M
UT
E
CO
DE
S
E
T
9
0
10
EN
T
MEM
O
R
Y
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
M
O
V
I
E
ENHANCE
R
TU
NIN
G
PRE
S
ET
BAN
D
D
I
S
PL
A
Y
RETURN
ON
SCREEN
O
PTI
ON
TOP MEN
U
MUT
E
PR
OG
RAM
VO
L
UM
E
PO
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
P
URE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LE
E
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
P
AR
T
Y
H
D
MI OUT
T
UNE
R
MAIN
Z
O
NE
2
U
S
B
MO
D
E
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NE
T
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIV
E
R
HDMI
AV
A
UD
I
O
5
6
7
6
5
V-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
S
UR. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
Cursor keys
APPENDIX Frequently asked questions En 111
APPENDIX
The new speaker system does not provide an ideal sound
balance...
If you have changed speakers or have a new speaker system, use “Auto Setup” to
optimize the speaker settings again (p.35). If you want to adjust the speaker settings
manually, use “Manual Setup” in the “Setup” menu (p.88).
Since we have small children, we want to set limitations on the
volume control...
If a small child accidentally operates the controls on the main unit or remote control, the
volume may suddenly increase. This may also cause injury or damage the unit or
speakers. We recommend using “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the maximum
volume level for the unit in advance (p.91). You can also set the maximum volume for
Zone2 (p.97).
I am occasionally startled by a sudden loud sound when turning
on the unit...
By default, the volume level when the unit last entered standby mode is automatically
applied. If you want to fix the volume, use “Initial Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the
volume to be applied when the receiver is turned on (p.92). You can also set the initial
volume for Zone2 (p.97).
I made HDMI connections but HDMI Control does not work at
all...
To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.123). After
connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices (such as BD/DVD players) to the unit,
enable HDMI Control on each device and perform the HDMI Control link setup. This
setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your
system. For information on how HDMI Control works between your TV and playback
devices, refer to the instruction manuals for each device.
I want to turn off the on-screen messages displayed during
operations...
By default, short messages are displayed on the TV screen when the unit is operated
(such as input selection and volume adjustment). If the short messages bother you
when you are watching movies or sports, configure “Short Message” (p.97) in the
“Setup” menu to turn off the short messages.
I want to prevent accidental changes to the settings...
You can protect the settings configured on the unit (such as speaker settings) by
utilizing “Memory Guard” in the “Setup” menu (p.99).
The unit’s remote control is simultaneously controlling another
Yamaha product as well as the unit...
When using multiple Yamaha products, the remote control may work on another
Yamaha product or another remote control may work on the unit. If this happens,
register different remote control IDs for the devices that you want to control with each
remote control (p.102).
Frequently asked questions
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 112
Refer to the table below when the unit does not function properly.
If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below or if the instructions below do not help, turn off the unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized
Yamaha dealer or service center.
First, check the following:
a The power cables of the unit, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are connected to AC wall outlets
securely.
b The unit, subwoofer, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are turned on.
c The connectors of each cable are securely inserted in to jacks on each device.
Power and system
Troubleshooting
Problem Cause Remedy
The power does not turn on.
The protection circuitry has been activated three times
consecutively. When the unit is in this condition, the standby
indicator on the unit blinks if you try to turn on the power.
As a safety precaution, capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your
nearest Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair.
The power does not turn off.
The internal microcomputer has frozen, due to an external electric
shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop
in the power supply voltage.
Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to
initialize and reboot the unit.
The power turns off (standby mode) immediately. The unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted.
Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and
speakers (p.18).
The unit enters
standby mode automatically.
The sleep timer worked. Turn on the unit and start playback again.
The auto-standby function kicked in because the unit was not used
for the specified time.
To disable the auto-standby function, set “Auto Power Down” in the “Setup” menu
to “Off” (p.99).
The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers (p.102).
The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short
circuit.
Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and
speakers (p.18).
The unit is not reacting.
The internal microcomputer is frozen, due to an external electric
shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop
in the power supply voltage.
Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to
initialize and reboot the unit.
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 113
Audio
Problem Cause Remedy
No sound.
Another input source is selected. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys.
Signals that the unit cannot reproduce are being input.
Some digital audio formats cannot be played back on the unit. To check the audio
format of the input signal, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.101).
The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
The volume cannot be increased.
The maximum volume is set. Use “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the maximum volume (p.91).
A device connected to the output jacks of the unit is not turned on.
(This may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.)
Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of the unit.
No sound is coming from a specific speaker.
The playback source does not contain a signal for the channel. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.101).
The currently selected sound program/decoder does not use the
speaker.
To check it, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu (p.90).
Audio output of the speaker is disabled.
Perform “Auto Setup” (p.35) or use “Configuration” in the “Setup” menu to change
the speaker settings (p.88).
The volume of the speaker is set too low.
Perform “Auto Setup” (p.35) or use “Level” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the
speaker volume (p.90).
The speaker cable connecting the unit and the speaker is
defective.
If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another speaker cable.
The speaker is malfunctioning.
To check it, replace with another speaker. If the problem persists, the unit may be
malfunctioning.
No sound is coming from the surround back
speaker.
The extended surround is disabled.
Use “Extended Surround” in the “Option” menu to select a decoder to be used
(p.77).
No sound is coming from the subwoofer.
The playback source does not contain LFE or low-frequency
signals.
To check it, set “Extra Bass” in the “Setup” menu to “On”, in order to output the
front channel low-frequency components from the subwoofer (p.89).
Subwoofer output is disabled.
Perform “Auto Setup” (p.35) or set “Subwoofer” in the “Setup” menu to “Use
(p.89).
The volume of the subwoofer is too low. Adjust the volume on the subwoofer.
The subwoofer has been turned off by its auto-standby function. Disable the auto-standby function of the subwoofer or adjust its sensitivity level.
No sound from the playback device (connected to
the unit with HDMI).
The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection).
Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications.
The unit is set not to output audio input through HDMI jacks from
the SPEAKERS terminals.
In “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu, set “Amp” to “On” (p.94).
The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack exceeds
the limit.
Disconnect some of the HDMI devices.
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 114
Video
No sound from the TV (when HDMI Control is
used).
The TV is set to output audio from the TV speakers.
Change the audio output setting on your TV so that the TV audio is output from the
speakers connected to the unit.
(If the TV is connected to the unit with an audio cable)
The TV audio input setting does not match the actual connection.
Use “TV Audio Input” in the “Setup” menu to select the correct audio input jack
(p.93).
(If you are trying to use ARC)
ARC is disabled on the unit or TV.
Set “ARC” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.94). Also, enable ARC on the TV.
Only the front speakers work on multichannel
audio.
The playback device is set to output 2-channel audio (such as
PCM) only.
To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.101). If necessary,
change the digital audio output setting on the playback device.
Noise/hum is heard.
The unit is too close to another digital or radio frequency device. Move the unit further away from the device.
The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
The sound is distorted.
The volume of the unit is too high. Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” is set to “On”, set it to “Off” (p.99).
A device connected to the unit’s output jacks is not turned on. (This
may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.)
Turn on all devices connected to the unit’s output jacks.
Problem Cause Remedy
Problem Cause Remedy
No video.
Another input source is selected on the unit. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys.
Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit.
The video signal output from the unit is not supported by the TV. Set “MON.CHK” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “YES” (p.103).
The cable connecting the unit and TV (or playback device) is
defective.
If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
No video from the playback device (connected to
the unit with HDMI).
The input video signal (resolution) is not supported by the unit.
To check the information about the current video signal (resolution), use “Video
Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.101). For information about video signals
supported by the unit, see “HDMI signal compatibility” (p.124).
The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection).
Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications.
The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over
the limit.
Disconnect some of the HDMI devices.
The menu of the unit is not displayed on the TV.
The TV is not connected to the unit via HDMI.
You can display the menu of the unit on the TV only when they are connected with
an HDMI cable. If necessary, use an HDMI cable to connect them (p.21 to 24).
Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 115
FM/AM radio
USB and network
Problem Cause Remedy
FM radio reception is weak or noisy.
There is multi-path interference. Adjust the FM antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location.
Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter.
Set “FM Mode” in the “Option” menu to “Mono” to select monaural FM radio
reception (p.77).
Use an outdoor FM antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element
antenna.
AM radio reception is weak or noisy.
The noises may be caused by fluorescent lamps, motors,
thermostats, or other electrical equipment.
It is difficult to completely eliminate noise. It may be reduced by using an outdoor
AM antenna.
Radio stations cannot be selected automatically.
Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter.
Select the station manually (p.51).
Use an outdoor antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element
antenna.
The AM radio signal is weak.
Adjust the AM antenna orientation.
Select the station manually (p.51).
Use an outdoor AM antenna. Connect it to the ANTENNA (AM) jack together with
the supplied AM antenna.
AM radio stations cannot be registered as
presets.
Auto Preset has been used.
Auto Preset is for registering FM radio stations only. Register AM radio stations
manually (p.52).
Problem Cause Remedy
The unit does not detect the USB device.
The USB device is not connected to the USB jack securely. Turn off the unit, reconnect your USB device, and turn the unit on again.
The file system of the USB device is not FAT16 or FAT32. Use a USB device with FAT16 or FAT32 format.
Folders and files in the USB device cannot be
viewed.
The data in the USB device is protected by the encryption. Use a USB device without an encryption function.
The network feature does not function.
The network parameters (IP address) have not been obtained
properly.
Enable the DHCP server function on your router and set “DHCP” in the “Setup”
menu to “On” on the unit (p.95). If you want to configure the network parameters
manually, check that you are using an IP address which is not used by other
network devices in your network (p.95).
The unit does not detect the PC.
The media sharing setting is not correct.
Configure the sharing setting and select the unit as a device to which music
contents are shared (p.63).
Some security software installed on your PC is blocking the access
of the unit to your PC.
Check the settings of security software installed on your PC.
The unit and PC are not in the same network.
Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the
unit and the PC to the same network.
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 116
Remote control
The files in the PC cannot be viewed or played
back.
The files are not supported by the unit or the media server.
Use the file format supported by both the unit and the media server. For
information about the file formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music
stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.63).
The Internet radio cannot be played.
The selected Internet radio station is currently not available.
There may be a network problem at the radio station, or the service may have
been stopped. Try the station later or select another station.
The selected Internet radio station is currently broadcasting
silence.
Some Internet radio stations broadcast silence at certain of times of the day. Try
the station later or select another station.
Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of your
network devices (such as the router).
Check the firewall settings of your network devices. The Internet radio can be
played only when it passes through the port designated by each radio station.
The port number varies depending on the radio station.
Problem Cause Remedy
Problem Cause Remedy
The unit cannot be controlled using the remote
control.
The unit is out of the operating range. Use the remote control within the operating range (p.5).
The batteries are weak. Replace with new batteries.
The unit’s remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight or
strong lighting.
Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition the unit.
The remote control is set to control external devices.
Press RECEIVER to set the remote control to control the unit (the key lights up in
orange).
The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not
identical.
Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.102).
External devices cannot be controlled using the
remote control.
The remote control is set to control the unit.
Press SOURCE to set the remote control to control external devices (the key lights
up in green).
The corresponding remote control code is not set properly.
Set the remote control code again (p.105). Even if the remote control code is
registered properly, some products may not respond to the remote control.
The remote control does not learn new functions.
(China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only)
The batteries of the remote control of the unit and/or the external
device are weak.
Replace with new batteries.
The distance between the two remote controls is not appropriate. Place the remote controls at a proper distance (p.107).
The signal coding or modulation of the other remote control is not
compatible with the remote control.
Learning is impossible in this case.
Memory capacity is full.
Clear unnecessary assignments to free some memory space for new functions
(p.108).
APPENDIX Error indications on the front display En 117
Error indications on the front display
Message Cause Remedy
Access denied Access to the PC is denied.
Configure the sharing settings and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared
(p.63).
Access error
The unit cannot access the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
The unit cannot access the iPod. Turn off the iPod and turn it on again.
There is a problem with the signal path from the network to the unit.
Make sure your router and modem are turned on.
Check the connection between the unit and your router (or hub) (p.30).
Check SP Wires The speaker cables short circuit. Twist the bare wires of the cables firmly and connect to the unit and speakers properly.
Connect error The unit has detected the iPod, but cannot access it. Turn off the iPod and then turn it on again.
Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
No content There are no playable files in the selected folder. Select a folder that contains files supported by the unit.
No device
The unit cannot detect the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
The unit cannot detect the iPod. Turn off the iPod and then turn it on again.
Please wait The unit is preparing for connecting to the network.
Wait until the message disappears. If the message stays more than 3 minutes, turn off the unit and turn
it on again.
RemID Mismatch
The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not
identical.
Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.102).
Unable to play
The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the iPod for some
reason.
Check the song data. If it cannot be played on the iPod itself, the song data or storage area may be
defective.
The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the PC for some
reason.
Check if the format of files you are trying to play is supported by the unit. For information about the
formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.63). If
the unit supports the file format, but still cannot play back any files, the network may be overloaded with
heavy traffic.
Unknown iPod The connected iPod is not supported by the unit. Use an iPod supported by the unit (p.56).
USB Overloaded An overcurrent is flowing through the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
APPENDIX Ideal speaker layout En 118
Use this diagram as a guide. You do not need to adjust the speaker layout to the following diagram exactly.
Ideal speaker layout
12
3
45
6 7
99
QW
30 cm (1 ft) or more
0.5 to 1 m
(1.6 to 3.3 ft)
1.8 m
(5.9 ft)
0.5 to 1 m
(1.6 to 3.3 ft)
1.8 m
(5.9 ft)
Turn it slightly inward to
reduce wall reflections.
Turn it slightly inward to
reduce wall reflections.
1 Front speaker (L)
2 Front speaker (R)
3 Center speaker
4 Surround speaker (L)
5 Surround speaker (R)
6 Surround back speaker (L)
7 Surround back speaker (R)
Q Presence speaker (L)
W Presence speaker (R)
9 Subwoofer
10° to 30°10° to 30°
APPENDIX Glossary En 119
Audio information
Audio decoding format
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports
5.1-channel audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs.
Dolby Digital EX
Dolby Digital EX creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with Dolby
Digital Surround EX. This decoder adds a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports
7.1-channel audio. Dolby Digital Plus remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems
that support Dolby Digital. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
Dolby Pro Logic II
Dolby Pro Logic II enables 5-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are three modes available:
“Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources, and “Game mode” for game sources.
Dolby Pro Logic IIx
Dolby Pro Logic IIx enables 7-channel playback from 2-channel or multichannel sources. There are three
modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources and “Game mode” for
game sources (for 2-channel sources only).
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. to offer a
high-definition home theater experience with the quality of the studio master. Dolby TrueHD can carry up to
eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This
technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. This
format remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital
Surround. This technology is used for music DVDs, etc.
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports
5.1-channel audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs.
DTS-ES
DTS-ES creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with DTS-ES. This
decoder adds a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound. In the DTS-ES Matrix 6.1 format, a
surround back sound is recorded in the surround channels, and in the DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 format, a
discrete surround back channel is recorded.
DTS Express
DTS Express is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel audio and allows a higher
compression rate than the DTS Digital Surround format developed by DTS, Inc. This technology is
developed for audio streaming services on the Internet and secondary audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports
7.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio remains fully compatible with the
existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This technology is used for audio on
BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio format developed to offer a high-definition home
theater experience with the quality of the studio master by DTS, Inc. DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to
eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This
technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS Neo:6
DTS Neo:6 enables 6-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are two modes available: “Music
mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources. This technology provides discrete
full-bandwidth matrix channels of surround sound.
DSD (Direct Stream Digital)
DSD (Direct Stream Digital) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as SACD (Super
Audio CDs). The signals are stored at a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz. The highest
frequency response is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This technology
offers better audio quality than that used for CDs.
FLAC
FLAC is a file format for lossless audio data compression. FLAC is inferior to lossy compressed audio
formats in compression rate but provides higher audio quality.
MP3
One of the compressed digital audio format used by MPEG. With psychoacoustic technologies, this
compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing data
quantity by about 1/10 maintaining a certain level of audio quality.
MPEG-4 AAC
An MPEG-4 audio standard. It is used for mobile telephones, portable audio players, and audio streaming
services on Internet because it allows a high compression rate of data while maintaining better audio quality
than MP3.
PCM (Pulse Code Modulation)
PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded, and transmitted. This
technology is the basis of all other audio format. This technology is used as a lossless audio format called
Linear PCM for audio on a variety of media, including CDs and BD (Blu-ray discs).
Glossary
APPENDIX Glossary En 120
Sampling frequency/Quantization bit
Sampling frequency and quantization bits indicate the quantity of information when an analog audio signal
is digitized. These values are noted as in the following example: “48 kHz/24-bit”.
Sampling frequency
Sampling frequency (the number of times the signal is sampled per second) is called the sampling rate.
When the sampling frequency is higher, the range of frequencies that can be played back are wider.
Quantization bit
The number of quantization bits indicate the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a
numeric value. When the number of quantized bits is higher, the expression of the sound level is more
accurate.
WAV
Windows standard audio file format, which defines the method of recording the digital data obtained by
converting audio signals. By default, the PCM method (no compression) is used, but you can also use other
compression methods.
WMA (Windows Media Audio)
One of the compressed digital audio formats developed by Microsoft Corporation. With psychoacoustic
technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of
compressing data quantity by about 1/20 maintaining a certain level of audio quality.
Others
Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp)
A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. When you use the bi-amplification
connection, the unit drives the tweeter and woofer in a speaker with the discrete amplifiers. As a
consequence, the tweeter and woofer provide clear audio signal without the interference.
LFE (Low Frequency Effects) 0.1 channel
This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This
channel is added to the channels for all bands with Dolby Digital or DTS to enhance low frequency audio
effects. This channel is labeled 0.1 because it is limited to only low frequency audio.
Lip sync
Video output sometimes lags behind audio output due to the complexity of signal processing caused by an
increase in video signal capacity. Lip sync is a technique for automatically correcting the timing lag
between audio and video output.
HDMI and video information
Component video signal
With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and
the Pb and Pr signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because
each of these signals is independent.
Composite video signal
With the composite video signal system, color, brightness, and synchronization data signals are combined
and transmitted with a single cable.
Deep Color
Deep Color is a technology that HDMI specification supports. Deep Color increases the number of available
colors within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space. Conventional color systems
process the color using 8 bits. Deep Color processes the color with 10, 12, or 16 bits. This technology
allows HDTVs and other displays to increase from millions of colors to billions of colors and eliminate
on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors.
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the world-wide standard interface for digital audio/video
signal transmission. This interface transmits both digital audio and digital video signals using a single cable
without any loss. HDMI complies with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) and provides a
secure audio/video interface. For further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at
“http://www.hdmi.org/”.
x.v.Color
“x.v.Color” is a technology that the HDMI specification supports. It is a more extensive color space than
sRGB and allows the expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with
the color gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and thus can produce more vivid,
natural images.
APPENDIX Glossary En 121
Yamaha technologies
CINEMA DSP (Digital Sound Field Processor)
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is
best experienced in a theater that has many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions
(such as room size, wall material, and number of speakers) can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are
differences in the sound that you hear. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, CINEMA DSP,
Yamaha’s original DSP technology provides the audiovisual experience of a movie theater in your own
home.
CINEMA DSP 3D
The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA
DSP 3D mode achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the
accurate and intensive 3D sound fields in a listening room.
Compressed Music Enhancer
The Compressed Music Enhancer feature compensates for missing harmonics in compression music
formats (such as MP3). As a result, this technology provides improved performance for the overall sound
system.
SILENT CINEMA
Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for
headphones have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound
programs can be enjoyed on headphones.
Virtual CINEMA DSP
Virtual CINEMA DSP allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with
front left and right speakers. Even if the surround speakers are not connected, the unit creates the realistic
sound field in a listening room.
APPENDIX Glossary En 122
Video signal flow
Video signals input from a video device to the unit are
output to a TV as shown below.
Video conversion table
You can select the resolution and the aspect ratio applied to HDMI-output video processing in “Video Mode” (p.92) in the “Setup” menu.
The unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably.
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO VIDEO VIDEOVIDEO
m: Available
HDMI out COMPONENT VIDEO out
VIDEO
out
Resolution
480i/
576i
480p/
576p
720p 1080i 1080p 4K
480i/
576i
480p/
576p
720p 1080i
480i/
576i
HDMI in
480i/576i mmmmmm
480p/576p mmmmm
720p mmmm
1080i mmmm
1080p/50, 60 Hz mmmm
1080p/24 Hz mm
4K m
COMPONENT
VIDEO in
480i/576i mmmmmmm
480p/576p m
720p m
1080i m
VIDEO in 480i/576i mmmmmm m
Video device The unit TV
HDMI outHDMI in
COMPONENT
VIDEO in
COMPONENT
VIDEO out
VIDEO
out
VIDEO
in
APPENDIX Information on HDMI En 123
HDMI Control
HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that
supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit (such as
power and volume) with TV remote control operations. You can also control playback
devices (such as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players) connected to the unit with
an HDMI cable.
For details on connections, see “Connecting a TV” (p.21) and “Connecting video
devices (such as BD/DVD players)” (p.26).
Operations available from the TV’s remote control
Standby synchronization
Volume control including mute
Switching to input audio from the TV when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner
Switching to input video/audio from the selected playback device
Switching between audio output devices (the unit or TV speaker)
(Example)
Operations available from the unit’s remote control
Starting playback on the playback device and turning on the TV with a scene
selection (p.44)
Switching the TV input to display the on-screen menu (when ON SCREEN is pressed)
Controlling the playback device (playback and menu operations) without registering
remote control codes (p.106)
(Example)
To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the following HDMI Control link setup after
connecting the TV and playback devices.
This setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system.
1
Turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices.
2
Enable HDMI Control on the unit, TV, and playback devices (such as
HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players).
To enable HDMI Control on the unit, setHDMI Control” (p.93) in the “Setup”
menu to “On” and configure the related items (“TV Audio Input”, “ARC”, and
“Standby Sync”).
3
Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off the unit and
playback devices.
4
Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV.
5
Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit.
6
Check the followings.
On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected.
If not, select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
Information on HDMI
HDMI Control
Turn off the TV
The unit turns off
(standby)
HDMI Control
Playback device
also turns off
HDMI Control
Press SCENE (BD/DVD)
Turns on and displays
video from the playback
device
HDMI Control
Playback starts
APPENDIX Information on HDMI En 124
7
Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning
off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try unplugging the TV in Step 2 and plugging in the TV again in
Step 3. It may solve the problem. Also, HDMI Control may not work if the number of connected devices
exceeds the limit. In this case, disable HDMI Control on the devices not in use.
If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on
the TV.
We recommend using TV and playback devices from the same manufacturer so that HDMI Control works
more effectively.
HDMI signal compatibility
Audio signals
Video signals
The unit is compatible with the video signals of the following resolutions:
When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video/audio signals may not be output, depending
on the type of the DVD player.
The unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI devices. For details, refer to the instruction
manual for each device.
To decode audio bitstream signals on the unit, set the input source device appropriately so that the device
outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream signals on the playback device).
For details, refer to the instruction manual for the playback device.
Audio signal type Audio signal format Compatible media (example)
2ch Linear PCM 2ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio
Multichannel Linear PCM 8ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit
DVD-Audio, BD (Blu-ray disc),
HD DVD
DSD 2/5.1ch, 2.8224 MHz, 1 bit SACD
Bitstream Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video
Bitstream
(High definition audio)
Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus,
DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD
High Resolution Audio, DTS
Express
BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD
VGA 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
480i/60 Hz 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
576i/50 Hz 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
480p/60 Hz 3840 x 2160p/30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz (4K signals)
576p/50 Hz 4096 x 2160p/24 Hz (4K signals)
APPENDIX Reference diagram (rear panel) En 125
The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product to prevent improper connections.
Reference diagram (rear panel)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
AC IN
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(
TV
)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
PB
Y
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
PR
PB
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(
NET
)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5 HDMI 6
HDMI 7
RS-232C
HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(
RADIO
)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
SPEAKERS
12V
0.1A
(U.S.A. model)
APPENDIX Trademarks En 126
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are
trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent Nos: 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872;
7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS-HD, the
Symbol, & DTS-HD and the Symbol together are registered trademarks & DTS-HD Master Audio is a
trademark of DTS, Inc.
Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
“Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone,” and “Made for iPad” mean that an electronic accessory has been
designed to connect specifically to iPod, iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been certified by the
developer to meet Apple performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with safety and regulatory
standards.
Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless performance.
AirPlay, the AirPlay logo, iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod nano, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson.
This receiver supports network connections.
“HDMI,” the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks, or registered
trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
x.v.Color™
“x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation.
“SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation.
DLNA™ and DLNA CERTIFIED™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of Digital Living Network
Alliance. All rights reserved. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited.
Windows
®
Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries.
Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows Media Audio, Windows Media Connect and Windows
Media Player are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States
and/or other countries.
Trademarks
APPENDIX Specifications En 127
Input jacks
• Analog Audio
[U.S.A. and Canada models]
Audio x 5 (AV 5–6, AUDIO 1–2, V-AUX)
[Other models]
Audio x 6 (AV 5–6, AUDIO 1–2, PHONO, V-AUX)
• Digital Audio (Supported frequencies: 32 kHz to 96 kHz)
Optical x 2 (AV 1, AV 4)
Coaxial x 2 (AV 2–3)
•Video
Composite x 5 (AV 3–6, V-AUX)
Component x 2 (AV 1–2)
• HDMI Input
HDMI x 8 (HDMI 1–7, V-AUX)
•Other
USB x 1 [Front Panel] (USB2.0)
USB x 1 [Rear Panel]
(For Yamaha Accessory, Power Supply Only)
NETWORK x 1 (100Base-TX)
Output jacks
• Analog Audio
- Speaker Out x 9 (7 ch) (
FRONT L/R, CENTER,
SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R
*1
, EXTRA SP L/R
*2
)
*1 Note: Assignment is possible [SURROUND BACK,
BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)]
*2 Note: Assignment is possible [ZONE2, PRESENCE]
- Pre Out x 7 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R)
- Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1–2, mono)
- AV OUT x 1
- AUDIO OUT x 1
- ZONE2 OUT x 1
- Headphone x 1
•Video
MONITOR OUT
- Component x 1
- Composite x 1
AV OUT
- Composite x 1
• HDMI Output
HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT 1–2)
Remote jacks
• REMOTE IN x 1
• REMOTE OUT x 1
• TRIGGER OUT x 1
HDMI
• HDMI Specification: Deep Color, “x.v.Color,” Auto Lip Sync,
ARC (Audio Return Channel), 3D, 4K
• Video Format (Repeater Mode)
-VGA
- 480i/60 Hz
- 576i/50 Hz
- 480p/60 Hz
- 576p/50 Hz
- 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
- 3840 x 2160p/30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz
- 4096 x 2160p/24 Hz
Audio Format
-Dolby TrueHD
- Dolby Digital Plus
- Dolby Digital
- DTS-HD Master Audio
- DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
- DTS Express
-DTS
-DSD 6-ch
- PCM 2-ch to 8-ch (Max. 192 kHz/24-bit)
Content Protection: HDCP compatible
Link Function: CEC supported
TUNER
Analog Tuner
[U.K. and Europe models]
FM/AM with Radio Data System x 1 (TUNER)
[Other models]
FM/AM x 1 (TUNER)
USB
• Capable of iPod, Mass Storage Class USB Memory
Current Supply Capacity: 2.1 A
Network
PC Client Function
• Compatible with DLNA ver. 1.5
• AirPlay supported
Internet Radio
Specifications
APPENDIX Specifications En 128
Compatible Decoding Formats
• Decoding Format
- Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus
- Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX
- DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio,
DTS Express
- DTS, DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1
- DTS Digital Surround
• Post Decoding Format
- Dolby Pro Logic
- Dolby Pro Logic II Music, Dolby Pro Logic II Movie,
Dolby Pro Logic II Game
- Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie, Dolby
Pro Logic IIx Game
- DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema
Audio Section
• Rated Output Power (2-channel driven)
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.09% THD, 8 )
Front L/R .............................................................100 W+100 W
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 )
Front L/R .............................................................110 W+110 W
Center............................................................................. 110 W
Surround L/R.......................................................110 W+110 W
Surround Back L/R .............................................110 W+110 W
• Rated Output Power (1-channel driven)
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 )
Front L/R .................................................................... 130 W/ch
Center ....................................................................... 130 W/ch
Surround L/R.............................................................. 130 W/ch
Surround Back L/R .................................................... 130 W/ch
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4 )
Front L/R [U.K. and Europe models] ......................... 160 W/ch
Maximum Effective Output Power (JEITA, 1 kHz, 10% THD, 8
)
[China, Asia and General models]
Front L/R .................................................................... 160 W/ch
Center ........................................................................ 160 W/ch
Surround L/R.............................................................. 160 W/ch
Surround Back L/R .................................................... 160 W/ch
• Dynamic Power (IHF)
Front L/R (8/6/4/2 )...................................140/180/210/250 W
• Damping Factor
Front L/R, 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 ............................. 100 or more
• Input Sensitivity / Input Impedance
PHONO (1 kHz, 100 W/8 )
[Except for U.S.A. and Canada models]............. 3.5 mV/47 k
AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 100 W/8 ).............................. 200 mV/47 k
• Maximum Input Signal
PHONO (1 kHz, 0.1% THD)
[Except for U.S.A. and Canada models].........................60 mV
AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD, Effect On) ............................2.3 V
• Output Level / Output Impedance
REC OUT........................................................... 200 mV/1.2 k
SUBWOOFER ........................................................... 1 V/1.2 k
ZONE2 OUT ...................................................... 200 mV/1.2 k
• Headphone Jack Rated Output / Impedance
AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 50 mV, 8 ) .............................100 mV/560
• Frequency Response
AV 5 etc. to Front (10 Hz to 100 kHz)..........................+0/-3 dB
• Total Harmonic Distortion
PHONO to AUDIO OUT (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 1 V)
[Except for U.S.A. and Canada models]............. 0.02% or less
AV 5 etc. to Front (Pure Direct)
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 50 W, 8 )............................... 0.06% or less
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)
PHONO (Input Shorted 5 mV, AUDIO OUT)
[Except for U.S.A. and Canada models]............81 dB or more
AV 5 etc. (Input Shorted 250 mV, Speaker Out)
.........................................................................100 dB or more
• Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)
Front L/R (Speaker Out) ..................................... 150 µV or less
Channel Separation
PHONO (Input Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz)
[Except for U.S.A. and Canada models]
.................................................................60 dB/55 dB or more
AV 5 etc. (Input 5.1 k Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz)
.................................................................60 dB/45 dB or more
Volume Control
Range..............................................MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB
Step.................................................................................0.5 dB
Tone Control Characteristics
Bass Boost/Cut .............................±6 dB/0.5 dB Step at 50 Hz
Bass Turnover ................................................................350 Hz
Treble Boost/Cut.......................... ±6 dB/0.5 dB Step at 20 kHz
Treble Turnover ............................................................. 3.5 kHz
• Filter Characteristics
(fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz)
H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back).......12 dB/oct.
L.P.F. (Subwoofer) .....................................................24 dB/oct.
Video Section
• Video Signal Type
[U.S.A., Canada, Korea and General models] ................NTSC
[Other models]....................................................................PAL
• Video Signal Type (Video Conversion)..................... NTSC/PAL
• Video Signal Level
Composite..............................................................1 Vp-p/75
Component
Y ..........................................................................1 Vp-p/75
Pb/Pr ................................................................0.7 Vp-p/75
• Video Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off)
....................................................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more
Video Signal to Noise Ratio................................ 50 dB or more
• Monitor Out Frequency Response (Video Conversion Off)
Component ............................................5 Hz to 60 MHz, -3 dB
APPENDIX Specifications En 129
FM Section
• Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ...................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz
[Asia and General models]
.......................................87.5/87.50 MHz to 108.0/108.00 MHz
[Other models].................................87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz
• 50 dB Quiet Sensitivity (IHF, 1 kHz, 100% MOD.)
Mono................................................................. 3 µV (20.8 dBf)
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)
Mono................................................................................ 71 dB
Stereo ..............................................................................69 dB
• Harmonic Distortion (IHF, 1 kHz)
Mono................................................................................. 0.3%
Stereo ............................................................................... 0.5%
Antenna Input ................................................75 unbalanced
AM section
• Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ......................... 530 to 1710 kHz
[Asia and General models]...... 530/531 kHz to 1710/1611 kHz
[Other models]......................................... 531 kHz to 1611 kHz
General
• Power Supply
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ......................... AC 120 V, 60 Hz
[General model]............ AC 110 to 120/220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz
[China model]................................................. AC 220 V, 50 Hz
[Korea model]................................................. AC 220 V, 60 Hz
[Australia model] ............................................ AC 240 V, 50 Hz
[U.K. and Europe models].............................. AC 230 V, 50 Hz
[Asia model] ................................... AC 220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz
• Power Consumption
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .............................400 W/500 VA
[Asia and General models]............................................. 300 W
[Other models]................................................................ 330 W
• Standby Power Consumption
HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off ........... 0.1 W (Typical)
HDMI Control On, Standby Through On (No Signals)
..........................................................................3.0 W (Typical)
Network Standby On .........................................2.0 W (Typical)
• Maximum Power Consumption
[Asia and General models] .............................................590 W
• Dimensions (W x H x D)
..................... 435 x 171 x 369 mm (17-1/8” x 6-3/4” x 14-1/2”)
• Weight ...........................................................10.8 kg (23.8 lbs)
* Specifications are subject to change without notice.
APPENDIX Index En 130
Symbols
key .........................................................11
Lock icon (o) ...........................................99
Numerics
2.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................15
2ch Stereo (Sound program) ....................47
3.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................15
4.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................15
4K signal (Video signal resolution) .........124
5.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................15
5ch BI-AMP
(Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) ........88
6.1-channel system
(Speaker connection) ............................18
6.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................14
7.1+2-channel system
(Speaker connection) ............................17
7.1+2-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................14
7.1-channel system
(Speaker connection) ............................17
7.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................14
7ch +1ZONE
(Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) ........88
7ch Stereo (Sound program) ....................47
A
Access control (Network device) ..............95
Action Game (Sound program) ................ 46
Adaptive DRC (Option menu) .................. 76
Adaptive DSP Level
(Sound, Setup menu) ........................... 92
Adjustment (Lipsync, Setup menu) .......... 91
ADVANCED SETUP menu ...................... 102
ADVANCED SETUP menu item list ........ 102
Adventure (Sound program) .................... 46
AirPlay ...................................................... 68
AM antenna .............................................. 30
Amp (Audio Output, Setup menu) ............ 94
ARC (Audio Return Channel) ................... 21
ARC (HDMI Control, Setup menu) ........... 94
ARC-compatible TV (Connection) ............ 21
Aspect (Video Mode, Setup menu) .......... 93
Audio Decoder (Front display) ................. 74
Audio device connection ......................... 29
Audio In (Input menu) .............................. 79
AUDIO jack .............................................. 20
AUDIO OUT jack ...................................... 31
Audio Output (HDMI, Setup menu) .......... 94
Audio Return Channel .............................. 21
Audio Signal (Information menu) ............ 101
Auto Power Down (ECO, Setup menu) .... 99
Auto Preset (FM radio) ............................. 55
Auto/Manual Select
(Lipsync, Setup menu) ......................... 91
Automatic preset (FM radio) .................... 55
AV OUT jack ............................................. 31
B
Banana plug ............................................. 18
Bass (Option menu) ................................. 76
Bass Cross Over
(Speaker, Setup menu) ........................ 89
Battery ........................................................ 5
Bi-amp speaker connection ..................... 19
Bitrate
(Audio Signal, Information menu) ....... 101
Bitstream ................................................ 124
C
Cellar Club (Sound program) ................... 47
Center (Speaker, Setup menu) ................ 88
Center Image (Sound Program menu) ..... 84
Center Width (Sound Program menu) ...... 84
Chamber (Sound program) ...................... 47
CINEMA DSP ............................................ 46
CINEMA DSP 3D ...................................... 48
CINEMA DSP 3D (Option menu) .............. 76
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (Option menu) .... 76
CLASSICAL
(Sound program category) ................... 47
Clock Time (Radio Data System) ............. 53
COAXIAL jack .......................................... 20
Combination of video/audio input jacks ... 27
Component video cable ........................... 20
Component video connection
(Playback device) ................................ 26
COMPONENT VIDEO jack ....................... 20
Composite AV Cable ................................ 56
Composite video connection
(Playback device) ................................ 27
Compressed Music Enhancer .................. 50
Configuration (Scene function) ................ 44
Connection (Audio devices) ..................... 29
Connection (iPod) .................................... 56
Index
APPENDIX Index En 131
Connection (NAS) .....................................30
Connection (Speaker cable) .....................18
Connection (Speaker) ...............................17
Connection (Subwoofer) ...........................18
Connection (Video devices) ......................26
Crossover frequency setting
(Subwoofer) ...........................................35
D
DC OUT jack .............................................10
Decode Type (Sound Program menu) ......83
Decoder Mode (Input menu) ....................79
Default Gateway ........................................95
Delay Enable (Lipsync, Setup menu) .......91
Detail (Load, Scene menu) .......................81
Device Control (Load, Scene menu) .........81
DHCP (IP Address, Setup menu) ..............95
Dialog Adjust (Option menu) ....................76
Dialog Lift (Option menu) ..........................76
Dialog Lvl (Option menu) ..........................76
Dialogue
(Audio Signal, Information menu) .......101
Dialogue Adjust (Option menu) ................76
Dialogue Level (Option menu) ..................76
Dialogue Lift (Option menu) ......................76
Dialogue normalization level ...................101
Digital coaxial cable ..................................20
Digital Media Controller (DMC) .................80
Digital optical cable ..................................20
Dimension (Sound Program menu) ...........84
Dimmer (Front Display)
(Display Set, Setup menu) ....................97
Direct (Sound Program menu) ..................84
Display Set (Function, Setup menu) .........97
Distance (Speaker, Setup menu) ..............90
DMC (Digital Media Controller) .................80
DMC Control (Input menu) ........................80
DNS Server .............................................. 95
Dolby Digital EX (Extended surround) ..... 77
Dolby Pro Logic (Surround decoder) ....... 49
Dolby Pro Logic II (Surround decoder) .... 49
Dolby Pro Logic IIx
(Surround decoder) ............................. 49
Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie
(Extended surround) ............................ 77
Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music
(Extended surround) ............................ 77
Drama (Sound program) .......................... 46
DSD ........................................................ 124
DSP Level (Sound Program menu) .......... 83
DSP Program (Front display) ................... 74
DTS Neo:6 (Surround decoder) ............... 49
DTS-ES (Extended surround) ................... 77
Dynamic Range (Sound, Setup menu) .... 91
E
ECO (Setup menu) ................................... 99
ECO Mode (ECO, setup menu) ................ 99
ENHANCER .............................................. 50
Enhancer (Option menu) .......................... 77
ENTERTAINMENT
(Sound program category) .................. 46
Error messages (YPAO) ........................... 41
EX/ES (Extended surround) ..................... 77
EXTD Surround (Option menu) ................ 77
Extended Surround (Option menu) .......... 77
External device control
(Remote control) ................................ 105
External device operation keys
(Remote control) .................................. 11
External power amplifier (Connection) ..... 31
Extra Bass
(Manual setup, Setup menu) ................ 89
F
Firmware update
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 104
Firmware update (on-screen) ................. 110
Firmware version
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 104
Firmware Version
(System, Information menu) ............... 101
FM antenna .............................................. 30
FM Mode (Option menu) .......................... 77
Format (Server) ........................................ 63
Format (USB storage device) ................... 60
Frequency step setting (FM/AM radio) .... 51
Front (Speaker, Setup menu) ................... 88
Front / Rear Balance
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 84
Front display
(Part names and functions) .................... 9
Front display information .......................... 74
Front panel (Part names and functions) ..... 8
Front Presence (Speaker, Setup menu) ... 89
Function (Setup menu) ............................. 97
G
GND (Connection) .................................... 29
Ground lead ............................................. 29
H
Hall in Munich (Sound program) .............. 47
Hall in Vienna (Sound program) ............... 47
HDMI (Setup menu) ................................. 93
HDMI cable .............................................. 20
HDMI connection (Playback device) ....... 26
HDMI Control .......................................... 123
HDMI Control (HDMI, Setup menu) .......... 93
HDMI Control-compatible TV
(Connection) ........................................ 23
APPENDIX Index En 132
HDMI jack .................................................20
HDMI Monitor (Information menu) ...........101
HDMI OUT1
(Audio Output, Setup menu) .................94
HDMI OUT2
(Audio Output, Setup menu) .................94
HDMI output jack selection .......................43
HDMI video output
(ADVANCED SETUP) ..........................103
Headphones ...............................................8
Height Balance (Sound Program menu) ...84
High definition audio ...............................124
High speed HDMI cable ...........................20
I
Impedance (Speaker) ...............................13
In.Trim (Option menu) ...............................77
Indicator (Part names and functions) ..........9
INFO key ...................................................74
Information (Front display) ........................74
Information display ......................................9
Information display
(Radio Data System) .............................53
Information menu ....................................100
INIT (ADVANCED SETUP) ......................103
Initial Delay (Sound Program menu) .........83
Initial setting restoration
(ADVANCED SETUP) ..........................103
Initial Volume (Sound, Setup menu) ..........92
Initial Volume (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) ....97
Initialize ...................................................103
Input (Front display) ..................................74
Input menu ................................................78
Input menu item list ...................................78
Input selection keys (Remote control) ......11
Input Trim (Option menu) ..........................77
Internet radio .............................................66
IP Address ............................................... 95
IP Address (Network, Setup menu) .......... 95
iPad .......................................................... 56
iPhone ...................................................... 56
iTunes ....................................................... 68
L
Language ................................................. 34
Language (Setup menu) .......................... 34
Learning (Remote control) ..................... 107
Left / Right Balance
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 84
Level (Sound Program menu) .................. 84
Level (Speaker, Setup menu) ................... 90
LFE ......................................................... 120
Lip sync .................................................. 120
Lipsync (Sound, Setup menu) .................. 91
LIVE/CLUB (Sound program category) .... 47
Liveness (Sound Program menu) ............. 83
Load (Input menu) ................................... 81
Low Frequency Effects .......................... 120
M
MAC Address Filter
(Network, Setup menu) ........................ 95
Main Zone Set
(Multi Zone, Setup menu) ..................... 96
Manual Setup (Speaker, Setup menu) ..... 88
Manual station preset (FM/AM radio) ....... 52
Mass storage class device ...................... 60
Max Volume (Sound, Setup menu) .......... 91
Max Volume (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) .... 97
Media sharing .......................................... 63
Memory Guard (Function, Setup menu) ... 99
MON.CHK (ADVANCED SETUP) ........... 103
Monaural Mix (Sound Program menu) ..... 84
Monaural reception mode (FM radio) ...... 51
Monitor check (ADVANCED SETUP) ..... 103
Mono Movie (Sound program) ................. 46
MOVIE (Sound program category) .......... 46
MOVIE THEATER
(Sound program category) ................... 46
Multi measure (YPAO) .............................. 38
Multi Zone (Setup menu) .......................... 96
Multi-zone ................................................. 70
MUSIC (Sound program category) .......... 47
Music Video (Sound program) ................. 46
MUTE key ................................................. 11
Muting ...................................................... 11
N
NAS (Network Attached Storage) ............ 30
NAS (Playback) ........................................ 63
Neo:6 Cinema (Surround decoder) .......... 49
Neo:6 Music (Surround decoder) ............ 49
Network (Information menu) ................... 101
Network (Setup menu) ............................. 95
Network Attached Storage ....................... 30
Network cable .......................................... 30
Network Name (Network, Setup menu) .... 96
Network Standby (Network, Setup menu) 95
NTSC
(TV FORMAT, ADVANCED SETUP) ... 103
O
ON SCREEN key ...................................... 11
On-screen menu ...................................... 11
OPTICAL jack ........................................... 20
OPTION key ............................................. 75
Option menu ............................................. 75
Option menu item list ............................... 75
P
PAL
(TV FORMAT, ADVANCED SETUP) ... 103
APPENDIX Index En 133
Panorama (Sound Program menu) ...........84
Parametric EQ (Speaker, Setup menu) .....90
PARTY (Multizone function) ......................73
Party mode ................................................73
Party Mode Set
(Multi Zone, Setup menu) ......................97
PC (Connection) ........................................30
PC (Playback) ...........................................63
PHONES jack ..............................................8
PHONO jack (Connection) ........................29
Placement (Speaker) ................................13
Playback (iPod) .........................................56
Playback (NAS) .........................................63
Playback (PC) ...........................................63
Playback (USB storage device) ................60
PLII Game (Surround decoder) ................49
PLII Movie (Surround decoder) .................49
PLII Music (Surround decoder) .................49
PLIIx Game (Surround decoder) ...............49
PLIIx Movie (Extended surround) .............77
PLIIx Movie (Surround decoder) ...............49
PLIIx Music (Extended surround) .............77
PLIIx Music (Surround decoder) ...............49
PLIIxMo (Extended surround) ...................77
PLIIxMu (Extended surround) ...................77
Power Amp Assign
(Manual setup, Setup menu) .................88
PRE OUT jack ...........................................31
Presence speakers
(Speaker connection) ............................18
Preset (FM/AM radio) ................................52
Preset (Remote control code) .................106
Preset (TV, Remote control) ....................105
Preset stations (FM/AM radio) ...................52
Pro Logic (Surround decoder) ..................49
Program Service (Radio Data System) .....53
Program Type (Radio Data System) ........ 53
PURE DIRECT .......................................... 49
Pure Direct mode ..................................... 49
R
Radio Data System (FM radio) ................. 53
Radio Text (Radio Data System) .............. 53
Rear panel (Part names and functions) ... 10
Recording device (Connection) ............... 31
Remote connection .................................. 32
Remote control
(Part names and functions) .................. 11
Remote control code preset .................. 106
Remote control code preset (TV) ........... 105
Remote Control Code Search ................ 106
Remote control ID
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 102
Remote control ID setting ...................... 102
Remote control sensor ............................... 5
Remote control signal transmitter
(Remote control) .................................. 11
REMOTE ID (ADVANCED SETUP) ......... 102
Remote ID
(System, Information menu) ............... 101
REMOTE IN jack ...................................... 32
REMOTE OUT jack ................................... 32
Rename (Input) ........................................ 79
Rename (Network name) ......................... 96
Rename (Scene) ...................................... 82
Rename/Icon Select (Input menu) ........... 79
Rename/Icon Select (Scene menu) ......... 82
Reset (Remote control) .......................... 109
Resolution (Video Mode, Setup menu) .... 92
Restore of the default settings
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 103
Reverb Delay (Sound Program menu) ..... 84
Reverb Level (Sound Program menu) ...... 84
Reverb Time (Sound Program menu) ...... 83
Roleplaying Game (Sound program) ....... 46
Room Size (Sound Program menu) .......... 83
Router (Connection) ................................. 30
S
Sampling
(Audio Signal, Information menu) ....... 101
Save (Scene menu) .................................. 81
SCENE function ........................................ 44
Scene function ......................................... 44
Scene function configuration ................... 44
SCENE link ............................................... 32
Scene menu ............................................. 80
Scene menu item list ................................ 81
Sci-Fi (Sound program) ............................ 46
Setup menu .............................................. 85
Setup menu item list ................................. 86
Sharing setup ........................................... 63
Short Message
(Display Set, Setup menu) ................... 97
SILENT CINEMA ....................................... 50
Simple play (iPod) .................................... 58
Single measure (YPAO) ........................... 37
SLEEP (Zone2) ......................................... 73
SLEEP key ................................................ 11
Sleep timer ............................................... 11
Sound (Setup menu) ................................ 91
Sound field effect ..................................... 46
Sound mode ............................................. 45
Sound program ........................................ 46
Sound program category ......................... 46
Sound Program menu .............................. 82
Sound Program menu item list ................. 83
SP IMP. (ADVANCED SETUP) .................. 16
Speaker (Setup menu) ............................. 88
Speaker connection ................................. 17
APPENDIX Index En 134
Speaker connection (Bi-amp) ...................19
Speaker impedance ..................................13
Speaker Impedance
(System, Information menu) ................101
Speaker impedance setting ......................16
Speaker indicator (Front display) ................9
Speaker placement ...................................13
Spectacle (Sound program) .....................46
Sports (Sound program) ...........................46
Standard (Sound program) .......................46
Standby indicator (Front panel) ..................8
Standby Sync
(HDMI Control, Setup menu) .................94
Standby Through (HDMI, Setup menu) ....94
STEREO (Sound program category) .........47
Stereo pin cable ........................................20
STP network cable ....................................30
STRAIGHT (Sound mode) .........................48
Straight decode ........................................48
Subnet Mask .............................................95
Subwoofer
(Manual setup, Setup menu) .................89
Subwoofer connection ..............................18
Subwoofer Trim (Option menu) .................77
SUR.DEC (Sound mode) ...........................49
SUR.DECODE (Sound mode) ...................49
Surround (Speaker, Setup menu) .............88
Surround Back (Speaker, Setup menu) ....89
Surround Back Initial Delay
(Sound Program menu) .........................83
Surround Back Liveness
(Sound Program menu) .........................83
Surround Back Room Size
(Sound Program menu) .........................83
Surround decoder .....................................49
Surround Initial Delay
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 83
Surround Liveness
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 83
Surround Room Size
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 83
SW.Trim (Option menu) ............................ 77
System (Information menu) .................... 101
System ID
(System, Information menu) ............... 101
T
Target Zone
(Trigger Output, Setup menu) .............. 98
Test Tone (Speaker, Setup menu) ........... 90
The Bottom Line (Sound program) ........... 47
The Roxy Theatre (Sound program) ......... 47
TONE CONTROL ..................................... 76
Tone Control (Option menu) .................... 76
TP (Traffic Program) ................................. 53
Traffic information .................................... 53
Traffic Program (Option menu) ................ 53
Treble (Option menu) ............................... 76
Trigger function ........................................ 32
Trigger Mode
(Trigger Output, Setup menu) .............. 98
TRIGGER OUT jack .................................. 32
Trigger Output (Function, Setup menu) ... 98
TU (ADVANCED SETUP) .......................... 51
Tuning (FM/AM radio) .............................. 51
Turntable .................................................. 29
TV (Connection) ....................................... 24
TV Audio Input
(HDMI Control, Setup menu) ................ 93
TV connection .......................................... 21
TV FORMAT (ADVANCED SETUP) ........ 103
TV Format
(System, Information menu) ............... 101
TV operation keys (Remote control) ......... 11
TV without HDMI input jacks
(Connection) ........................................ 25
U
UPDATE (ADVANCED SETUP) .............. 104
Update (Firmware) ................................. 110
USB jack ..................................................... 8
USB storage device ................................. 60
V
VERSION (ADVANCED SETUP) ............. 104
Video (Setup menu) ................................. 92
VIDEO AUX jacks ..................................... 29
VIDEO jack ............................................... 20
Video Mode (Option menu) ...................... 77
Video Mode (Video, Setup menu) ............ 92
Video Out (Input menu) ............................ 80
Video pin cable ........................................ 20
Video Signal (Information menu) ............ 101
Video signal type
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 103
Video/audio input jack combination ......... 27
Virtual CINEMA DSP ................................. 48
Virtual Presence Speaker ......................... 48
VOLTAGE SELECTOR .............................. 33
Voltage selector ....................................... 33
Volume Interlock (Input menu) ................. 80
Volume Trim (Option menu) ..................... 77
VPS (Virtual Presence Speaker) ............... 48
W
Wall Paper (Display Set, Setup menu) ..... 98
Warning messages (YPAO) ..................... 42
Windows Media Player ............................. 63
APPENDIX Index En 135
Y
Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic
Optimizer (YPAO) ..................................35
YPAO
(Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic
Optimizer) .............................................35
YPAO MIC jack ...........................................8
YPAO microphone ....................................35
Z
Zone (Information menu) .........................101
Zone Rename
(Main Zone Set, Setup menu) ...............96
Zone Rename
(Zone2 Set, Setup menu) ......................97
Zone2 ........................................................70
Zone2 Set
(Main Zone Set, Setup menu) ...............97
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation YE227A0/EN

Documenttranscriptie

AV Receiver Owner’s Manual Read the supplied booklet “Safety Brochure” before using the unit. English CONTENTS Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Connecting a device that supports SCENE link playback (remote connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 6 8 Connecting the power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 What you can do with the unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 10 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) . . . . . . . . . 35 FEATURES Part names and functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 9 Selecting an on-screen menu language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Measuring at one listening position (single measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Checking the measurement results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Front display (indicators) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Warning messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 PREPARATIONS 12 PLAYBACK 43 General setup procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Basic playback procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 1 Placing speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Selecting an HDMI output jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 2 Connecting speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Input/output jacks and cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 3 Connecting a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Configuring scene assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Selecting the sound mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 4 Connecting playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Enjoying unprocessed playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Connecting to the jacks on the front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 5 Connecting the FM/AM antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Listening to FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 6 Connecting to a network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 7 Connecting other devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Connecting an external power amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Connecting recording devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Setting the frequency steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Selecting a frequency for reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Registering favorite radio stations (presets) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Radio Data System tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Operating the radio on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 En 2 Playing back iPod music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Configuring various functions (Setup menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Connecting an iPod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Setup menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Playback of iPod content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Speaker (Manual Setup) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Playing back music stored on a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Connecting a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Playback of USB storage device contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Multi Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Media sharing setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Playback of PC music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 ECO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Listening to Internet radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Preparing Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Controlling Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Viewing the current status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) . . . . . . . . . 100 Types of information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) . . . . . . 102 ADVANCED SETUP menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 Changing the speaker impedance setting (SP IMP.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 Switching information on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 Viewing the status information on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MON.CHK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 Configuring playback settings for different playback sources Restoring the default settings (INIT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 (Option menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Updating the firmware (UPDATE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 Option menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 CONFIGURATIONS 78 Checking the firmware version (VERSION) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 Controlling external devices with the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Registering the remote control code for a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 Registering the remote control codes for playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 Programming from other remote controls (learning) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 Configuring input sources (Input menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Input menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Clearing functions learned from other remote controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108 Resetting remote control codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 Updating the unit’s firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Scene menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Sound Program menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 En 3 APPENDIX 111 Frequently asked questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Power and system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 USB and network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Error indications on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Ideal speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Audio information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 HDMI and video information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Yamaha technologies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Video signal flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Information on HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 HDMI Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 HDMI signal compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Reference diagram (rear panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 En 4 Accessories Operating range of the remote control Check that the following accessories are supplied with the product. • Point the remote control at the remote control sensor on the unit and remain within the operating range shown below. … Remote control … Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) (x2) Within 6 m (20 ft) 30° 30° Insert the batteries the right way round. … AM antenna … FM antenna *One of the above is supplied depending on the region of purchase. … YPAO microphone … Power cable • The illustrations of the main unit and remote control used in this manual are of the U.S.A. model, unless otherwise specified. • Some features are not available in certain regions. *The supplied power cable varies depending on the region of purchase. … CD-ROM (Owner’s Manual) … Easy Setup Guide … Safety Brochure • Due to product improvements, specifications and appearance are subject to change without notice. • This manual explains operations using the supplied remote control. • This manual describes all the “iPod”, “iPhone” and “iPad” as the “iPod”. “iPod” refers to “iPod”, “iPhone” and “iPad”, unless otherwise specified. • indicates precautions for use of the unit and its feature limitations. • indicates supplementary explanations for better use. Accessories En 5 FEATURES What you can do with the unit Wide variety of supported content • iPod/iPhone/iPad . p.56 • USB . p.60 • Media server (PC/NAS) . p.63 • Internet radio . p.66 • AirPlay . p.68 Supports 2- to 7.1-channel (plus presence) speaker system. Allows you to enjoy your favorite acoustic spaces in various styles. • Automatically optimizing the speaker . p.35 settings to suit your room (YPAO) • Reproducing stereo or multichannel . p.46 sounds with the sound fields like actual movie theaters and concert halls (CINEMA DSP) • Enjoying compressed music with . p.50 enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) • Playing back music in multiple rooms . p.70 (multi-zone) Network contents Speakers Audio iPod/iPhone/iPad Audio HDMI Control USB device 3D and 4K signals supported Audio HDMI Control Video BD/DVD player Audio/Video TV AV receiver (the unit) Operating external devices with the supplied remote control . p.105 Sequential operation of a TV, AV receiver, and BD/DVD player (HDMI Control) Change the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) The unit’s remote control . p.44 TV remote control . p.123 FEATURES ➤ What you can do with the unit En 6 Full of useful functions! Useful tips ❑ Connecting various devices (p.26) ❑ Creating 3-dimensional sound fields (p.46) The combination of video/audio input jacks does not match an external device... A number of HDMI jacks and various input/output jacks on the unit allow you to connect video devices (such as BD/DVD players), audio devices (such as CD players), game consoles, camcorders, and other devices. Connecting presence speakers allows you to create a natural 3-dimensional sound field in your own room (CINEMA DSP 3D). Even when no presence speakers are connected, the Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) function produces 3D surround sound. Use “Audio In” in the “Input” menu to change the combination of video/audio input jacks so that it matches the output jack(s) of your external device (p.27). Video and audio are not synchronized... Use “Lipsync” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the delay between video and audio output (p.91). BD/DVD player I want to hear audio from the TV speakers... Use “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu to select the output destination of signals input into the unit (p.94). Your TV speakers may be selected as an output destination. CD player Game console I want to change the on-screen menu language... Use “Language” in the “Setup” menu to select a language from English, Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian and Chinese (p.34). Camcorder TV Set-top box I want to update the firmware... ❑ Listening to FM/AM radio (p.51) The unit is equipped with a built-in FM/AM tuner. You can register up to 40 favorite radio stations as presets. ❑ Playing back TV audio in surround sound with a single HDMI cable connection (Audio Return Channel: ARC) (p.21) When using an ARC -compatible TV, you only need one HDMI cable to enable video output to the TV, audio input from the TV, and the transmission of HDMI Control signals. HDMI Control TV audio ❑ Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (p.49) When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the unit plays back the selected source with the least circuitry, which lets you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality. ❑ Easy operation with a TV screen You can navigate through different types of content (such as iPod, USB, and network), view information, or easily configure the settings using the on-screen menu. ❑ Low power consumption Video from external device Use “UPDATE” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to update the unit’s firmware (p.104). If the unit is connected to the Internet, a message will be displayed on the TV when a firmware update is available (p.110). Many other settings are available that let you to customize the unit. For details, see the following pages. • Input settings (p.78) • Scene settings (p.81) • Sound program and surround decoder settings (p.83) • Various function settings (p.86) • Information view (such as audio signal and video signal) (p.101) • System settings (p.102) The ECO mode (power saving function) reduces the unit’s power consumption (p.99). FEATURES ➤ What you can do with the unit En 7 Part names and functions Front panel 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 : A B Opening the front panel door • To use controls or jacks behind the front panel door, gently press the bottom of the door to open it. Keep the door closed when not using controls or jacks behind the front panel door. MAIN ZONE PURE DIRECT ZONE 2 ZONE CONTROL INFO MEMORY PRESET INPUT BD/DVD PHONES SILENT CINEMA C FM AM TUNING VOLUME SCENE D USB TONE CONTROL PROGRAM TV E F G H 1 MAIN ZONE z key Turns on/off (standby) the unit. 2 Standby indicator Lights up when the unit is in standby mode under any of the following conditions. • HDMI Control is enabled (p.93) • Standby Through is enabled (p.94) • Network Standby is enabled (p.95) • An iPod is being charged (p.56) 3 ZONE 2 key Enables/disables the audio output to Zone2 (p.72). 4 ZONE CONTROL key Changes the zone (main zone or the Zone2) that is controlled by the keys and knobs on the front panel (p.72). 5 INFO key Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.74). Registers FM/AM radio stations as preset stations (p.52). 7 PRESET keys YPAO MIC VIDEO AUX STRAIGHT iPod/iPhone/iPad 5V 2.1A 6 MEMORY key RADIO NET VIDEO L AUDIO R I HDMI IN J K L 8 FM and AM keys Switch between FM and AM (p.51). 9 Front display Displays information (p.9). 0 Remote control sensor Receives remote control signals (p.5). A TUNING keys Select the radio frequency (p.51). B PURE DIRECT key Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.49). C INPUT knob Selects an input source. D SCENE keys Select the registered input source, sound program, and various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when it is in standby mode (p.44). E PHONES jack F USB jack For connecting a USB storage device (p.60) or an iPod (p.56). G TONE CONTROL key Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range of output sounds (p.76). H PROGRAM keys Select a sound program or a surround decoder (p.45). I STRAIGHT key Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.48). J VIDEO AUX jacks For connecting devices, such as camcorders and game consoles (p.29). K YPAO MIC jack For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.35). L VOLUME knob Adjusts the volume. For connecting headphones. Select a preset FM/AM radio station (p.52). FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 8 Front display (indicators) 1 OUT 1 2 3 OUT1/OUT2 Indicates the HDMI OUT jacks currently outputting an HDMI signal 2 CINEMA DSP Lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.46) is working. CINEMA DSP n Lights up when CINEMA DSP 3D (p.48) is working. 3 ENHANCER Lights up when Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50) is working. 4 ADAPTIVE DRC Lights up when Adaptive DRC (p.76) is working. 5 STEREO Lights up when the unit is receiving a stereo FM radio signal. 7 89 SLEEP ZONE 2 : VOL. MUTE SW PL PR C L R SL SR SBL SB SBR A Lights up when HDMI signals are being input or output. 5 6 ENHANCER ADAPTIVE DRC STEREO PARTY 3 TUNED 2 1 HDMI 4 B 6 PARTY Lights up when the unit is in the party mode. (p.73) 7 SLEEP Lights up when the sleep timer is on. 8 ZONE2 Lights up when audio output to Zone2 is enabled (p.72). 9 MUTE Blinks when audio is muted. 0 Volume indicator Indicates the current volume. A Cursor indicators Indicate the remote control cursor keys currently operational. A C C Speaker indicators Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output. A Front speaker (L) S Front speaker (R) D Center speaker F Surround speaker (L) G Surround speaker (R) H Surround back speaker (L) J Surround back speaker (R) K Surround back speaker Z Presence speaker (L) X Presence speaker (R) L Subwoofer B Information display Displays the current status (such as input name and sound mode name). You can switch the information by pressing INFO (p.74). TUNED Lights up when the unit is receiving an FM/AM radio station signal. FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 9 Rear panel 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 (U.S.A. model) RS-232C DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT (NET) HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 HDMI 6 HDMI 7 1 2 ARC SPEAKERS ANTENNA AM FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO CENTER SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND ZONE 2/PRESENCE REMOTE FM PR IN PR SINGLE OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y MONITOR OUT 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT EXTRA SP SINGLE CENTER AC IN OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 : AV OUT A AUDIO 1 AUDIO OUT AUDIO 2 B CDE 1 DC OUT jack For connecting to an optional accessory. 2 NETWORK jack For connecting to a network (p.30). 3 PHONO jacks (Except for U.S.A. and Canada models) For connecting to a turntable (p.29). 4 HDMI OUT 1–2 jacks For connecting to HDMI-compatible TVs and outputting video/audio signals (p.21). When using ARC, TV audio signal can also be input through the HDMI OUT 1 jack. 5 ANTENNA jacks For connecting to FM and AM antennas (p.30). 6 HDMI 1–7 jacks For connecting to HDMI-compatible playback devices and inputting video/audio signals (p.26). 7 RS-232C terminal This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation. Consult your dealer for details. ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND F G SUR. BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 H 9 VOLTAGE SELECTOR (General model only) Selects the switch position according to your local voltage (p.33). 0 AV 1–6 jacks For connecting to video/audio playback devices and inputting video/audio signals (p.26). A AV OUT jacks For outputting video/audio to a recording device (such as a VCR) (p.31). B AUDIO 1–2 jacks For connecting to audio playback devices and inputting audio signals (p.29). C MONITOR OUT jacks COMPONENT VIDEO jacks For connecting to a TV that supports component video and outputting video signals (p.25). VIDEO jack For connecting to a TV that supports composite video and outputting video signals (p.25). I * The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product to prevent improper connections. D REMOTE IN/OUT jacks For connecting to a Yamaha product that supports SCENE link playback (p.32) or for connecting to an infrared signal receiver/emitter that allows you to operate the unit and other devices from another room (p.71). E TRIGGER OUT jack For connecting to a device that supports the trigger function (p.32). F AUDIO OUT jacks For outputting audio to a recording device (such as tape deck) (p.31). G ZONE2 OUT jacks For connecting to the external amplifier used in Zone2 and for outputting audio (p.71). H PRE OUT jacks For connecting to a subwoofer with built-in amplifier or to an external power amplifier (p.31). I AC IN jack For connecting the supplied power cable (p.33). 8 SPEAKERS terminals For connecting to speakers (p.17). FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 10 Remote control 1 Remote control signal transmitter 1 Transmits infrared signals. 2 SOURCE z key 2 RECEIVER SOURCE Turns on/off an external device. SOURCE key HDMI 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 Sets the remote control to operate external devices (p.106). This key lights up in green after pressed. RECEIVER key AV Sets the remote control to operate the unit (p.106). This key lights up in orange after pressed. AUDIO 4 5 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 TV PROGRAM 7 TOP MENU NET MUTE OPTION I J K ENTER RETURN B C D E G H RADIO POP-UP/MENU 9 : A HDMI OUT VOLUME ON SCREEN RECEIVER z key Turns on/off (standby) the unit. SCENE BD DVD 6 8 2 DISPLAY L BAND MODE TUNING MUSIC SLEEP 1 2 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Changes the zone (main zone or Zone2) that is controlled by the remote control (p.72). 6 PROGRAM keys 5 6 9 0 3 4 7 Select a sound program (p.45). 7 External device operation keys 8 MEMORY 10 Select menus for external devices (p.106). ENT 8 ON SCREEN key TV F 4 MAIN/ZONE2 switch Select the registered input source, sound program, and various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when it is in standby mode (p.44). SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT INFO Select an input source for playback. HDMI 1–7 HDMI 1–7 jacks V-AUX VIDEO AUX jack (on the front panel) AV 1–6 AV 1–6 jacks AUDIO 1–2 AUDIO 1–2 jacks TUNER FM/AM radio USB USB jack (on the front panel) NET NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a desired network source) ★ (U.S.A. and Canada models only) Changes the external device to be controlled without switching the input source. PHONO (Except for U.S.A. and Canada models) PHONO jacks 5 SCENE keys PRESET MOVIE 3 Input selection keys INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET M Displays the on-screen menu on the TV. 9 Menu operation keys Cursor keys Select a menu or a parameter. ENTER Confirms a selected item. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. (U.S.A. model) 0 MODE key Switches the iPod operation modes (p.58). A Radio keys Operate the FM/AM radio when “TUNER” is selected as the input source (p.51). BAND Switches between FM and AM radio PRESET Select a preset station. TUNING Select the radio frequency. External device operation keys Let you play back and perform other operations for external devices when an input source other than “TUNER” is selected (p.106). B Sound mode keys Select a sound mode (p.45). C INFO key Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.74). D SLEEP key Switches the unit to standby mode automatically after a specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off). E Numeric keys Let you enter numerical values, such as radio frequencies. MEMORY key Registers FM/AM radio stations as presets (p.52). F TV operation keys Let you select TV input and volume, and perform other TV operations (p.105). G HDMI OUT key Selects HDMI OUT jacks to be used for video/audio output (p.43). H PARTY key Turns on/off the party mode (p.73). I VOLUME keys Adjust the volume. J MUTE key Mutes the audio output. K OPTION key Displays the option menu (p.75). L DISPLAY key Displays status information on the TV (p.74). M CODE SET key Registers remote control codes of external devices on the remote control (p.105). • To operate external devices with the remote control, register a remote control code for each device before using (p.105). FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 11 PREPARATIONS General setup procedure 1 Placing speakers (p.13) Select the speaker layout for the number of speakers that you are using and place them in your room. 2 Connecting speakers (p.17) Connect the speakers to the unit. 3 Connecting a TV (p.21) Connect a TV to the unit. 4 Connecting playback devices (p.26) Connect video devices (such as BD/DVD players) and audio devices (such as CD players) to the unit. 5 Connecting the FM/AM antennas (p.30) Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit. 6 Connecting to a network (p.30) Connect the unit to a network. 7 Connecting other devices (p.31) Connect external devices, such as an external power amplifier and recording devices. 8 Connecting the power cable (p.33) After all the connections are complete, plug in the power cable. 9 Selecting an on-screen menu language (p.34) Select the desired on-screen menu language (default: English). 10 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) (p.35) Optimize the speaker settings, such as volume balance and acoustic parameters, to suit your room (YPAO). This completes all the preparations. Enjoy playing movies, music, radio and other content with the unit! PREPARATIONS ➤ General setup procedure En 12 1 Speaker placement 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 Placing speakers Select the speaker layout for the number of speakers that you are using and place the speakers and subwoofer (with built-in amplifier) in your room. This section describes the representative speaker layout examples. Caution • Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the unit’s speaker impedance to “6 For details, see “Setting the speaker impedance” (p.16). MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. Speaker system (the number of channels) Speaker type Front (L) Abbr. 1 Front (R) 2 Center 3 Surround (L) 4 Surround (R) 5 Surround back (L) 6 Surround back (R) 7 Surround back 8 Presence (L) Q Presence (R) W Subwoofer Function 9 Produce front right/left channel sounds (stereo sounds). Produces center channel sounds (such as movie dialogue and vocals). Produce surround right/left channel sounds. Surround speakers also produce surround back channel sounds when no surround back speakers are connected. Produce surround back left/right channel sounds. 7.1+2 7.1 7.1 6.1 5.1 4.1 3.1 2.1 ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Produces sounds mixed from surround back left/right channel sounds. Produce CINEMA DSP effect sounds. In combination with CINEMA DSP 3D (p.48), the presence speakers create a natural 3-dimensional sound field in your room. Produces LFE (low-frequency effect) channel sounds and reinforces the bass parts of other channels. This channel is counted as “0.1”. You can connect 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to the unit. ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● • For information on the ideal speaker layout, see “Ideal speaker layout” (p.118). • If you have seven speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers or presence speakers. To reinforce the rear right/left sounds, use them as surround back speakers. To create a natural 3-dimensional sound field, use them as presence speakers. • Two subwoofers connected to the unit output the same sounds. PREPARATIONS ➤ Placing speakers En 13 1 Speaker placement 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 7.1+2-channel system 7.1-channel system (using surround back speakers) Q W 1 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 9 9 2 3 4 5 6 7 7 • The surround back speakers and presence speakers do not produce sounds simultaneously. The unit automatically changes the speakers to be used, depending on the selected CINEMA DSP (p.46). 7.1-channel system (using presence speakers) Q W 1 9 4 6.1-channel system 1 2 9 3 5 2 3 4 5 8 PREPARATIONS ➤ Placing speakers En 14 1 Speaker placement 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 5.1-channel system 3.1-channel system 1 9 2 1 3 9 4 3 5 4.1-channel system 2.1-channel system 1 2 1 9 4 2 2 9 5 PREPARATIONS ➤ Placing speakers En 15 1 Speaker placement 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Setting the speaker impedance Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the speaker impedance to “6 MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. 1 Before connecting speakers, connect the power cable to an AC wall outlet. 2 While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z. MAIN ZONE z STRAIGHT 3 Check that “SP IMP.” is displayed on the front display. SPIMP.8MIN 4 5 Press STRAIGHT to select “6 MIN”. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and remove the power cable from the AC wall outlet. You are now ready to connect the speakers. PREPARATIONS ➤ Placing speakers En 16 1 2 Speaker connections 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 2 Connecting speakers Connect the speakers placed in your room to the unit. The following diagrams provide connections for 7.1+2-, 7.1-, and 6.1-channel systems as examples. For other systems, connect speakers while referring to the connection diagram for the 6.1-channel system. 7.1+2-channel system 7.1-channel system (using surround back speakers) The unit (rear) The unit (rear) SPEAKERS FRONT CENTER SPEAKERS SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND ZONE 2/PRESENCE FRONT CENTER SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND ZONE 2/PRESENCE Caution SINGLE • Remove the unit’s power cable from an AC wall outlet and turn off the subwoofer before connecting the speakers. • Ensure that the core wires of the speaker cable do not touch one another or come into contact with the unit’s metal parts. Doing so may damage the unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will appear on the front display when the unit is turned on. SINGLE EXTRA SP SINGLE EXTRA SP CENTER SINGLE CENTER AC IN AUDIO OUT ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT AC IN 1 SUBWOOFER 2 AUDIO OUT ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 Cables required for connection (commercially available) Speaker cables (x the number of speakers) + – Q W + – 1 2 1 2 Audio pin cable (two for connecting two subwoofers) 9 3 9 4 5 6 7 9 3 4 5 6 7 PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 17 1 2 Speaker connections 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 7.1-channel system (using presence speakers) The unit (rear) The unit (rear) SPEAKERS FRONT ■ Connecting speaker cables 6.1-channel system CENTER SPEAKERS SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND ZONE 2/PRESENCE FRONT CENTER SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND SINGLE SINGLE EXTRA SP SINGLE EXTRA SP CENTER SINGLE ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT AC IN 1 SUBWOOFER 2 AUDIO OUT ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT a Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8”) of insulation from the ends of the speaker cable and twist the bare wires of the cable firmly together. CENTER AC IN AUDIO OUT ZONE 2/PRESENCE Speaker cables have two wires. One is for connecting the negative (-) terminal of the unit and the speaker, and the other is for the positive (+) terminal. If the wires are colored to prevent confusion, connect the black wire to the negative and the other wire to the positive terminal. b Loosen the speaker terminal. c Insert the bare wires of the cable into the gap on the side (upper right or bottom left) of the terminal. 1 SUBWOOFER 2 d Tighten the terminal. Q + (red) W 1 2 1 b c FR ON 2 T d a - (black) 9 3 9 3 Using a banana plug (U.S.A., Canada, China, Australia and General models only) 4 5 4 5 a Tighten the speaker terminal. b Insert a banana plug into the end of the terminal. 8 Banana plug a FR ON T b When using only one surround back speaker, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). ■ Connecting the subwoofer Use an audio pin cable to connect the subwoofer. Audio pin cable PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 18 1 2 Speaker connections 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp connections When using front speakers that support bi-amp connections, connect them to the FRONT jacks and SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP jacks. To enable the bi-amp function, set “Power Amp Assign” (p.88) in the “Setup” menu to “5ch BI-AMP” after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. Caution • Before making bi-amp connections, remove any brackets or cables that connect a woofer with a tweeter. Refer to the instruction manual of the speakers for details. If you are not making bi-amp connections, make sure that the brackets or cables are connected before connecting the speaker cables. • Surround back speakers cannot be used during bi-amp connections. The unit (rear) SPEAKERS FRONT CENTER SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND ZONE 2/PRESENCE SINGLE EXTRA SP SINGLE CENTER AC IN AUDIO OUT ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT 1 1 SUBWOOFER 2 2 3 9 4 5 PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 19 Input/output jacks and cables ■ Video/audio jacks ■ Video jacks ■ Audio jacks ❑ HDMI jacks ❑ COMPONENT VIDEO jacks ❑ OPTICAL jacks Transmit digital video and digital sound through a single jack. Use an HDMI cable. Transmit video signals separated into three components: luminance (Y), chrominance blue (PB), and chrominance red (PR). Use a component video cable with three plugs. Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital optical cable. Remove the tip protector (if available) before using the cable. HDMI cable Digital optical cable Component video cable OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 ❑ COAXIAL jacks • Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. We recommend using a cable less than 5.0 m (16.4 ft) long to prevent signal quality degradation. Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital coaxial cable. • To connect a device that has a DVI jack, an HDMI/DVI-D cable is required. Digital coaxial cable • The unit’s HDMI jacks support the HDMI Control, Audio Return Channel (ARC), and 3D and 4K video transmission features. ❑ VIDEO jacks Transmit analog video signals. Use a video pin cable. • Use high speed HDMI cables to enjoy 3D or 4K videos. Video pin cable ❑ AUDIO jacks Transmit analog stereo audio signals. Use a stereo pin cable. Stereo pin cable PREPARATIONS ➤ Input/output jacks and cables En 20 1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 3 Connecting a TV Connect a TV to the unit so that video input to the unit can be output to the TV. You can also enjoy playback of TV audio on the unit. ■ Connection Method 1 (HDMI Control/ARC-compatible TV) Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable. The connection method varies depending on the functions and video input jacks available on your TV. Refer to the instruction manual of the TV and choose a connection method. Does your TV support Audio Return Channel (ARC)? Yes • The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters (p.93) in the “Setup” menu. • HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack. ■ Connection Method 1 (p.21) • Use an HDMI cable that supports ARC. HDMI OUT 1 jack No Does your TV support HDMI Control? The unit (rear) Yes HDMI OUT 1 2 ARC ■ Connection Method 2 (p.23) HDMI DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI input (ARC-compatible) HDMI OUT (NET) 1 HDMI 2 ARC ARC No ANTENNA HDMI (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO AM PR Does your TV have an HDMI input jack? Yes PB ■ Connection Method 3 (p.24) No VIDEO Y OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT TV ■ Connection Method 4 (p.25) About HDMI Control HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit’s power and volume with the TV’s remote control. You can also control playback devices (such as an HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD player) connected to the unit with an HDMI cable. For details, see “HDMI Control” (p.123). • By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV (except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.122). • By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV. • You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.25). About Audio Return Channel (ARC) ARC allows audio signals to travel both ways under HDMI Control. If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control and ARC to the unit with a single HDMI cable, you can output video/audio to the TV or input TV audio to the unit. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a TV En 21 1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ Necessary settings To use HDMI Control and ARC, you need to configure the following settings. 3 Configure the settings for HDMI Control. For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV. a Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD player). 1 After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback devices) and the power cable to the unit, turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices. b Turn off the TV’s main power and then turn off the unit and playback devices. 2 Configure the settings of the unit. c Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV’s main power. d Switch the TV input to display video from the unit. a Check that ARC is enabled on the TV. b Switch the TV input to display video from the unit. c Press ON SCREEN. ON SCREEN RETURN On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select the input source manually. On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed. OPTION ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER ENTER e Check the following. DISPLAY d Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. f Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control. This completes the necessary settings. If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of the unit will be automatically switched to “AV 4” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit. If you cannot hear the TV’s audio, check that “ARC” (p.94) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”. • If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and then plugging in again) the devices. It may solve the problem. • If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on the TV. • If the audio is interrupted while using ARC, set “ARC” (p.94) in the “Setup” menu to “Off” and use a digital optical cable to input TV audio to the unit (p.23). e Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”. • “AV 4” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks, use “TV Audio Input” (p.93) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.44), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV). f Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER. g Use the cursor keys to select “On”. h Press ON SCREEN. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a TV En 22 1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Connection Method 2 (HDMI Control-compatible TV) ❑ Necessary settings Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and a digital optical cable. To use HDMI Control, you need to configure the following settings. For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV. • The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters (p.93) in the “Setup” menu. 1 After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback devices) and power cable of the unit, turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices. 2 Configure the settings of the unit. • HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack. HDMI OUT 1 jack The unit (rear) HDMI OUT 1 a Switch the TV input to display video from the unit. 2 ARC HDMI DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI input b Press ON SCREEN. HDMI OUT (NET) 1 HDMI 2 ARC ON SCREEN HDMI ANTENNA OPTION (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER AM PR ENTER PB VIDEO Y RETURN OPTICAL OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 OPTICAL AV (TV) AV 5 AV 6 O DISPLAY c Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. O OUT (TV) AV 4 AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack TV Audio output (digital optical) • By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV (except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.122). • By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV. • You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.25). d Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”. e Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER. f Use the cursor keys to select “On”. g Press ON SCREEN. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a TV En 23 1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 3 Configure the settings for HDMI Control. a Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as a HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD player). b Turn off the TV’s main power and then turn off the unit and playback devices. c Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV. ■ Connection Method 3 (TV with HDMI input jacks) Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and a digital optical cable. HDMI OUT 1 jack The unit (rear) HDMI OUT 1 2 ARC HDMI HDMI input d Switch the TV input to display video from the unit. DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI OUT (NET) e Check the following. On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select the input source manually. 1 HDMI 2 ARC HDMI ANTENNA (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO AM PR PB On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed. VIDEO Y f Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control. This completes the necessary settings. If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of the unit will be automatically switched to “AV 4” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit. OPTICAL OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 OPTICAL AV (TV) AV 5 AV 6 O O OUT (TV) AV 4 AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack TV Audio output (digital optical) If you switch the input source of the unit to “AV 4” using the AV 4 or SCENE(TV) keys, the TV audio will be played back on the unit. • If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and then plugging in again) the devices. It may solve the problem. • If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on the TV. • “AV 4” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or if you want to use another input jack (other than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, use “TV Audio Input” (p.93) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.44), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV). • By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV (except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.122). • By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV. • If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or if you want to use another input jack (other than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, connect the TV to one of the AV 1–6 and AUDIO 1–2 jacks. To use the SCENE function (p.44), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV). • You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.25). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a TV En 24 1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Connection Method 4 (TV without HDMI input jacks) When connecting any video device to the AV 1–2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks of the unit, connect the TV to the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks. When connecting any video device to the AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jacks or the front VIDEO jack of the unit, connect the TV to the MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack. If you select “AV 4” as the input source by pressing AV 4 or SCENE(TV), the TV audio will be played back on the unit. ❑ VIDEO (composite video) connection (with a video pin cable) MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack The unit (rear) DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT (NET) 1 HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) 2 Video input (composite video) H VIDEO VIDEO ARC ANTENNA COMPONENT VIDEO AM V COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) V REM FM NITOR OUT PR IN PR OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y • If you connect your TV to the unit with a cable other than HDMI, video input to the unit via HDMI cannot be output to the TV. 12 TRIGG MONITOR OUT OPTICAL • Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI. OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV OUT (TV) AV 5 AV 6 OPTICAL AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 O O (TV) AV 4 ❑ COMPONENT VIDEO connection (with a component video cable) Video input (component video) COMPONENT VIDEO MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks The unit (rear) 1 HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) PR HDM The unit has two HDMI output jacks. If you connect another TV or a projector to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can switch the TV (or projector) to be used for watching videos with the remote control (p.43). HDMI OUT 2 jack The unit (rear) PB PR PR ANTENNA HDMI Y DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI OUT (NET) REMOT FM 1 Y PINB 2 ARC PB COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) AM Y TV HDMI OUT 1 PB 2 ARC Audio output (digital optical) ■ Connecting another TV or a projector PR COMPONENT VIDEO HDMI 1 HDMI OUT TV AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack • If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or if you want to use another input jack (other than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, connect the TV to one of the AV 1–6 and AUDIO 1–2 jacks. To use the SCENE function (p.44), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV). 2 ARC PR OUT ANTENNA PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y MONITOR OUT (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO AM MONITOR OU PR HDMI 12V TRIGGER OU HDMI input PB VIDEO OPTICAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 3 AV 4 O AV (TV) AV 5 AV 6 OUT OPTICAL AUDIO 1 HDMI Y O AUDIO 2 (TV) AV 4 AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack TV Audio output (digital optical) OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT TV (already connected) Projector • HDMI Control is not available on the HDMI OUT 2 jack. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a TV En 25 1 2 3 4 Playback device connections 5 6 7 8 9 10 4 Connecting playback devices The unit is equipped with a variety of input jacks including HDMI input jacks to allow you to connect different types of playback devices. For information on how to connect an iPod or a USB storage device, see the following pages. – Connecting an iPod (p.56) ■ Component video connection Connect a video device to the unit with a component video cable and an audio cable (digital optical or digital coaxial). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device. – Connecting a USB storage device (p.60) Output jacks on video device Input jacks on the unit Video Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) Connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, set-top boxes (STBs) and game consoles to the unit. Depending on the video/audio output jacks available on your video device, choose one of the following connections. We recommend using an HDMI connection if the video device has an HDMI output jack. • If the combination of video/audio input jacks available on the unit does not match your video device, change its combination according to the output jacks of your device (p.27). Audio Digital optical AV 1 (COMPONENT VIDEO + OPTICAL) Digital coaxial AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + COAXIAL) Component video Video output (component video) AV 1–2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks The unit (rear) COMPONENT VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO PR PR DC OUT 5V 0.5A ■ HDMI connection NETWORK HDMI OUT (NET) 1 PB ANTENNA Connect a video device to the unit with an HDMI cable. The unit (rear) PR PR PB PB Y Y PB 2 ARC (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO Y AM Y PR PB HDMI 1–7 jacks VIDEO Y RS-232C HDMI 1 HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 O O C C OPTICAL HDMI 6 HDMI 7 SPEAKERS ENNA FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO DIO) CENTER REMOTE FM IN PR PB Y HDMI output HDMI OUT VIDEO HDMI MONITOR OUT CENTER AUDIO 2 OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) Video device AV AV 5 OPTICAL OUT COAXIAL AV 6 AV2 COAXIAL AV 1 (OPTICAL) jack or AV 2 (COAXIAL) jack Audio output (digital optical or digital coaxial) If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–2, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. HDMI AUDIO 1 COAXIAL 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT SINGLE AV OUT COAXIAL AV1 SURROU SURROUND OPTICAL AUDIO OUT ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT 1 SUB Video device If you select the input source by pressing HDMI 1–7, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. • The component video signals (other than 480i/576i signals) input to AV 1–2 jacks of the unit can be output from the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks only. To watch those videos, you need to connect your TV to the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks of the unit (p.25). • To watch videos input to the HDMI 1–7 jacks, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack of the unit (p.21 to 24). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting playback devices En 26 1 2 3 4 Playback device connections 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Composite video connection ■ Changing the combination of video/audio input jacks Connect a video device to the unit with a video pin cable and an audio cable (digital coaxial, digital optical, or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device. If the combination of video/audio input jacks available on the unit does not match your video device, change its combination according to the output jacks of your device. You can connect a video device that has the following video/audio output jacks. Output jacks on video device Output jacks on video device Input jacks on the unit Input jacks on the unit Video Audio Composite video Video Digital coaxial AV 3 (VIDEO + COAXIAL) Digital optical AV 4 (VIDEO + OPTICAL) Analog stereo AV 5–6 (VIDEO + AUDIO) HDMI Audio Video Audio Digital optical HDMI 1–7 AV 1 (OPTICAL) AV 4 (OPTICAL) Digital coaxial HDMI 1–7 AV 2–3 (COAXIAL) Analog stereo HDMI 1–7 AV 5–6 (AUDIO) AUDIO 1–2 Analog stereo AV 1–2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) AV 5–6 (AUDIO) AUDIO 1–2 Video output (composite video) AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jack Component video VIDEO DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK V HDMI OUT (NET) VIDEO 1 ❑ Necessary setting 2 ARC V ANTENNA (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO For example, if you have connected a video device to AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) and AV 5 (AUDIO) jacks of the unit, change the combination setting as follows. AM PR PB Video device VIDEO Y C OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 COAXIAL AV OUT O AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks COMPONENT VIDEO The unit (rear) O OPTICAL (TV) OPTICAL L The unit (rear) Video output (component video) C COAXIAL PR L L L R R R DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI OUT (NET) 1 R PR PR 2 ARC PB PB PB Y A COMPONENT VIDEO Y AM Y PR Audio output Any of AV 3 (COAXIAL) jack, (either digital optical, AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack, digital coaxial, or analog stereo) AV 5–6 (AUDIO) jacks PB VIDEO Y L AUDIO L If you select the input source by pressing AV 3–6, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 L L R R AV 6 R Video device R AV 5 • To watch videos input to the AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jacks, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack (p.21 to 24) or to the MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack (p.25) of the unit. AV 5 (AUDIO) jacks Audio output (analog stereo) PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting playback devices En 27 1 2 3 4 Playback device connections 5 6 7 8 9 10 • The following operation is available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI. 1 After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback devices) and power cable of the unit, turn on the unit. 2 Press AV 2 to select “AV 2” (video input jack to be used) as the input source. 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 USB NET N 6 7 Use the cursor keys to select “Audio In” and press ENTER. 8 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “AV5” (audio input jack to be used). AV AV 2 AUDIO TUNER TOP MENU 2 POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN 3 4 5 DISPLAY ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER This completes the necessary settings. If you select “AV 2” as the input source by pressing AV 2, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “AV2” (video input jack to be used) and press the cursor key (q). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting playback devices En 28 1 2 3 4 Playback device connections 5 6 7 8 9 10 Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) Connecting to the jacks on the front panel Connect audio devices such as CD players, MD players, and a turntable to the unit. Depending on the audio output jacks available on your audio device, choose one of the following connections. Use the VIDEO AUX jack to temporarily connect devices such as game consoles and camcorders to the unit. Audio output jacks on audio device Audio output jacks on the unit Digital optical AV 1 (OPTICAL) AV 4 (OPTICAL) Digital coaxial AV 2–3 (COAXIAL) Analog stereo AV 5–6 (AUDIO) AUDIO 1–2 Turntable (PHONO) PHONO* Use the USB jack to connect an iPod or a USB storage device. For details, see “Connecting an iPod” (p.56) or “Connecting a USB storage device” (p.60). Before making a connection, stop playback on the device and turn down the volume on the unit. The unit (front) PHONES SILENT CINEMA USB iPod/iPhone/iPad 5V 2.1A TONE CONTROL PROGRAM YPAO MIC VIDEO AUX STRAIGHT VIDEO L V L AUDIO R R HDMI IN HDMI * Except for U.S.A. and Canada models Audio output (PHONO) PHONO jacks* PHONO L The unit (rear) PHONO L L R R R GND DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT (NET) 1 HD (BD/DVD) Ground lead GND Turntable 2 ARC ANTENNA COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO AM Game console FM PR O PR O OPTICAL PB OPTICAL PB VIDEO Y Y C MONITOR C COAXIAL COAXIAL L OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT L L AUDIO 1 Audio device Camcorder L AUDIO 2 R R R AV 1–6 jacks AUDIO 1–2 jacks R If you select “V-AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the video/audio played back on the device will be output from the unit. Audio output (either digital optical, digital coaxial, or analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2 or PHONO*, the audio played back on the audio device will be output from the unit. • To watch videos input to the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack of the unit (p.21 to 24). • You need to prepare an HDMI cable that match the output jacks on your device. When connecting a turntable (Except for U.S.A. and Canada models) • The PHONO jack of the unit is compatible with an MM cartridge. To connect a turntable with a low-output MC cartridge, use a boosting transformer. • Connecting the turntable to the GND terminal of the unit may reduce noise in the signal. • If you connect video devices to both the HDMI IN jack and VIDEO/AUDIO jacks, the unit outputs video/audio input through the HDMI IN jack. • When “USB” is selected as the input source, video signals input to the VIDEO AUX (VIDEO) jack are output from the HDMI OUT and MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jacks. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting playback devices En 29 1 2 3 4 5 FM/AM antenna connections 6 Network connections 7 8 9 10 5 Connecting the FM/AM antennas Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit. Fix the end of the FM antenna to a wall, and place the AM antenna on a flat surface. 6 Connecting to a network Connect the unit to your router with a commercially-available STP network cable (CAT-5 or higher straight cable). You can enjoy Internet radio or music files stored on media servers, such as PCs and Network Attached Storage (NAS), on the unit. FM antenna AM antenna Internet Network Attached Storage (NAS) WAN The unit (rear) PC RS-23 LAN DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT (NET) HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 HDMI 6 Modem HDMI 7 1 2 ARC SPEA ANTENNA AM FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO CENTER SURROUND REMOTE FM PR IN PR OUT PB VIDEO PB VIDEO Y Y MONITOR OUT Router 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT Network cable Assembling and connecting the AM antenna Mobile device (such as iPod touch and iPhone) DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT (NET) 1 HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) 2 ARC ANTENNA COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO AM FM PR PR PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y MONITOR OUT The unit (rear) Hold down Insert Release OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 • If you are using a router that supports DHCP, you do not need to configure any network settings for the unit, as the network parameters (such as the IP address) will be assigned automatically to it. You only need to configure the network settings if your router does not support DHCP or if you want to configure the network parameters manually (p.95). • You can check whether the network parameters (such as IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu. • Unwind only the length of cable needed from the AM antenna unit. • Some security software installed on your PC or the firewall settings of network devices (such as a router) may block the access of the unit to the network devices or the Internet. In these cases, configure the security software or firewall settings appropriately. • The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity. • Each server must be connected to the same subnet as the unit. • To use the service via the Internet, broadband connection is strongly recommended. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting the FM/AM antennas En 30 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Other connections 8 9 10 7 Connecting other devices Connecting an external power amplifier When connecting an external power amplifier (pre-main amplifier) to enhance speaker output, connect the input jacks of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks of the unit. The same channel signals are output from the PRE OUT jacks as from their corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. 5 CENTER jack Outputs center channel sounds. Connecting recording devices You can connect video/audio recording devices to the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks. These jacks output analog video/audio signals selected as the input. • To copy video/audio from a video device, connect the video device to the AV 5–6 jacks of the unit. Caution • To copy audio from an audio device, connect the audio device to the AV 5–6 jacks or AUDIO 1–2 jacks of the unit. • To prevent the generation of loud noises or abnormal sounds, make sure the followings before making connections. • Be sure to use the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks only for connecting recording devices. Video/audio input – Remove the power cable of the unit and turn off the external power amplifier before connecting them. – When using the PRE OUT jacks, do not connect speakers to the corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. The unit (rear) – When using an external amplifier that does not have the volume control bypass, do not connect other devices (except the unit) to the amplifier. AV OUT jacks VIDEO V HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI 3 V HDMI 4 HDMI 5 2 L ARC L ANTENNA The unit (rear) FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) AM OUT HDMI 1 HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) R IN Video recording device PR RS-232C HDMI OUT L CENTE REMOTE FM HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 PB VIDEO Y HDMI 6 R R VIDEO AV OUT MONITOR OUT AUDIO 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT HDMI 7 2 C SPEAKERS ANTENNA FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) AM CENTER ZONE 2/PRESENCE SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND REMOTE FM COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO OUT ZONE 2 OUT IN PR SINGLE OUT PB Y L VIDEO MONITOR OUT 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT L L R R EXTRA SP SINGLE CENTER R AC IN AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO OUT ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 1 23 4 5 Audio recording device AUDIO OUT AUDIO AUDIO OUT jacks Audio input 1 FRONT jacks Output front channel sounds. 2 SURROUND jacks Output surround channel sounds. 3 SUR. BACK jacks Output surround back channel sounds. When using only one external amplifier for the surround back channel, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). 4 SUBWOOFER1–2 jacks For connecting a subwoofer with built-in amplifier. When 2 subwoofers are connected, the same sound is output from them. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting other devices En 31 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Other connections 8 9 10 Connecting a device that supports SCENE link playback (remote connection) If you have a Yamaha product that supports SCENE control signal transmission, you can operate it remotely by connecting it to the REMOTE OUT jack, using a monaural mini-jack cable, and linking with the SCENE function (p.44). REMOTE OUT jack Remote input REMOTE HDMI 1 HDMI OUT HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI 3 HDMI 4 REMOTE IN HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 2 ARC OUT 2 HDMI 1 HDMI OUT IN 1 The trigger function can control an external device in conjunction with operating the unit (such as powering on/off and input selection). If you have a Yamaha subwoofer that supports a system connection or a device with a trigger input jack, you can use the trigger function by connecting the external device to the TRIGGER OUT jack. The unit (rear) The unit (rear) K Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function ANTENNA AM FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) ARC CE REMOTE FM IN ANTENNA AM PR FRO COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) OUT REMOTE FM IN PB VIDEO PR OUT Y PB VIDEO Y VIDEO MONITOR OUT 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT AV 5 COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT AUDIO 1 MONITOR OUT System connection input 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT Yamaha product (such as a DVD player) AUDIO 2 AV 6 AV OUT AUDIO 1 AUDIO OUT AUDIO 2 ZONE 2 OUT 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT TRIGGER OUT jack Yamaha subwoofer that supports a system connection • If you connect a Yamaha product that supports the SCENE link playback function, to the REMOTE OUT jack, you can remotely start playback on it by linking with a scene selection (p.44). To enable the SCENE link playback function, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.81) in the “Scene” menu. • You can configure the trigger function settings in “Trigger Output” (p.98) in the “Setup” menu. • You can also connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to operate devices in the main zone from Zone2 (p.71). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting other devices En 32 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Power cable connection 9 10 8 Connecting the power cable Before connecting the power cable (General model only) After all the connections are complete, connect the supplied power cable to the unit and then to an AC wall outlet. Set the switch position of VOLTAGE SELECTOR according to your local voltage. Voltages are AC 110–120/220–240 V, 50/60 Hz. The unit (rear) RS-232C DMI 5 HDMI 6 HDMI 7 • Make sure you set VOLTAGE SELECTOR of the unit BEFORE plugging the power cable into an AC wall outlet. Improper setting of VOLTAGE SELECTOR may cause damage to the unit and create a potential fire hazard. SPEAKERS CENTER SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND ZONE 2/PRESENCE SINGLE VOLTAGE SELECTOR The unit (rear) EXTRA SP VOLTAGE SELECTOR 220V-240V SINGLE CENTER 110V-120V AC IN RS-232C NE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 HDMI 7 SPEAKERS SURROUND BACK/BI AMP OUND ZONE 2/PRESENCE SINGLE EXTRA SP SINGLE CENTER AC IN RROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT To an AC wall outlet 1 SUBWOOFER 2 PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting the power cable En 33 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Language setting 10 RECEIVER SOURCE RECEIVER z 9 Selecting an on-screen menu language HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 Select the desired on-screen menu language from English (default), Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian and Chinese. AV 1 2 AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN ON SCREEN 1 2 Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit. 3 4 Press ON SCREEN. 5 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Language” and the cursor keys (q/w) to select the desired language. OPTION Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). 6 7 To confirm the setting, press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. • The information on the front display is provided in English only. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET PREPARATIONS ➤ Selecting an on-screen menu language En 34 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Automatic speaker setup RECEIVER SOURCE RECEIVER z 10 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 AV 1 2 AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 The Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) function detects speaker connections, measures the distances from them to your listening position(s), and then automatically optimizes the speaker settings, such as volume balance and acoustic parameters, to suit your room. 4 YPAO MIC jack HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO Place the YPAO microphone at your listening position (same height as your ears) and connect it to the YPAO MIC jack on the front panel. The unit (front) YPAO MIC • Please note the following when using YPAO. – Use YPAO after connecting a TV and speakers to the unit. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION – During the measuring process, test tones are output at high volume. Ensure that the test tones do not frighten small children. Also, refrain from using this function at night when it may be a nuisance to others. – During the measuring process, you cannot adjust the volume. 1 2 – During the measuring process, keep the room as quiet as possible. – Do not connect headphones. ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET 1 2 3 Turn on the subwoofer and set the volume to half. If the crossover frequency is adjustable, set it to maximum. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 9 Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit. Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). 4 3 YPAO 5 microphone ENHANCER PURE DIRECT MEMORY 10 ENT Ear height TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE Place the YPAO microphone at your listening position (same height as your ears). We recommend the use of a tripod as a microphone stand. You can use the tripod screws to stabilize the microphone. TV CH CODE SET VOLUME MIN MAX CROSSOVER/ HIGH CUT MIN 9 MAX • If you are using bi-amp connection or Zone2 speakers, set “Power Amp Assign” (p.88) in the “Setup” menu to the appropriate setting before starting YPAO. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 35 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Automatic speaker setup The following screen appears on the TV. RECEIVER SOURCE • If you perform the multi measure, the speaker settings will be optimized for you to enjoy surround sound in a wider space. HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET • If you perform the multi measure, first place the YPAO microphone at the listening position you will be seated most frequently. AV AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 Single measure Multi measure (5 listening positions) HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME • To cancel the operation, disconnect the YPAO microphone before starting the measurement. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN 5 OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY If desired, change the measuring method (multi/single). d e bac a Use the cursor keys to select “Multi Position” and press ENTER. b Use the cursor keys to select a setting and then press ENTER. Multi measure Multi measure (1 listening position + front/back/left/right) (2 listening positions + front/back) BAND MODE TUNING a PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT b c a e d TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET c a b d Settings Yes Select this option if you will have several listening positions or if you want others to enjoy surround sound. You can take measurements at up to 8 different positions in the room. The speaker settings will be optimized to suit the area defined by those positions (multi measure). No (default) Select this option if your listening position will always be fixed. Take the measurements at only one position. The speaker settings will be optimized to suit that position (single measure). This completes the preparations. See the following page to start the measurement. When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”: “Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)” (p.38) When “Multi Position” is set to “No”: “Measuring at one listening position (single measure)” (p.37) PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 36 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Automatic speaker setup Measuring at one listening position (single measure) RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 Follow the procedure below for measurement. AV 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and press ENTER. 3 To save the measurement results, use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “SAVE” and press ENTER. AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 • Do not stand between the speakers and the YPAO microphone during the measurement process (about 3 minutes). HDMI OUT • Move to the corner of the room or leave the room. SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU 1 RADIO To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to select “Measure” and press ENTER. VOLUME The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the measurement immediately. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION The adjusted speaker settings are applied. ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Cursor keys ENTER RETURN • To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN. The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement finishes. • To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”. BAND MODE TUNING 4 PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 7 Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit. This completes optimization of the speaker settings. 4 Caution 8 MEMORY 10 • The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on top of AV equipment). ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET • If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error messages” (p.41) or “Warning messages” (p.42). • To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking the measurement results” (p.39). PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Automatic speaker setup Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 3 When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”, follow the procedure below for measurement. AV When you have taken measurements at 8 listening positions, the following screen appears automatically. AUDIO 5 6 TUNER MAIN 1 USB 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 • Do not stand between the speakers and the YPAO microphone during the measurement process. It takes about 10 minutes to measure 8 listening positions. HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD When the measurements at the positions you want to measure are completed, use the cursor keys to select “CANCEL” and press ENTER. TV NET • Move to the corner of the room or leave the room. RADIO • If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error messages” (p.41) or “Warning messages” (p.42). PROGRAM MUTE VOLUME 1 TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the measurement immediately. OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Cursor keys ENTER RETURN • To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking the measurement results” (p.39). • To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN. BAND MODE TUNING The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement at the first position finishes. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to select “Measure” and press ENTER. 4 Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and press ENTER. 5 To save the measurement result, use the cursor keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 2 Move the YPAO microphone to the next listening position and press ENTER. Repeat step 2 until measurements at all listening positions (up to 8) have been taken. The adjusted speaker settings are applied. • To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 38 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Automatic speaker setup 6 RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 4 Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit. 2 This completes optimization of the speaker settings. Wiring Polarity of each speaker Normal: The speaker cable is connected with the correct polarity (+/-). Reverse: The speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity (+/-). Size Size of each speaker (cross-over frequency of the subwoofer) Large: The speaker can reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. Small: The speaker cannot reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. You can check the YPAO measurement results. Distance Distance from the listening position to each speaker 1 Level Output level adjustment for each speaker AV 1 2 3 5 6 1 Use the cursor keys to select an item. Caution AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 • The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on top of AV equipment). NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO Checking the measurement results PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING Cursor keys ENTER RETURN After the measurement, use the cursor keys to select “Result” and press ENTER. • A speaker with a problem is indicated with a message enclosed in a red box. • You can also select “Result” from “Auto Setup” (p.86) in the “Setup” menu, which displays the previous measurement results. 3 The following screen appears. PRESET To finish checking the results and return to the previous screen, press RETURN. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT 1 TV 2 INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 3 1 Measurement result items 2 Measurement result details 3 The number of measured positions (when multi measure is performed) PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 39 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Automatic speaker setup Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET When the speaker settings you have configured manually are not suitable, follow the procedure below to discard the manual settings and reload the previous YPAO adjustments. AV AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU 1 In the “Setup” menu, select “Speaker”, “Auto Setup”, and then “Result” (p.85). 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Setup Reload” and press ENTER. 3 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. HDMI OUT RADIO VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN ON SCREEN OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 7 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 40 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Automatic speaker setup Error messages If any error message is displayed during the measurement, resolve the problem and perform YPAO again. Error message Cause E-1: No Front SP Front speakers are not detected. E-2: No Sur. SP One of the surround speakers cannot be detected. E-3: No F.PRNS SP One of the presence speakers cannot be detected. E-4: SBR A surround back speaker is connected to the R side only. When using only one surround back speaker, you need to connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speaker. E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud. Keep the room quiet and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If you select “PROCEED”, YPAO takes the measurement again and ignores any noise detected. E-6: Check Sur. Surround back speakers are connected, but no surround speakers are connected Surround speakers need to be connected in order to use surround back speakers. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speakers. E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone cannot detect test tones. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. E-9: User Cancel The measurement has been canceled. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. To cancel the measurement, select “EXIT”. An internal error has occurred. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off and on the unit. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. SBL E-10: Internal Error Remedy Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then check the speaker connections. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 41 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Automatic speaker setup Warning messages If a warning message is displayed after the measurement, you can still save the measurement results by following on-screen instructions. However, we recommend you perform YPAO again in order to use the unit with the optimal speaker settings. Warning message Cause Remedy W-1: Out of Phase A speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity (+/-). Select “Wiring” in “Result” (p.39) and check the cable connections (+/-) of the speaker identified by “Reverse”. If the speaker is connected incorrectly, turn off the unit and then reconnect the speaker cable. Depending on the type of speakers or room environment, this message may appear even if the speakers are connected correctly. W-2: Over Distance A speaker is placed more than 24 m (80 ft) from the listening position. Select “Distance” in “Result” (p.39) and move the speaker identified by “>24.0m (>80.0ft)” within 24 m (80 ft) of the listening position. W-3: Level Error There are significant volume differences between the speakers. Check the usage environment and cable connections (+/-) of each speaker, and the volume of the subwoofer. We recommend using the same speakers or speakers with specifications that are as similar as possible. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 42 PLAYBACK RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 AV Input selection keys Basic playback procedure AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 1 Turn on the external devices (such as a TV or BD/DVD player) connected to the unit. 2 Use the input selection keys to select an input source. 3 Start playback on the external device or select a radio station. HDMI OUT HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN MUTE VOLUME ON SCREEN For details on the following operations, see the corresponding pages. Cursor keys ENTER RETURN DISPLAY • Listening to FM/AM radio (p.51) BAND MODE TUNING • Playing back iPod music (p.56) PRESET • Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.60) SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT • Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) (p.63) MEMORY 9 10 0 ENT • Listening to Internet radio (p.66) TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE 1 Press HDMI OUT to select an HDMI OUT jack. Each time you press the key, the HDMI OUT jack to be used for signal output changes. VOL. HDMIOUT1+2 SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR Refer to the instruction manual for the external device. OPTION ENTER Selecting an HDMI output jack • Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) (p.68) TV CH CODE SET 4 HDMI OUT 1+2 Outputs the same signal at both the HDMI OUT 1 and HDMI OUT 2 jacks. HDMI OUT 1 Output the signals at the selected HDMI OUT jack. HDMI OUT 2 HDMI OUT Off Does not output the signals at the HDMI OUT jacks. • You can also select an HDMI output jack by selecting a scene (p.44). • When “HDMI OUT 1+2” is selected, the unit outputs video signals at the highest resolution supported by both TVs (or projectors) connected to the unit. (For example, if you have connected a 1080p TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack and a 720p TV to the HDMI OUT 2 jack, the unit outputs 720p video signals.) Press VOLUME to adjust the volume. • To mute the audio output, press MUTE. Press MUTE again to unmute. • To adjust the treble/bass settings, use the “Option” menu or TONE CONTROL on the front panel (p.76). On-screen input selection a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select the desired input source and press ENTER. PLAYBACK ➤ Basic playback procedure En 43 SOURCE RECEIVER SOURCE Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX AV 1 2 3 5 6 1 4 TUNER USB NET Input selection keys AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 The SCENE function allows you to select the assigned input source, sound program, Compressed Music Enhancer on/off, and HDMI output jack with just one touch. 2 1 HDMI OUT TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN SCENE SCENE Input Sound program • Select a sound program (p.45) • Enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50) HDMI output jack BD/DVD HDMI 1 MOVIE (Sci-Fi) Off HDMI OUT 1+2 TV AV 4 STRAIGHT On HDMI OUT 1+2 NET NET RADIO MUSIC (7ch Stereo) On HDMI OUT 1+2 RADIO TUNER MUSIC (7ch Stereo) On HDMI OUT 1+2 • Selecting an HDMI output jack (p.43) 2 OPTION RETURN BAND TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 4 8 Hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front display. VOL. SETComplete DISPLAY MODE INFO Compressed Music Enhancer Perform the following operations to prepare the settings you want to assign to a scene. • Select an input source (p.43) By default, the following settings are registered for each scene. ENTER MOVIE 1 The input source and settings registered to the corresponding scene are selected. The unit turns on automatically when it is in standby mode. SCENE BD DVD Press SCENE. Configuring scene assignments 3 SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR If you want to control the corresponding playback device after selecting the scene, hold down the corresponding SCENE key and input selection key together for more than 3 seconds. MEMORY 10 ENT TV Once the setting is completed successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET • If you have not registered the remote control code of the playback device yet, see “Registering the remote control codes for playback devices” (p.106) to register it. • You can also configure scene assignments in the “Scene” menu (p.80). • The SCENE link playback function allows you to start playback of an external device connected to the unit via HDMI or of a Yamaha product connected to the REMOTE OUT jack. To enable SCENE link playback, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.81) in the “Scene” menu. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) En 44 Selecting the sound mode RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 4 The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs and surround decoders that allow you to enjoy playback sources with your favorite sound mode (such as sound field effect or stereo playback). AV 1 2 3 5 6 1 AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 Selecting a sound program suitable for movies (p.46) HDMI OUT Press MOVIE repeatedly. SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN On-screen sound program/surround decoder selection a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select a sound program/surround decoder and press ENTER. Selecting a sound program suitable for music or stereo playback (p.47) PROGRAM ON SCREEN Press MUSIC repeatedly. Selecting a surround decoder (p.49) Press SUR.DECODE repeatedly. OPTION • You can also switch the sound programs and surround decoder by pressing PROGRAM. • You can change the settings of the surround programs and surround decoders in the “Sound Program” menu (p.82). • The sound mode can be applied separately to each input source. Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN Switching to the straight decode mode (p.48) Press STRAIGHT. DISPLAY Switching to the Pure Direct mode (p.49) BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 7 4 8 MOVIE MUSIC SUR.DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Press PURE DIRECT. • When you play back audio signals with a sampling rate of higher than 96 kHz, the straight decode mode (p.48) is automatically selected. • You can check which speakers are currently outputting sound by looking at the speaker indicators on the unit’s front panel (p.9) or at the “Audio Signal” screen in the “Information” menu (p.100). Enable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50) Press ENHANCER. MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 45 Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP) The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs that utilize Yamaha’s original DSP technology (CINEMA DSP). It allows you to easily create sound fields like actual movie theaters or concert halls in your room. Drama This program features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres, from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The reverberations are modest, but suitably stereophonic. The sound effects and background music are reproduced with a gentle echo that does not impinge on the articulation of the dialogue. You’ll never get tired listening for long periods. Mono Movie This program reproduces monaural video sources, such as classic movies, in an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program creates a pleasant space with depth, by adding breadth and the appropriate reverberation to the original audio. Sound program category “CINEMA DSP” lights up ❑ ENTERTAINMENT VOL. Sci-Fi L SL SW C Sports This program allows listeners to enjoy the rich vividness of sport broadcasts and light entertainment programs. In sports broadcasts, the commentators’ voices are positioned clearly at the center, while the atmosphere inside the stadium is realistically conveyed by the peripheral delivery of the sounds of the fans in a suitable space. Action Game This program is suitable for action games, such as car racing and fighting games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player feel like they are right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater concentration. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a more dynamic and strong sound field. Roleplaying Game This program is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This program adds depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction of background music, special effects, and dialogue from a wide variety of scenes. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a clearer and more spatial sound field. Music Video This program allows you to enjoy videos of pop, rock, and jazz concerts, as if you were there yourself. Immerse yourself in the hot concert atmosphere thanks to the vividness of the singers and solos on stage, a presence sound field that emphasizes the beat of rhythm instruments, and a surround sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall. R SR Sound program ■ Sound programs suitable for movies (MOVIE) The following sound programs are optimized for viewing video sources, such as movies, TV programs, and games. ❑ MOVIE THEATER Standard This program creates a sound field that emphasizes the surround feeling without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multichannel audio, such as Dolby Digital and DTS. Its design is based on the concept of the ideal movie theater, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful reverberations from the left, right, and rear. Spectacle This program delivers the scale and grandeur of spectacular movie productions. It delivers an expansive sound space to match the cinemascope wide-screen, and boasts a broad dynamic range, providing everything from small delicate sounds to powerful loud booms. Sci-Fi This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the latest Sci-Fi and SFX movies. You can enjoy a variety of cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear separation between dialogue, sound effects, and background music. Adventure This program is ideal for reproducing the sound design of action and adventure movies precisely. The sound field restrains reverberations, but puts emphasis on reproducing a sensation of expansiveness on both sides, powerful space expanded widely to the left and right. The restrained depth creates a clear and powerful space, while also maintaining the articulation of the sounds and the separation of the channels. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 46 ■ Sound programs suitable for music/stereo playback (MUSIC) The following sound programs are optimized for listening to music sources. You can also select stereo playback. ❑ CLASSICAL Hall in Munich This program simulates a Munich concert hall with approximately 2,500 seats that uses stylish wood for the interior finishing. Fine, beautiful reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the arena. Hall in Vienna This program simulates a 1,700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a shoebox shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reverberations from all around the audience, producing a very full, rich sound. Chamber This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling, like an audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable for courtly music and chamber music. ❑ LIVE/CLUB Cellar Club This program simulates an intimate concert venue with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field delivers powerful sounds that make you feel as if you are sitting in the front row in front of a small stage. The Roxy Theatre This program creates the sound field of a 460-seat rock music concert venue in Los Angeles. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the hall. The Bottom Line This program creates the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound. ❑ STEREO 2ch Stereo Use this program to mix down multichannel sources to 2 channels. When multichannel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2 channels and output from the front speakers (this program does not utilize CINEMA DSP). 7ch Stereo Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back multichannel sources, the unit mixes down the source to 2 channels, and then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 47 RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET ■ Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields (CINEMA DSP 3D) Enjoying unprocessed playback CINEMA DSP 3D creates a natural stereoscopic sound field in your room. ■ Playing back in original channels (straight decode) You can play back input sources without any sound field effect processing. AV AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 CINEMA DSP 3D functions when both of the following conditions are met. HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME • One of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is selected (p.46). When the straight decode mode is enabled, the unit produces stereo sound from the front speakers for 2-channel sources such as CDs, and produces unprocessed multichannel sounds for multichannel sources. • “CINEMA DSP 3D Mode” (p.76) in the “Option” menu is set to “On”. 1 POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Each time you press the key, the straight decode mode is enabled or disabled. “CINEMA DSP n” lights up OPTION Press STRAIGHT. VOL. 3 ENTER Hall in Vienna RETURN PL L SL SW C VOL. PR R SR DISPLAY BAND STRAIGHT SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE STRAIGHT MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE • We recommend using presence speakers in order to experience the full effect of the stereoscopic sound fields. However, even when no presence speakers are connected, the unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce stereoscopic sound fields. TV CH CODE SET • To enable 6.1/7.1-channel playback from 5.1-channel sources when surround back speakers are used, set “Extended Surround” (p.77) in the “Option” menu to a setting other than “Off”. ■ Enjoying sound field effects without surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA DSP) If you select one of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) when no surround speakers are connected, the unit automatically creates the surround sound field using the front-side speakers. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 48 ■ Playing back 2-channel sources in multichannel (surround decoder) RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET The surround decoder enables unprocessed multichannel playback from 2-channel sources. When a multichannel source is input, it works the same way as the straight decode mode. AV AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 TV NET When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the unit plays back the selected source with the least circuitry in order to reduce the electrical noise from other circuitry (such as the front display). It allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality. For details on each decoder see “Glossary” (p.119). 1 HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) Press SUR.DECODE to select a surround decoder. Each time you press the key, the surround decoder changes. RADIO 1 Press PURE DIRECT. Each time you press the key, the Pure Direct mode is enabled or disabled. VOL. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOL. VOLUME ProLogic POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN bPro Logic bPLIIx Movie RETURN DISPLAY bPLII Movie BAND MODE TUNING bPLIIx Music PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT SUR.DECODE MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 PURE DIRECT 3 7 4 R SR PUREDIRECT SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR 10 bPLIIx Game • When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the following functions are not available. – Some settings for the speakers or sound programs Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for movies. – Operating the on-screen menu Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for music. – Audio output from the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks bPLII Game Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for games. Neo:6 Cinema Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder suitable for movies. Neo:6 Music Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder suitable for music. – Using the multi-zone function – Viewing information on the front display (when not in operation) ENT TV INPUT TV VOL bPLII Music Uses the Dolby Pro Logic decoder suitable for all sources. 8 MEMORY MUTE SW C OPTION ENTER MOVIE L SL TV CH CODE SET • You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoders when headphones are connected or when “Surround Back” in the “Setup” menu is set to “None”. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 49 Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET AV AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 Compressed Music Enhancer adds depth and breadth to the sound, allowing you to enjoy a dynamic sound close to the original sound before it was compressed. This function can be used along with any other sound modes. HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO 1 VOLUME Each time you press the key, Compressed Music Enhancer is enabled or disabled. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Press ENHANCER. “ENHANCER” lights up OPTION ENTER ENHANCER RETURN Enhancer On DISPLAY VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP ENHANCER PURE DIRECT ENHANCER 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 4 8 MEMORY 10 • Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on signals whose sampling rate is over 48 kHz. ENT TV • You can also use “Enhancer” (p.77) in the “Option” menu to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer. INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) You can enjoy surround or sound field effects, like a multichannel speaker system, with stereo headphones by connecting the headphones to the PHONES jack and selecting a sound program or a surround decoder. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 50 Listening to FM/AM radio RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 4 You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or selecting from registered radio stations. AV 1 2 3 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 HDMI OUT • The radio frequencies differ depending on the country or region where the unit is being used. The explanation of this section uses a display with frequencies used in U.K. and Europe models. RADIO • If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the FM/AM antennas. TUNER SCENE BD DVD TV NET Selecting a frequency for reception 1 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. 2 Press BAND to select a band (FM or AM). VOL. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU Setting the frequency steps VOLUME (Asia and General models only) POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN At the factory, the frequency step setting is set to 50 kHz for FM and 9 kHz for AM. Depending on your country or region, set the frequency steps to 100 kHz for FM and 10 kHz for AM. OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND BAND MODE TUNING PRESET TUNING SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC 1 2 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Set the unit to standby mode. When holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z. MAIN ZONE z 10 0 3 SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Use the following keys to set a frequency. TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the key for about a second to search stations automatically. Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to select 98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT). VOL. STEREO TUNED FM98.50MHz SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. Numeric keys MEMORY 9 FM87.50MHz ENT TV “STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received. INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET PROGRAM 3 STRAIGHT Press PROGRAM repeatedly to select “TU”. TUFM50/AM9 4 5 • “Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of reception range. • You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM radio reception in “FM Mode” (p.77) in the “Option” menu. When the signal reception for an FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may improve it. Press STRAIGHT to select “FM100/AM10”. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on again. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 51 Registering favorite radio stations (presets) RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 You can register up to 40 radio stations as presets. Once you have registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their preset numbers. AV ■ Selecting a preset station Tune into a registered radio station by selecting its preset number. 1 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. 2 Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired radio station. AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 TUNER HDMI OUT • You can automatically register FM radio stations that have strong signals by using “Auto Preset” (p.55). SCENE BD DVD TV NET You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the numeric keys after pressing PRESET once. ■ Registering a radio station RADIO Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN VOL. STEREO TUNED SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR 1 Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.51) to tune into the desired radio station. 2 Hold down MEMORY for more than 2 seconds. • “No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered. The first time that you do register a station, the selected radio station will be registered to the preset number “01”. Thereafter, each radio station you select will be registered to the next empty (unused) preset number after the most recently registered number. • “Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered. 01:FM98.50MHz OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY 9 PRESET 10 0 ENT • “Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered. • To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.55). VOL. STEREO TUNED Numeric keys MEMORY 01:FM98.50MHz SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE Preset number TV CH CODE SET • To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning into the desired radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and then press MEMORY again. VOL. STEREO TUNED 02:Empty SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR “Empty” (not in use) or the frequency currently registered PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 52 Radio Data System tuning RECEIVER SOURCE • “Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text”, and “Clock Time” are not displayed if the radio station does not provide the Radio Data System service. HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 (U.K. and Europe models only) Radio Data System is a data transmission system used by FM stations in many countries. The unit can receive various types of Radio Data System data, such as “Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time”, when it is tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting station. AV AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT ■ Displaying the Radio Data System information SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME 1 POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY OPTION Cursor keys ENTER RETURN BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO 3 4 7 8 Tune into the desired Radio Data System broadcasting station. • We recommend using “Auto Preset” to tune into the Radio Data System broadcasting stations (p.55). 2 Press INFO. ■ Receiving traffic information automatically When “TUNER” is selected as the input source, the unit automatically receives traffic information. To enable this function, follow the procedure below to set the traffic information station. 1 When “TUNER” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Traffic Program” (TrafficProgram) and press ENTER. The traffic information station search will start in 5 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the search immediately. Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes. INFO VOL. STEREO TUNED SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR ProgramType • To search upward/downward from the current frequency, press the cursor keys (q/w) while “READY” is displayed. • To cancel the search, press RETURN. • Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display. Item name MEMORY 9 10 0 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for the displayed item appears. 9850 VOL. STEREO TUNED CLASSICS SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR The following screen appears for about 3 seconds when the search finishes. FINISH VOL. STEREO TUNED TPFM101.30MHz SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR Traffic information station (frequency) Information Program Service Program service name Program Type Current program type Radio Text Information on the current program Clock Time Current time DSP Program Sound mode name Audio Decoder Decoder name Frequency Frequency • “TP Not Found” appears for about 3 seconds when no traffic information stations are found. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 53 Operating the radio on the TV RECEIVER SOURCE Menu HDMI 1 2 3 You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the TV. 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 Submenu Function FM (U.K. and Europe models only) Switches to FM/AM. AM AV 1 AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 TUNER NET PARTY ZONE 2 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. Manual Tuning The playback screen is displayed on the TV. HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE ■ Playback screen RADIO VOLUME 1 TOP MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND Selects a frequency. Auto (+/-) Selects a radio station automatically. Memory Registers the selected station as presets. Direct Enters a frequency directly. Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset station list). Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 3 2 POP-UP/MENU Tuning (+/-) 4 Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY 9 10 0 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 1 Radio station information Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected band (FM/AM) and frequency. (U.K. and Europe models only) When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.53), the Radio Data System information (“Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time”) is also displayed. 2 Band icon (Except for U.K. and Europe models) Select this icon and press ENTER to switch between FM and AM. 3 TUNED/STEREO indicators “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. “STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received. 4 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 54 ■ Browse screen RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET 1 AV AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 3 2 HDMI OUT 2 SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO 1 Preset station list PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys to select a preset station and press ENTER to tune into it. 2 Preset number POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND 3 Operation menu Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu MODE TUNING SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE Submenu Function Memory Registers the current station to the preset number selected in the list. Auto Preset Automatically registers FM radio stations with strong signals (up to 40 stations). Clear Preset Clear the preset station selected in the list. Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations. PRESET MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 3 7 4 8 Utility MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 1 Page Up 1 Page Down Moves to the previous/next page of the list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 55 Playing back iPod music You can play back iPod music on the unit using a USB cable supplied with the iPod. Connecting an iPod Connect your iPod to the unit with the USB cable supplied with the iPod. • Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or software version of the iPod. • To play back iPod videos on the unit, an Apple Composite AV Cable (not supplied) is required. Connect the USB and composite video plugs of the Apple Composite AV cable to the USB jack and VIDEO AUX (VIDEO) jack on the front panel. To select a video, operate the iPod itself in the simple play mode (p.58). 1 Connect the USB cable to the iPod. 2 Connect the USB cable to the USB jack. Supported iPods (as of January 2012) • iPod touch, iPod nano (2nd gen. to 6th gen.) • iPhone 4S, iPhone 4, iPhone 3GS, iPhone 3G, iPhone • iPad2, iPad The unit (front) BD/DVD PHONES SILENT CINEMA USB USB TONE CONTROL PROGRAM iPod/iPhone/iPad 5V 2.1A VOL. Connected SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR • The iPod charges while it is connected to the unit. If you set the unit to standby mode while the iPod is charging, the iPod continues to charge up to 4 hours. If “Network Standby” (p.95) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, it continues to change until full. • Disconnect the iPod from the USB jack when it is not in use. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iPod music En 56 Playback of iPod content RECEIVER SOURCE ■ Browse screen HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 1 2 3 Follow the procedure below to operate the iPod contents and start playback. AV You can control the iPod with the menu displayed on the TV screen. AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 USB NET PARTY ZONE 2 1 5 Press USB to select “USB” as the input source. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. HDMI OUT 4 SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO 1 Status indicators PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.59) and playback status (such as play/pause). 2 List name POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION 3 Contents list ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND Displays the list of iPod content. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 4 Item number/total MODE TUNING • If playback is ongoing on your iPod, the playback screen is displayed. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY 10 ENT 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. 5 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Function 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH 10 Pages Up CODE SET Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • To operate the iPod manually to select content or control playback, switch to the simple play mode (p.58). PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iPod music En 57 ■ Playback screen RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 ■ Operating the iPod itself or remote control (simple play) 1 2 AV 1 5 6 TUNER MAIN 1 USB 3 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 To display the TV menu screen, press MODE again. HDMI OUT 2 SCENE BD DVD Press MODE to switch to the simple play mode. The TV menu screen turns off and iPod operations are enabled. AUDIO TV NET RADIO 1 Status indicators PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.59) and playback status (such as play/pause). 2 Playback information POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining time. Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information. Operate your iPod itself or the remote control to start playback. Operational remote control keys Function Cursor keys Select an item. ENTER Confirms the selection. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. 3 Operation menu a Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC MODE ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 3 7 Menu 4 8 MEMORY 10 s Stops playback. Submenu Function a Resumes playback from pause. g s Stops playback. h d Stops playback temporarily. j INPUT TV VOL Starts playback or stops playback temporarily. f ENT TV MUTE External device operation keys d TV CH CODE SET Play Control Skips forward/backward. Searches forward/backward (by holding down). f g h j Skips forward/backward. Searches forward/backward (by holding down). Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • You can also use the external device operation keys on the remote control to control playback. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iPod music En 58 ■ Repeat/shuffle settings RECEIVER SOURCE You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings of your iPod. HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 AV • During simple play, configure the repeat/shuffle settings directly on your iPod or press MODE to display the TV menu screen and then follow the procedure below. AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT 1 When “USB” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME POP-UP/MENU • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY OPTION Cursor keys ENTER RETURN BAND MODE MODE TUNING • Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. Item PRESET Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. Songs (Songs) Plays back songs in random order. “x” appears in the TV screen. Albums (Albums) Plays back albums in random order. “x” appears in the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “c” appears in the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs repeatedly. “v” appears in the TV screen. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Shuffle (Shuffle) MEMORY 9 10 0 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET Repeat (Repeat) 4 To exit from the menu, press OPTION. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iPod music En 59 Playing back music stored on a USB storage device RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 You can play back music files stored on a USB storage device on the unit. Refer to the instruction manuals for the USB storage device for more information. AV 1 2 AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 USB • If the USB storage device contains many files, it may take time to load the them. In this case, “Loading...” appears in the front display. The unit supports USB mass storage class devices (FAT16 or FAT32 format). HDMI OUT • Disconnect the USB storage device from the USB jack when it is not in use. SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN • The unit is compatible with sampling rate of up to 96 kHz for WAV and FLAC files, and 48 kHz for other files. • Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or manufacturer of the USB storage device. OPTION Connecting a USB storage device ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING 1 Connect the USB storage device to the USB jack. Playback of USB storage device contents Follow the procedure below to operate the USB storage device contents and start playback. You can control the USB memory device with the menu displayed on the TV screen. 1 Press USB to select “USB” as the input source. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE • The unit supports WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC and FLAC files. The unit (front) MUSIC BD/DVD ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 PHONES USB TONE CONTROL PROGRAM MEMORY 9 10 0 ENT SILENT CINEMA TV iPod/iPhone/iPad 5V 2.1A INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET USB • If playback is ongoing on your USB storage device, the playback screen is displayed. USB storage device USB Connected VOL. SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 60 2 RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. ■ Browse screen 1 2 3 If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. AV AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 5 2 HDMI OUT 4 SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO 1 Status indicators PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME 2 List name POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING 3 Contents list Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected. Displays the list of USB storage device contents. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. 4 Item number/total 5 Operation menu PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.62) and playback status (such as play/pause). MUSIC Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 Menu Moves to the previous/next page of the list. MEMORY 10 ENT TV Function 1 Page Up 1 Page Down INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 61 ■ Playback screen RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 ■ Repeat/shuffle settings You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings for playback of USB storage device contents. 1 2 AV AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 3 2 1 When “USB” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO 1 Status indicators PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND OPTION Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT 3 Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Play Control Submenu Function a Resumes playback from pause. s Stops playback. d Stops playback temporarily. Shuffle (Shuffle) Repeat (Repeat) TV f INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET g Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. Item 3 Operation menu ENHANCER PURE DIRECT MEMORY • Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display. 2 Playback information POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.62) and playback status (such as play/pause). Skips forward/backward. Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 4 Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. On (On) Plays back songs in the current album (folder) in random order. “x” appears on the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “c” appears on the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs in the current album (folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the TV screen. To exit from the menu, press OPTION. • You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 62 Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 4 1 2 3 5 6 1 Playback of PC music contents You can play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS on the unit. AV Follow the procedure below to operate the PC music contents and start playback. AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 HDMI OUT • To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router (p.30). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu. RADIO • The unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC and FLAC files. NET NET PARTY ZONE 2 SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE • The unit is compatible with sampling rates of up to 96 kHz for WAV and FLAC files, and 48 kHz for other files. VOLUME You can control the PC/NAS with the menu displayed on the TV screen. 1 The browse screen is displayed on the TV. • To play back FLAC files, you need to install server software that supports sharing of FLAC files via DLNA on your PC or use a NAS that supports FLAC files. TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING Media sharing setup To play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS, first you need to configure the media sharing setting on each music server. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 7 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT TV ■ For a PC with Windows Media Player installed 1 INPUT TV VOL MUTE Press NET repeatedly to select “SERVER” as the input source. TV CH Check that Windows Media Player 11 or later is installed on your PC. CODE SET 2 In the media sharing settings, enable media sharing and allow media to be shared with the device. • If playback of a music file selected from the unit is ongoing on your PC, the playback screen is displayed. 2 Use the cursor keys to select a music server and press ENTER. ■ For a PC or a NAS with other DLNA server software installed Refer to the instruction manual for the device or software and configure the media sharing settings. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 63 3 RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. ■ Browse screen 1 2 3 If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. AV AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 5 2 HDMI OUT 4 SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO 1 Status indicators PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME OPTION 3 Contents list ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected. Displays the list of PC content. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. 4 Item number/total 5 Operation menu PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO 2 List name POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN MOVIE Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.65) and playback status (such as play/pause). Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 Menu Moves to the previous/next page of the list. MEMORY 10 ENT TV Function 1 Page Up 1 Page Down INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 64 ■ Playback screen RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 ■ Repeat/shuffle settings You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings for the playback of PC music content. 1 2 AV AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 3 2 1 When “SERVER” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO 1 Status indicators PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME 2 Playback information POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND OPTION Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu 10 ENT Play Control • Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display. 3 Submenu Function a Resumes playback from pause. s Stops playback. d Stops playback temporarily. Shuffle (Shuffle) Repeat (Repeat) TV f INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET g Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. Item 3 Operation menu ENHANCER PURE DIRECT MEMORY • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.65) and playback status (such as play/pause). Skips forward/backward. Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 4 Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. On (On) Plays back songs in the current album (folder) in random order. “x” appears on the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “c” appears on the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs in the current album (folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the TV screen. To exit from the menu, press OPTION. • You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. • You can also use a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. For details, see “DMC Control” (p.80). PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 65 Listening to Internet radio RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 You can listen to Internet radio stations from all over the world. You can control the Internet radio with the menu displayed on the TV screen. AV 1 2 AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 TV NET Press NET repeatedly to select “NET RADIO” as the input source. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. NET HDMI OUT • To use this function, the unit must be connected to the Internet (p.30). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu. SCENE BD DVD 1 RADIO • This service may be discontinued without notice. • You may not be able to receive some Internet radio stations. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME • The unit uses the vTuner Internet radio station database service. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 If an Internet radio station is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to Internet radio En 66 ■ Browse screen RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET ■ Playback screen 1 2 3 AV 1 2 AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT 4 SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO 1 Playback indicator 1 Playback indicator 2 List name 2 Playback information VOLUME ON SCREEN Displays the list of Internet radio content. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET Displays the station name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. 3 Contents list POP-UP/MENU 4 Item number/total 5 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 3 5 2 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Menu 7 4 8 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Submenu Function Play Control s Stops playback. Function Browse Moves to the browse screen. Moves to the previous/next page of the list. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 1 Page Up 3 3 Operation menu 1 Page Down MEMORY 10 ENT TV 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. • You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s) on the remote control to control playback. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. • Some information may not be available depending on the station. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • You can register your favorite Internet radio stations to the “Bookmarks” folder by accessing the following website with the web browser on your PC. To use this feature, you need the unit’s vTuner ID and your e-mail address in order to create your personal account. You can find the vTunerID (MAC address of the unit) in “Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu. http://yradio.vtuner.com/ PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to Internet radio En 67 Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) The AirPlay function allows you to play back iTunes/iPod music on the unit via network. Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents Follow the procedure below to play back iTunes/iPod music contents on the unit. iTunes PC 1 Router The unit Starts playback on iTunes or iPod Turn on the unit, and start iTunes on the PC or display the playback screen on the iPod. If the iTunes/iPod recognizes the unit, the AirPlay icon ( ) appears. iTunes (example) iPod (example) Playback starts iPod • To use this function, the unit and your PC or iPod must be connected to the same router (p.30). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.101) in the “Information” menu. Supported iTunes/iPods (as of January 2012) • If the icon does not appear, check whether the unit and PC/iPod are connected to the router properly. 2 • iTunes 10.2.2 or later (Windows/Mac) On the iTunes/iPod, click (tap) the AirPlay icon and select the unit (network name of the unit) as the audio output device. • iPod touch, iPhone or iPad with iOS 4.3.3 or later iTunes (example) iPod (example) Network name of the unit 3 Select a song and start playback. The unit automatically selects “AirPlay” as the input source and starts playback. The playback screen is displayed on the TV. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) En 68 Menu RECEIVER SOURCE • The playback screen is available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI. HDMI 1 2 5 3 6 4 7 V-AUX 4 Play Control AV 1 2 3 5 6 1 • You can turn on the unit automatically when starting playback on iTunes or iPod by setting “Network Standby” (p.95) in the “Setup” menu to “On”. AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 • You can edit the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on iTunes/iPod in “Network Name” (p.96) in the “Setup” menu. NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT TV NET RADIO Function a Resumes playback from pause. d Stops playback temporarily. f g Screen Off • If you select the other input source on the unit during playback, playback on the iTunes/iPod stops automatically. SCENE BD DVD Submenu Skips forward/backward. Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • To adjust the unit’s volume from the iTunes/iPod, set “Volume Interlock” (p.80) in the “Input” menu to “Limited” (default) or “Full”. PROGRAM MUTE VOLUME • You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. Caution TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 • When you use iTunes/iPod controls to adjust volume, the volume may be unexpectedly loud. This could result in damage to the unit or speakers. If the volume suddenly increases during playback, stop playback on the iTunes/iPod immediately. ■ Playback screen iTunes (example of English version) 1 2 4 3 8 MEMORY 10 • To control iTunes playback with the remote control of the unit, you need to configure the iTunes preferences to enable iTunes control from remote speakers in advance. ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 1 Playback indicator Check this box 2 Playback information Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining time. 3 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) En 69 Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) The multi-zone function allows you to play back different input sources in the room where the unit is installed (main zone) and in another room (Zone2). For example, while you are watching TV in the living room (main zone), another person can listen to radio in the study room (Zone2). ■ Using the unit’s internal amplifier Connect the speakers placed in Zone2 to the unit with speaker cables. To utilize the EXTRA SP terminals for Zone2 speakers, set “Power Amp Assign” (p.88) in the “Setup” menu to “7ch +1ZONE” after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. The unit (rear) SPEAKERS FRONT CENTER ZONE 2/PRESENCE SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND SINGLE EXTRA SP SINGLE CENTER AC IN AUDIO OUT FRONT ZONE 2 OUT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 Study room (Zone2) 1 2 FL FR Living room (main zone) 9 • Analog audio sources (including FM/AM radio), and USB and network sources can be output to Zone2. To listen to the playback of an external device in Zone2, you need to connect the device to the AUDIO jacks (AV 5–6 or AUDIO 1–2 jacks) of the unit. The party mode (p.73) allows you to play back the same audio output in main zone as Zone2, whatever the input audio signal type. 3 4 5 6 7 Zone2 Preparing Zone2 Main zone Connect the device that will be used in Zone2 to the unit. The connection method varies depending on the amplifier being used (the unit or an external amplifier). • When Zone2 output is enabled (p.72), the surround back speakers in the main zone do not output sound. Caution • Remove the unit’s power cable from the AC wall outlet before connecting speakers or an external amplifier. • Ensure that the core wires of the speaker cable do not touch one another or come into contact with the unit’s metal parts. Doing so may damage the unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will appear on the front display when the unit is turned on. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 70 ■ Using an external amplifier Connect the external amplifier (with volume control) placed in Zone2 to the unit with a stereo pin cable. The unit (rear) HDMI 1 HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI 3 HDMI 4 You can operate the unit and external devices from Zone2 using the supplied remote control if you connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to the unit’s REMOTE IN/OUT jacks. HDMI 5 FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO • To operate external devices with the supplied remote control, you must register a remote control code for each device before using (p.105). CENT REMOTE FM ■ Operating the unit from Zone2 (remote connection) IN PR ZONE2 OUT jacks OUT PB Y REMOTE IN/OUT jacks The unit (rear) VIDEO 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT MONITOR OUT REMOTE L IN HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 R AUDIO 1 AUDIO OUT AUDIO 2 ZONE 2 OUT 2 ANTENNA COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) AM REMOTE FM IN PR OUT PB O Y L Q HDMI 3 OUT ARC External amplifier Audio input (analog stereo) ZONE2 OUT HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) VIDEO MONITOR OUT 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT W R 1 9 2 AUDIO XIAL OPTICAL 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 3 4 5 6 Infrared signal transmitter 7 Infrared signal receiver Zone2 External device (such as a CD player) Remote control Main zone Zone2 Main zone PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 71 Controlling Zone2 Remote connections between Yamaha products RECEIVER SOURCE RECEIVER z HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 4 AV 1 2 3 5 6 1 AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 AV 5–6 AUDIO 1–2 TUNER USB NET An infrared signal transmitter is not required if you are using Yamaha products that support remote connections, as the unit does. You can transmit remote control signals by connecting the REMOTE IN/OUT jacks with monaural mini-jack cables and an infrared signal receiver. REMOTE IN/OUT jacks 1 2 MAIN/ZONE2 REMOTE IN IN OUT OUT When Zone2 output is enabled, “ZONE2” lights up in the front display. SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME Yamaha products (up to six, including the unit) POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN 3 Infrared signal receiver Press RECEIVER z. Each time you press the key, Zone2 output is enabled or disabled. REMOTE IN/OUT jacks HDMI OUT REMOTE Set MAIN/ZONE2 to “ZONE2”. Use the following keys to select an input source. V-AUX: VIDEO AUX (AUDIO) jacks (on the front panel) AV 5–6: AV 5–6 (AUDIO) jacks OPTION AUDIO 1–2: AUDIO 1–2 jacks ENTER Remote control RETURN BAND Zone2 MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 7 TUNER: FM/AM radio USB: USB jack (on the front panel) DISPLAY NET: NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a desired network source) PHONO: PHONO jacks (except for U.S.A. and Canada models) 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET • You cannot select USB and network sources exclusively for each zone. For example, if you select “SERVER” for Zone2 when “USB” is selected for the main zone, the input source for the main zone also switches to “SERVER”. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 72 4 RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 4 ■ Enjoying the same source in multiple rooms (party mode) Start playback on the external device or select a radio station. The party mode allows you to play back in Zone2 the same music that is being played back in the main zone. During the party mode, stereo playback is automatically selected for all zones. Utilize this function when you want to use main zone music as background music for a house party. Refer to the instruction manual for the external device. AV 1 2 3 5 6 1 For details on the following operations, see the corresponding pages. AUDIO TUNER MAIN USB 2 • Listening to FM/AM radio (p.51) NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT PARTY • Playing back iPod music (p.56) 1 SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO VOLUME MUTE VOLUME OPTION • Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) (p.63) When the party mode is turned on, “PARTY” lights up in the front display. • If the party mode does not work on Zone2, set “Party Mode Set” (p.97) in the “Setup” menu to “Enable” (default). DISPLAY BAND • The on-screen operations are not available for Zone2. Use the front display to control Zone2. MODE TUNING PRESET • AirPlay is available in Zone2 only when Airplay playback is ongoing in the main zone. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE Each time you press the key, the party mode is turned on or off. • Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) (p.68) ENTER RETURN Press PARTY. • Listening to Internet radio (p.66) POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN • Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.60) MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 SLEEP 3 7 4 8 MEMORY 10 ENT TV • To set the sleep timer (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off), press SLEEP repeatedly. The Zone2 output will be disabled after a specified period of time. INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET • To adjust the Zone2 volume, press VOLUME or MUTE (when using the unit’s internal amplifier). When using an external amplifier, use the volume control on it. Caution • To avoid unexpected noise, never play back DTS-CDs in Zone2. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 73 Viewing the current status RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 Switching information on the front display AV Input source group Item NET RADIO Song (song title), Album (album name), Station (station name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) PHONO (Except for U.S.A. and Canada models) Input (input source name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 1 HDMI OUT Press INFO. Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes. SCENE BD DVD TV NET RADIO VOL. AudioDecoder PROGRAM MUTE L SL SW C R SR VOLUME Viewing the status information on the TV Item name TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for the displayed item appears. OPTION ENTER 1 RETURN DISPLAY ProLogic DISPLAY Press DISPLAY. The following information is displayed on the TV. VOL. L SL SW C R SR Compressed Music Enhancer status BAND MODE TUNING Information PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO 3 7 4 Volume Audio format/ Decoder Sound mode • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. The displayed item can also be applied separately to each input source group. 8 MEMORY 10 Input source/ Party mode status ENT Input source group Item HDMI 1–5 V-AUX AV 1–6 AUDIO 1–2 Input (input source name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET CINEMA DSP status Frequency (frequency), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) TUNER USB SERVER AirPlay * (U.K. and Europe models only) Radio Data System data is also available when the unit is tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.53). 2 To close the information display, press DISPLAY. Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) * During simple playback of iPod: Input (input source name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) PLAYBACK ➤ Viewing the current status En 74 Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) You can configure separate playback settings for different playback sources. This menu is available on the front panel (or on the TV screen), allowing you to easily configure settings during playback. 1 Press OPTION. Option menu items • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. • Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display. OPTION ToneControl VOL. SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR Front display Item Function Page Tone Control (Tone Control) Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range of sounds. 76 Adaptive DRC (Adaptive DRC) Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted when the volume is adjusted. 76 CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (CINEMA DSP 3D) Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D. 76 Dialogue Level Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. Dialogue Adjust (Dialog Lvl) (Dialog Adjust) Dialogue Lift Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. (Dialog Lift) TV screen 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 3 4 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. To exit from the menu, press OPTION. Extended Surround (EXTD Surround) Volume Trim (Volume Trim) Input Trim (In.Trim) 76 76 Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources when surround back speakers are used. 77 Corrects volume differences between input sources. 77 Subwoofer Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. Trim (SW.Trim) 77 Enhancer (Enhancer) Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer. 77 Video Mode (Video Mode) Enables/disables the video signal processing settings configured in the “Setup” menu. 77 FM Mode (FM Mode) Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception. 77 Traffic Program (TrafficProgram) (U.K. and Europe models only) Automatically searches for a traffic information station. 53 Repeat (Repeat) Configures the repeat setting for the iPod (p.59), USB storage device (p.62), or media server (p.65). — Shuffle (Shuffle) Configures the shuffle setting for the iPod (p.59), USB storage device (p.62), or media server (p.65). — PLAYBACK ➤ Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 75 ■ Tone Control (Tone Control) ■ CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (CINEMA DSP 3D) Adjusts the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) of sounds. Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D (p.48). If this function is set to “On”, CINEMA DSP 3D functions with the selected sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo). Choices Treble (Treble), Bass (Bass) Settings Setting range -6.0 dB to Bypass (Bypass) to +6.0 dB, *0.5 dB increments Default Bypass (Bypass) On (On) (default) Enables CINEMA DSP 3D. Off (Off) Disables CINEMA DSP 3D. ■ Dialogue Adjust (Dialog Adjust) Adjusts the volume or perceive height of dialogue sounds. • If you set an extreme value, sounds may not match those from other channels. ❑ Dialogue Level (Dialog Lvl) Adjusting with the front panel controls Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. If dialogue sounds cannot be heard clearly, you can turn up its volume by increasing this setting. a Press TONE CONTROL to select “Treble” or “Bass”. Setting range 0 to 3 b Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment. Default 0 ■ Adaptive DRC (Adaptive DRC) Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted when the volume level is adjusted. When it is set to “On”, it is useful for listening to playback at a low volume at night. Settings On (On) Automatically adjusts the dynamic range. Off (Off) (default) The dynamic range is not automatically adjusted. Off Input level Output level Output level On Volume: high Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. If the dialogue sounds as if it is coming from below the TV screen, you can raise its perceived height by increasing this setting. • This setting is available only when one of the following conditions is met. If “On” is selected, the dynamic range becomes narrow at a low volume and wide at a high volume. Volume: low ❑ Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift) – One of the sound programs (except for 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is selected when presence speakers are used. – Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) (p.48) is working. Setting range 0 to 5 (The bigger the value the higher the position) Default 0 On Off Input level Ideal position PLAYBACK ➤ Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 76 ■ Extended Surround (EXTD Surround) ❑ Subwoofer Trim (SW.Trim) Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources when surround back speakers are used. Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. Settings Auto (Auto) (default) Automatically selects the most suitable decoder if signals that contain surround back channel signals are input, and reproduces the signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel. If two surround back speakers are connected, the unit reproduces the 5.1-channel signals in 7.1-channel. bPLIIx Movie (bPLIIxMo) Always reproduces signals in 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie decoder. This setting is available only when two surround back speakers are connected. bPLIIx Music (bPLIIxMu) Always reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music decoder. This setting is available only when one or two surround back speakers are connected. EX/ES (EX/ES) Automatically selects the Dolby EX or DTS-ES decoder, and reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel. Off (Off) Always reproduces signals in their original channels. (Even when DTS-ES or Dolby Digital EX signal is input, the unit reproduces the signal in 5.1-channel.) • Some Dolby Digital EX or DTS-ES sources do not contain a flag for reproducing surround back channel. In this case, the unit reproduces the signals in 5.1-channel if “Extended Surround” is set to “Auto”. To reproduce the signals in 6.1 or 7.1-channel, set it to “bPLIIx Movie”, “bPLIIx Music”, or “EX/ES”. Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50). • This setting is applied separately to each input source. • You can also use ENHANCER on the remote control to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.50). Settings Off (Off) Disables Compressed Music Enhancer. On (On) Enables Compressed Music Enhancer. Default TUNER, USB, (network sources): On (On) Others: Off (Off) Settings ❑ Input Trim (In.Trim) Corrects volume differences between input sources. If you are bothered by volume differences when switching between input sources, use this function to correct it. Default 0.0 dB ■ Enhancer (Enhancer) Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio) settings configured in “Processing” (p.92) in the “Setup” menu. Fine-adjusts volume difference between input sources or subwoofer volume. Setting range -6.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) Default 0.0 dB ■ Video Mode (Video Mode) ■ Volume Trim (Volume Trim) • This setting is applied separately to each input source. Setting range -6.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) Processing (Processing) Enables the video signal processing. Direct (Direct) (default) Disables the video signal processing. ■ FM Mode (FM Mode) Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception. Settings Stereo (Stereo) (default) Receives FM radio in stereo sounds. Mono (Mono) Receives FM radio in monaural sounds. PLAYBACK ➤ Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 77 CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. You can change the input source settings using the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 3 5 6 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an input source to be configured and press the cursor key (q). Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Input menu items • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. The input source of the unit also changes. • You can still switch the input source by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3. Item Function Rename/Icon Select Changes the input source name and icon. 79 Audio In Combines the video jack of the selected input source with an audio jack of others. 79 Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. 79 Volume Interlock Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay. 80 Video Out Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. 80 DMC Control Selects whether to allow a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. 80 CONFIGURATIONS Page ➤ Configuring input sources (Input menu) En 78 ■ Rename/Icon Select ■ Audio In Changes the input source name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen. Combines the video jack of the selected input source with an audio jack of others. For example, use this function in the following cases. Input sources HDMI 1–7, V-AUX, AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2, USB, PHONO* * Except for U.S.A. and Canada models ■ Setup procedure 1 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a template and press the cursor key (w). • Connecting a playback device that supports HDMI video output, but not HDMI audio output • Connecting a playback device that has component video jacks and analog stereo jacks (such as game consoles) Input sources HDMI 1–7, AV 1–2 ■ Setup procedure (To input audio through a digital optical jack) Select “AV1” or “AV4” and connect the device to the unit’s corresponding audio jacks with a digital optical cable. (To input audio through a digital coaxial jack) Select “AV2” or “AV3” and connect the device to the unit’s corresponding audio jacks with a digital coaxial cable. • You cannot change the template or icon for “USB” when an iPod is connected. 2 3 4 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w). Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. (To input audio through analog audio jacks) Select “AV5”, “AV6”, “AUDIO1”, or “AUDIO2”, and connect the device to the unit’s corresponding audio jacks with a stereo pin cable. ■ Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to “DTS”. For example, if the unit does not detect DTS audio and outputs noise, set “Decoder Mode” to “DTS”. Input sources HDMI 1–7, V-AUX, AV 1–4 Settings Auto (default) Automatically selects an audio format to match the input audio signal. DTS Selects DTS only. (Other audio signals are not reproduced.) • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 5 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring input sources (Input menu) En 79 ■ Volume Interlock Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay. Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) You can change the settings of the SCENE function (p.44) using the TV screen. Input sources AirPlay Settings Off Disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod. Limited (default) Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod within the limited range (-80 dB to 0 dB and mute). Full Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod in the full range (-80 dB to +16.5 dB and mute). 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a scene to be configured and press the cursor key (q). Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER. ■ Video Out Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. Input sources TUNER, (network sources), USB Settings Off Does not output video. HDMI 1–7, AV 1–6, V-AUX Outputs video input through the corresponding video input jacks. Default USB: V-AUX Others: Off ■ DMC Control Selects whether to allow DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. Input source SERVER • You can still switch the scene by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3. Settings Disable Does not allow DMCs to control playback. Enable (default) Allows DMCs to control playback. • A Digital Media Controller (DMC) is a device that can control other network devices through the network. When this function is enabled, you can control playback of the unit from DMCs (such as Windows Media Player 12) on the same network. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) En 80 4 ■ Load Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. Select “DETAIL” to configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the scene assignments. ❑ Device Control Recalls a selected scene and starts its playback on an external device connected to the unit via HDMI or on a Yamaha product connected to the REMOTE OUT jack. (SCENE link playback) Settings 5 6 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to change the setting. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Scene menu items Item Function Save Registers the current settings in the selected scene. Load Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. You can also configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the scene assignments. 81 Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon. 82 Reset Restores the default settings for the selected scene. 82 Off Disables the SCENE link playback function. HDMI Control Enables SCENE link playback using HDMI Control signals. Select this if an HDMI Control-compatible device (such as a BD/DVD player) is connected to the unit via HDMI. It also turns on the TV if it supports HDMI Control. IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1 Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack. Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 2 if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack and “IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1” does not work properly. Page 81 IR: Yamaha CD Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this if a Yamaha CD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack. Default SCENE1 (BD/DVD), SCENE2 (TV): HDMI Control SCENE3 (NET), SCENE4 (RADIO): Off ■ Save • To control playback of an HDMI Control-compatible device by SCENE link playback, you need to set “HDMI Control” in the “Setup” menu to “On” and perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.123). Registers the unit’s current settings (input source, sound program/surround decoder, Compressed Music Enhancer on/off, and HDMI output jack) in the selected scene. ❑ Detail Displays the assignments of the selected scene. • If you have changed the input assignment for a scene, you also need to change the external device assigned to the corresponding SCENE key (p.44). Input Input source to be used HDMI Output HDMI OUT jack to be used Mode Sound program/surround decoder to be used Enhancer Compressed Music Enhancer on/off CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) En 81 ■ Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen. ■ Setup procedure 1 2 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w). Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) You can change the settings of the sound programs and surround decoders using the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a sound program to be configured and press the cursor key (q). Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press ENTER. Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 4 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 5 • You can still switch the sound program by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Reset Restores the default settings (p.44) for the selected scene. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 82 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. Sound Program menu items • Available items vary depending on the selected sound program or surround decoder. ■ Settings for sound programs • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. Item Function Decode Type Selects a surround decoder to be used bPLIIx Movie (bPLII in combination with the selected sound Movie), Neo:6 Cinema program. DSP Level Adjusts the sound field effect level. -6 dB to +3 dB (default: 0 dB) Higher to enhance the sound field effect, and lower to reduce it. Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and presence sound field generation. 1 ms to 99 ms Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. Surround Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and surround sound field generation. • To restore the default settings for the selected sound program, select “Reset”. 5 6 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Surround Back Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and surround back sound field generation. Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the presence sound field. Surround Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the surround sound field. Surround Back Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the surround back sound field. Liveness Adjusts the loss of the presence sound field. Surround Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround sound field. Surround Back Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround back sound field. Reverb Time Adjust the decay time of the rear reverberant sound. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Settings 1 ms to 49 ms Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. 0.1 to 2.0 Higher to enhance the broadening effect, and lower to reduce it. 0 to 10 Higher to enhance the reflectivity, and lower to reduce it. 1.0 s to 5.0 s Higher to enrich the reverberant sound and lower to have clear sound. Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 83 ■ Settings for decoders Item Function Settings Reverb Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and reverberant sound generation. 0 ms to 250 ms Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. Adjusts the volume of the reverberant sound. 0% to 100% Higher to strengthen the reverberant sound, and lower to weaken it. Reverb Level The following items are available when you set “Decode Type” of “Surround Decoder” to “bPLIIx Music” or “Neo:6 Music”. Decode Type Item Function Settings Panorama Adjusts the broadening effect of the front sound field. Off (default), On Select “On” to wrap front right/left channel sounds around the field and generate a spacious sound field in combination with the surround sound field. Center Width Adjusts the broadening effect of the center sound field. 0 to 7 (default: 3) Higher to enhance the broadening effect, and lower to reduce it (closer to center). Dimension Adjusts the difference in level between the front and surround sound fields. -3 to +3 (default: 0) Higher to strengthen the front sound field and lower to strengthen the surround sound field. Center Image Adjusts the center orientation level (broadening effect) of the front sound field. 0.0 to 1.0 (default: 0.3) Higher to strengthen the center orientation level (less broadening effect) and lower to weaken (more broadening effect). The following items are available when you select “2ch Stereo” or “7ch Stereo”. Sound program Item Function Settings Direct Selects whether to automatically bypass the DSP and tone control circuits when an analog audio source is played back. Auto (default), Off Select “Auto” to bypass the circuits (when both “Treble” and “Bass” are set to “Bypass”). bPLIIx Music 2ch Stereo Level Adjusts the entire volume. -5 to +5 (default: 0) Front / Rear Balance Adjusts the front and rear volume balance. -5 to +5 (default: 0) Higher to enhance the front side, and lower to enhance the rear side. Left / Right Balance Adjusts the right and left volume balance. -5 to +5 (default: 0) Higher to enhance the right side, and lower to enhance the left side. Height Balance Adjust the height volume balance using the presence speakers. 0 to 10 (default: 5) Higher to enhance the upside, and lower to enhance the downside. (The presence speakers do not produce sounds when “Height Balance” is set to “0”.) Monaural Mix Enables/disables monaural sound output. Off (default), On Neo:6 Music 7ch Stereo • Available items in “7ch Stereo” vary depending on the speaker system being used. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 84 Configuring various functions (Setup menu) You can configure the unit’s various function with the menu displayed on the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a menu. 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 5 6 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 85 Setup menu items Menu Item Function Auto Setup Power Amp Assign Page Automatically optimizes the speaker settings (YPAO). 35 Selects a speaker system. 88 Front Selects the size of the front speakers. 88 Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. 88 Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their size. 88 Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their size. 89 Front Presence Selects whether or not presence speakers are connected. 89 Subwoofer Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. 89 Extra Bass Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components. 89 Bass Cross Over Sets the lower limit of the low-frequency component that can be output from speakers whose size is set to “Small”. 89 Configuration Speaker Manual Setup Lipsync Sound Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position. 90 Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. 90 Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. 90 Test Tone Enables/disables the test tone output. 90 Delay Enable Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. 91 Auto/Manual Select Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. 91 Adjustment Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually. 91 Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. 91 Max Volume Sets the maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness. 91 Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. 92 Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level when the volume is adjusted. 92 Video Video Mode Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). 92 HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control. You can also configure the relevant settings (such as ARC and TV audio input). 93 HDMI Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. 94 Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in standby mode. 94 CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 86 Menu Item Function Page IP Address Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). 95 Network Standby Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from other network devices. 95 MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. 95 Network Name Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. 96 Network Main Zone Set Multi Zone Zone2 Set Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 96 Max Volume Sets the Zone2 maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness in the second zone. 97 Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. 97 Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 97 Enables/disables switching to the party mode. 97 Dimmer (Front Display) Adjusts the brightness of the front display. 97 Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated. 97 Wall Paper Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. 98 Trigger Mode Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. 98 Target Zone Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. 98 Memory Guard Prevents accidental changes to the settings. 99 Auto Power Down Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. 99 Eco Mode Enables/disables the eco mode (power saving mode). 99 Select an on-screen menu language. 100 Party Mode Set Display Set Function Trigger Output ECO Language CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 87 Speaker (Manual Setup) ❑ Front Selects the size of the front speakers. Configures the speaker settings manually. Settings Large Select this option for large speakers. The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency components. Small (default) Select this option for small speakers. The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). • “Front” is automatically set to “Large” when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”. ■ Power Amp Assign ❑ Center Selects a speaker system. Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. In addition to the 5.1- or 7.1-channel speaker system, various speaker configurations are possible using the presence speakers, Zone2 speakers, or bi-amp connection. Settings Settings Large Select this option for large speakers. The center speaker will produce all of the center channel frequency components. Basic (default) Select this option when you use a normal speaker system (not using Zone2 speakers or a bi-amp connection). 7ch +1ZONE Select this option when you use Zone2 speakers (p.70) in addition to the speaker system in the main zone. Small (default) Select this option for small speakers. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce center channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). 5ch BI-AMP Select this option when you connect front speakers that support bi-amp connections (p.19). None Select this option when no center speaker is connected. The front speakers will produce center channel audio. ■ Configuration Configures the output characteristics of the speakers. ❑ Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their sizes. Settings • When you configure the speaker size, select “Large” if the woofer diameter of your speaker is 16 cm (6-1/4”) or larger or “Small” if it is smaller than 16 cm (6-1/4”). Large Select this option for large speakers. The surround speakers will produce all of the surround channel frequency components. Small (default) Select this option for small speakers. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). None Select this option when no surround speakers are connected. The front speakers will produce surround channel audio. Virtual CINEMA DSP works when you select a sound program. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 88 ❑ Surround Back ❑ Subwoofer Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their sizes. Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. Settings Settings Large x1 Select this option when one large speaker is connected. The surround back speaker will produce all of the surround back channel frequency components. Large x2 Select this option when two large speakers are connected. The surround back speakers will produce all of the surround back channel frequency components. Small x1 Select this option when one small speaker is connected. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). Small x2 (default) Select this option when two small speakers are connected. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). None Select this option when no surround back speakers are connected. The surround speakers and subwoofer (or front speakers) will produce surround back channel audio. Normal (default) Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase not reversed). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. Reverse Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase reversed). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. Use None Select this option when no subwoofer is connected. The front speakers will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. • When the bass sound is lacking or unclear, switch the subwoofer phase. ❑ Extra Bass Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components. Settings • This setting is not available when “Power Amp Assign” is set to “5ch BI-AMP”, or when “Surround” is set to “None”. Off (default) Depending on the size of the front speakers, either the subwoofer or front speakers produce the front channel low-frequency components. ❑ Front Presence On Both the front speakers and subwoofer produce the front channel low-frequency components. Selects whether or not presence speakers are connected. Settings Use (default) Select this option when presence speakers are connected. None Select this option when no presence speakers are connected. • This setting is not available when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”, or when “Front” is set to “Small”. ❑ Bass Cross Over Sets the lower limit of the low-frequency components that can be output from a speaker whose size is set to “Small”. A frequency sound lower than the specified value will be produced from the subwoofer or front speakers Settings 40 Hz, 60 Hz, 80 Hz (default), 90 Hz, 100 Hz, 110 Hz, 120 Hz, 160 Hz, 200 Hz • If the volume and crossover frequency are adjustable on your subwoofer, set the volume to half and crossover frequency to maximum. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 89 ■ Distance ■ Manual equalizer adjustment Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position so that sounds from the speakers reach the listening position at the same time. First, select the unit of distance from “Meter” or “Feet”. Choices Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer 1 2 3 Press ENTER again to enter the edit screen. Use the cursor keys to select a speaker and press ENTER. • To restore the default settings for all speakers, select “PEQ Data Clear” and then “OK”. Setting range 0.30 m to 24.00 m (1.0 ft to 80.0 ft), *0.05 m (0.2 ft) increments Default 3.00 m (10.0 ft) Set “Parametric EQ” to “Manual” and press ENTER. • To copy the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” (p.35) to the “Manual” fields for fine adjustment, select “PEQ Data Copy” and then an equalizer type. 4 ■ Level Press ENTER to select an item. Band: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a center frequency from the preset 7 bands and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. Frequency: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the center frequency of the selected band and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. Adjusts the volume of each speaker. Q: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the Q factor (bandwidth) of the selected band and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. Choices Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer Setting range -10.0 dB to +10.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) Default 0.0 dB ■ Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. Settings Manual Setting range Gain: -20.0 dB to +6.0 dB Center frequency: 31.3 HZ to 16.0 kHz Q factor: 0.500 to 10.08 Select this option when you want to adjust the equalizer manually. For details, see “Manual equalizer adjustment”. YPAO:Flat Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics. YPAO:Front Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics as the front speakers. YPAO:Natural Adjusts all speakers to achieve a natural sound. Through Does not use the equalizer. 5 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Test Tone Enables/disables the test tone output. Test tone output helps you to adjust the speaker balance or equalizer while confirming its effect. Settings • “YPAO:Flat”, “YPAO:Front”, and “YPAO:Natural” are available only when the measurement results of “Auto Setup” have already been saved (p.35). Press ENTER again to view the measurement results. Off (default) Does not output test tones. On Outputs test tones automatically when you adjust the speaker balance or equalizer. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 90 Sound ❑ Adjustment Configures the audio output settings. Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually when “Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Manual”. You can fine-adjust the audio output timing when “Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”. Setting range 0 ms to 500 ms (1 ms increments) Default 0 ms • “Offset” shows the difference between automatic adjustment and fine adjustment. ■ Dynamic Range ■ Lipsync Adjusts the delay between video and audio output. Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. Settings ❑ Delay Enable Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. Choices HDMI 1–7, AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2 Settings Disable Disable the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source. Enable (default) Enables the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source. ❑ Auto/Manual Select Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. Setting range Auto (default) Adjusts the delay between video and audio output automatically when a TV that supports an automatic lipsync function is connected to the unit via HDMI. If necessary, you can fine-adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”. Manual Select this option when you want to adjust the delay between video and audio output manually. Adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”. Maximum (default) Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range. Standard Optimizes the dynamic range for regular home use. Minimum/Auto Sets the dynamic range for clear sound even at night or at low volumes. When playing back Dolby TrueHD signals, the dynamic range is automatically adjusted based on the input signal information. ■ Max Volume Sets the maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness. Setting range -30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB Default +16.5 dB • “Auto/Manual Select” is automatically set to “Manual” depending on the TV connected to the unit. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 91 ■ Initial Volume Video Sets the initial volume when the receiver is turned on. Configures the video output settings. Settings Off (default) Sets the level to the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby mode. On Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB increments). (This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max Volume”.) ■ Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level when the volume is adjusted. Settings ■ Video Mode Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). Off Does not adjust the effect level automatically. On (default) Adjusts the effect level automatically. Settings Direct (default) Disables the video signal processing. Processing Enables the video signal processing. Select a resolution and an aspect ratio in “Resolution” and “Aspect”. • When “Video Mode” is set to “Direct”, the unit transmits video signals with the least circuitry in order to reduce video output delay. ❑ Resolution Selects a resolution to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to “Processing”. Settings Through Does not convert the resolution. Auto (default) Selects a resolution automatically in accordance with TV resolution. 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p, 4K Output video signals with a selected resolution. (Only the resolutions supported by your TV are selectable.) • If you need to select a resolution that is not supported by your TV, set “MON.CHK” (p.103) in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “SKIP” and try again. (Note that the output video may not be displayed on your TV normally.) CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 92 ❑ Aspect HDMI Selects an aspect ratio to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to “Processing”. Configures the HDMI settings. Settings Through (default) Does not convert the aspect ratio. 16:9 Normal Outputs 4:3 video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either side of the screen. • This setting functions only when 480i/576i or 480p/576p signals are converted into 720p, 1080i, 1080p, or 2160p (4K) signals. ■ HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control (p.123). Settings Off (default) Disables HDMI Control. On Enables HDMI Control. Configure the settings in “TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and “Standby Sync”. • To use HDMI control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.123) after connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices. ❑ TV Audio Input Selects an audio input jack of the unit to be used for TV audio input when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. The unit’s input source automatically switches to TV audio when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner. Settings AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2 Default AV 4 • When using ARC to input TV audio to the unit, you cannot use the input jacks selected here for connecting an external device because the input will be used for TV audio input. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 93 ❑ ARC ❑ HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2 Enables/disables ARC (p.21) when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. Enables/disables the audio output from a TV connected to the HDMI OUT jack. Settings Settings Off Disables ARC. Off (default) Disables the audio output from the TV. On (default) Enables ARC. On Enables the audio output from the TV. • You do not need to change this setting normally. In case noises are produced from the speakers connected to the unit because TV audio signals input to the unit via ARC are not supported by the unit, set “ARC” to “Off” and use the TV’s speakers. ❑ Standby Sync Select whether to use HDMI control to link the standby behavior of the TV and the unit when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. ■ Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in standby mode. If this function is set to “On”, you can use the input selection keys (HDMI 1–7) to select an HDMI input even when the unit is in standby mode (the standby indicator on the unit blinks). Settings Off (default) Does not output videos/audio to the TV. On Outputs videos/audio to the TV. (The unit consumes approximately 3 W of power.) Settings Off Does not set the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off. On Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off. Auto (default) Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off only when the unit is receiving TV audio or HDMI signals. • This setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”. ■ Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. • The “Amp” and “HDMI OUT1” settings are available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”. ❑ Amp Enables/disables the audio output from the speakers connected to the unit. Settings Off Disables the audio output from the speakers. On (default) Enables the audio output from the speakers. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 94 Network Configures the network settings. 6 7 To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Network Standby Selects whether the unit can be turned on from other network devices (network standby). Settings Off (default) Disables the network standby function. On Enables the network standby function. (The unit consumes approximately 2 W of power.) ■ IP Address ■ MAC Address Filter Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. ❑ DHCP ❑ Filter Select whether to use a DHCP server. Enables/disables the MAC address filter. Settings Settings Off Does not use a DHCP server. Configure the network parameters manually. For details, see “Manual network settings”. Off (default) Disables the MAC address filter. On (default) Uses a DHCP server to automatically obtain the unit’s network parameters (such as IP address). On Enables the MAC address filter. In “MAC Address 1–10”, specify the MAC addresses of the network devices that will be permitted access to the unit. ■ Manual network settings 1 2 Set “DHCP” to “Off”. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a parameter type and press ENTER. IP Address Specifies an IP address. Subnet Mask Specifies a subnet mask. Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway. DNS Server (P) Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server. DNS Server (S) Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS server. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to select a value. 4 5 To confirm the setting, press ENTER. To configure another network parameter, repeat steps 2 to 4. ❑ MAC Address 1–10 Specifies the MAC addresses (up to 10) of the network devices that will be permitted access to the unit when “Filter” is set to “On”. ■ Procedure 1 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “MAC Address 1–5” or “MAC Address 6–10” and press ENTER. 2 3 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an MAC address number and press ENTER. 4 5 6 To confirm the setting, press ENTER. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to select a value. To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 95 ■ Network Name Multi Zone Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. Configures the multi zone settings. ■ Procedure 1 2 Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. ■ Main Zone Set Configures the main zone setting. ❑ Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 3 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. ■ Procedure 1 2 Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 3 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 96 ■ Zone2 Set Function Configures the Zone2 settings. Configures the functions that make the unit easier to use. ❑ Max Volume Sets the Zone2 maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness. Setting range -30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB Default +16.5 dB • This setting is available only when “Power Amp Assign” (p.88) is set to “7ch +1ZONE”. ❑ Initial Volume ■ Display Set Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. Configures the settings related to the front display and TV screen display. Settings ❑ Dimmer (Front Display) Off (default) Sets the level at the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby mode. On Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB increments). (This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max Volume”.) Adjusts the brightness of the front display. Setting range -4 to 0 (higher to brighten) Default 0 • This setting is available only when “Power Amp Assign” (p.88) is set to “7ch +1ZONE”. • The front display may become dark when “ECO Mode” (p.99) is set to “On”. ❑ Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. You can change the zone name in the same manner as “Zone Rename” in “Main Zone Set” (p.96). ❑ Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated (such as input selection and volume adjustment). Settings ■ Party Mode Set On (default) Displays short messages on the TV screen. Enables/disables switching to the party mode (p.73). Off Does not display short messages on the TV screen. Choice Target: Zone 2 Settings Disable Disables switching to the party mode. Enable (default) Enables switching to the party mode. You can turn on/off the party mode by pressing PARTY on the remote control. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 97 ❑ Wall Paper Manual Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Manual”. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of the external device connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack. Settings Picture 1 (default), Picture 2, Picture 3 Displays the selected image on the TV screen when there is no video signal. Gray Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there is no video signal. ■ Trigger Output Sets the TRIGGER OUT jack to function in sync with the power status of each zone or input switching. ❑ Trigger Mode Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. Choices Low Stops the electronic signal transmission. High (default) Transmits the electronic signal. ❑ Target Zone Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. Settings Main When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of the main zone. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone. Zone2 When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in Zone2. All (default) When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of the main zone or Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone or Zone2. Settings Power (default) The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the power status of the zone specified with “Target Zone.” Source The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the input switching in the zone specified with “Target Zone.” An electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in “Source.” Manual Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission with “Manual.” Source Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input, switching when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”. Choices HDMI 1–7, AV 1–6, V-AUX, AUDIO 1–2, TUNER, PHONO*, (network sources), USB * Except for U.S.A. and Canada models Settings Low Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input source specified in this option. High (default) Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source specified in this option. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 98 ■ Memory Guard ECO Prevents accidental changes to the settings. Configures the power supply settings. Settings Off (default) Does not protect the settings. On Protects the settings until “Off” is selected. • When “Memory Guard” is set to “On”, the lock icon (o) is displayed on the menu screen. Icon ■ Auto Power Down Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. If you do not operate the unit for the specified time, the unit will automatically go into standby mode. Settings Off Does not set the unit to standby mode automatically. 2 hours, 4 hours, 8 hours, 12 hours Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit for the specified time. For example, when “2 hours” is selected, the unit will switch to standby mode if you do not operate it for 2 hours. Default U.K. and Europe models: 8 hours Other models: Off • Just before the unit enters standby mode, “AutoPowerDown” appears and then countdown starts in the front display. ■ ECO Mode Enables/disables the eco (power saving) mode. When the eco mode is enabled, you can reduce the unit’s power consumption. Settings Off (default) Disables the eco mode. On Enables the eco mode. • The new setting will take effect after the unit is restarted. • When “ECO Mode” is set to “On”, the front panel display may become dark. • If you want to play audio at high volume, set “ECO Mode” to “Off”. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 99 Language Select an on-screen menu language. Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) You can view information about the unit using the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an information type. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Information” and press ENTER. Settings English (default) English 日本語 Japanese Français French Deutsch German Español Spanish Russian Chinese • The information on the front display is provided in English only. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) En 100 ■ Network Types of information Displays the network information on the unit. ■ Audio Signal IP Address IP address Displays information about the current audio signal. Subnet Mask Subnet mask Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway DNS Server (P) The IP address of the primary DNS server Format Audio format of the input signal Channel The number of source channels in the input signal (front/surround/LFE) For example, “5.1 (3/2/0.1)” means 5.1ch in total (3 front channels, 2 surround channels, and LFE). Input Sampling The number of samples per second of the input digital signal Bitrate The amount of data per second of the input bitstream signal Dialogue Output The dialogue normalization level of the input bitstream signal The speaker terminals from which signals are output DNS Server (S) The IP address of the secondary DNS server MAC Address MAC address Network Name Network name (the unit’s name on the network) Status The connection status of the NETWORK jack ■ System Displays the system information on the unit. • Even when the unit is set to output bitstream signals directly, the signal may be converted depending on the specifications and settings of the playback device. Remote ID The unit’s remote control ID setting (p.102) TV Format The unit’s video signal type (p.103) Speaker Impedance The speaker impedance setting of the unit (p.102) ■ Video Signal System ID System ID number Displays information about the current video signal. Firmware Version The version of firmware installed on the unit HDMI Signal Presence or absence of HDMI signal input/output HDMI Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI) Analog Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog) and signal output at the MONITOR OUT jacks (analog) • If the unit detects a newer firmware over the network, “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in this screen. You can update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in this screen and following the procedure in “Updating the unit’s firmware” (p.110). ■ HDMI Monitor ■ Zone Displays information about the TVs connected to the HDMI OUT jacks. Displays information about Zone2. Interface TV interface Input The input source selected for Zone2 Video Resolution Resolutions supported by the TV Volume The volume setting for Zone2 • Use the cursor keys (q/w) to switch between “OUT1” and “OUT2”. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) En 101 Changing the speaker impedance setting (SP IMP.) Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) SPIMP.8MIN Configure the system settings of the unit while viewing the front display. 1 2 Change the unit’s speaker impedance settings depending on the impedance of the speakers connected. Set the unit to standby mode. Settings While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z. MAIN ZONE z PROGRAM 3 4 5 6 MIN Select this option when you connect 6-ohm speakers to the unit. You can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. 8 MIN (default) Select this option when you connect 8-ohm or higher speakers to the unit. Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID) STRAIGHT Press PROGRAM to select an item. REMOTEIDID1 Press STRAIGHT to select a setting. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on again. Change the unit’s remote control ID so that it matches the remote control’s ID (default: ID1). When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each remote control with a unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver. Settings ID1 (default), ID2 The new settings take effect. ■ Changing the remote control ID of the remote control ADVANCED SETUP menu items Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be automatically canceled. Item Function SP IMP. Changes the speaker impedance setting. Page 102 REMOTE ID Selects the unit’s remote control ID. 102 TU (Asia and General models only) Changes the FM/AM tuning frequency setting. 103 TV FORMAT Switches the video signal type. 103 MON.CHK Removes the limitation on HDMI video output. 103 INIT Restores the default settings. 103 UPDATE Updates the firmware. 104 VERSION Checks the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. 104 1 2 3 Press CODE SET on the remote control. Press RECEIVER. Use the numeric keys to enter “5019” (ID1) or “5020” (ID2). Once the remote control ID is registered successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. If it blinks six times, registration failed. Repeat from Step 1. • The registered remote control codes (p.105) are not cleared even if you change the remote control ID. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 102 Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TU) (Asia and General models only) TUFM50/AM9 Change the FM/AM tuning frequency setting of the unit depending on your country or region. Settings FM100/AM10 Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 100-kHz steps and AM by 10-kHz steps. FM50/AM9 (default) Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 50-kHz steps and AM by 9-kHz steps. Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) TVFORMATNTSC Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MON.CHK) MON.CHKYES The unit automatically detects resolutions supported by a TV connected to the HDMI OUT jack. Disable the monitor check function if you want to specify a resolution in “Resolution” (p.92) when the unit cannot detect the TV’s resolution or when you want to specify a different resolution than the detected resolution. Settings YES (default) Enables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a resolution supported by the TV only.) SKIP Disables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a specified resolution regardless of compatibility with the TV.) • Reset to “YES” if the unit becomes inoperable because video from the unit cannot be displayed on the TV after “MON.CHK” has been set to “SKIP”. Switch the video signal type of the unit so that it matches to the format of your TV. Settings NTSC, PAL Default U.S.A., Canada, Korea and General models: NTSC Other models: PAL Restoring the default settings (INIT) INITCANCEL Restores the default settings for the unit. Choices VIDEO Restores the default settings for video configurations. ALL Restores the default settings for the unit. CANCEL Does not perform an initialization. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 103 Updating the firmware (UPDATE) UPDATEUSB New firmware that provides additional features or product improvements will be released as needed. Updates can be downloaded from our website. If the unit is connected to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network. For details, refer to the information supplied with updates. ■ Firmware update procedure Do not perform this procedure unless firmware update is necessary. Also, make sure you read the information supplied with updates before updating the firmware. 1 Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “USB” or “NETWORK” and press INFO to start firmware update. Choices USB Update the firmware using a USB memory device. NETWORK Update the firmware via the network. • If the unit detects newer firmware over the network, the corresponding message will be displayed after ON SCREEN is pressed. In this case, you can also update the unit’s firmware by following the procedure in “Updating the unit’s firmware” (p.110). Checking the firmware version (VERSION) VERSIONxx.xx Check the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. • You can also check the firmware version in “System” (p.101) in the “Information” menu. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 104 SOURCE RECEIVER SOURCE Controlling external devices with the remote control HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 4 1 2 3 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET AUDIO MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 • You cannot control an external device that does not have a remote control sensor. HDMI OUT • Ensure that the remote control ID of the external device is set to “ID1”. If any other ID is selected, the remote control operations may not work properly. SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO • If the unit’s remote control is without batteries for more than 2 minutes, the registered codes may be cleared. If this happens, insert new batteries and register the codes again. VOLUME OPTION ENTER RETURN BAND MODE INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 3 4 ■ TV operations Registering the remote control code for a TV Once you have registered the remote control code for your TV, you can control it using the TV operation keys, regardless of the input source selected on the unit. 7 8 TV operation keys Numeric keys MEMORY 10 0 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE Once the remote control code is successfully registered, SOURCE blinks twice. You can use the unit’s remote control to operate a TV if you have registered its remote control code. MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 9 Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote control code. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE Press TV z. • Under the unit’s default settings, the amplifier code (Yamaha: 5098) is set for all the input selection keys. With this setting, you can control HDMI Control-compatible devices connected to the unit with the remote control. (This function may not work depending on the specification of the external device.) DISPLAY TUNING 3 4 If it blinks six times, registration has failed. Repeat from Step 2. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 2. You can use the unit’s remote control to operate external devices (such as BD/DVD players) if you have registered the remote control code of the external device. AV TV CH CODE SET TV operation keys TV z CODE SET • You can also register your TV’s remote control code to the unit’s input selection keys (p.106). This would allow you to use the cursor keys or numeric keys to operate the TV (this function may not be available on some TV models). INPUT Switches the video inputs of the TV. MUTE Mutes the audio output of the TV. TV VOL Adjust the volume of the TV. TV CH Switch the channels of the TV TV z Turns on/off the TV. • (China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only) You can also assign a function to each key using the learning function (p.107). 1 Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM to find your TV’s remote control code. • If there are multiple remote control codes, register the first code in the list. If that does not work, try the other codes. 2 Press CODE SET. SOURCE blinks twice. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Controlling external devices with the remote control En 105 RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 SOURCE z SOURCE RECEIVER AV Input selection keys AUDIO 5 6 TUNER MAIN 1 USB 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT Registering the remote control codes for playback devices You can use the unit’s remote control to operate playback devices if you have registered their remote control codes. You can also use the input selection keys to change the playback devices that are controlled by the remote control, because their remote control codes are assigned to the input selection keys. • For details on how to register a remote control code to a SCENE key, refer to “Configuring scene assignments” (p.44). ■ Playback device operations Once you have registered the remote control code for your playback device, you can control it using the following keys after selecting the input source or scene. SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO • (U.S.A. and Canada models only) If you assign the remote control code for an external device to the star (★) key, you can operate the device with the remote control without switching the input source after pressing the star key. VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION External device operation keys Menu operation keys ENTER RETURN DISPLAY • (China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only) You can also assign a function to each key using the learning function (p.107). 1 DISPLAY Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM to find the remote control code for your playback device. BAND MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET • If there are multiple remote control codes, register the first code in the list. If that does not work, try the other codes. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Numeric keys 2 MEMORY 9 10 0 ENT TV TV operation keys INPUT TV VOL MUTE CODE SET CODE SET 3 SOURCE z Menu operation keys Select an item. ENTER Confirms a selected item. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. TOP MENU Displays the top menu. DISPLAY Switches information on the display. POP-UP/MENU Displays the pop-up menu. SOURCE blinks twice. s Stops playback. d Stops playback temporarily. a Starts playback of the selected song/video. External device operation keys h Press the input selection key. j For example, press HDMI 1 to set the remote control code for the playback device connected to the HDMI 1 jack. 4 Turns on/off the playback device. Cursor keys Press CODE SET. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 2. TV CH • By pressing SOURCE or RECEIVER, you can switch the devices (the unit or external device) that are operated by the menu operation keys, DISPLAY and numeric keys. You can operate the unit after pressing RECEIVER (lights up in orange), and an external device after pressing SOURCE (lights up in green). For example, if you register the remote control code of your external device on TUNER, you can operate the unit’s built-in FM/AM radio after pressing RECEIVER and the external device after pressing SOURCE. Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote control code. Searches forward/backward (by holding down). f g Skips forward/backward. Numeric keys Enter numerical values. TV operation keys Control the TV (p.105). Once the remote control code is registered successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. If it blinks six times, registration has failed. Repeat from Step 2. CONFIGURATIONS • These keys work only if the corresponding function is available on your playback device and if the device can be operated with an infrared remote control. ➤ Controlling external devices with the remote control En 106 RECEIVER SOURCE SOURCE z SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 TUNER MAIN 1 USB 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO 1 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION External device operation keys RETURN 2 DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 0 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET TV operation keys TV z CODE SET 3 4 b On the external device, press the key from which the operation is learned. SOURCE blinks twice. If it blinks six times, learning has failed. Repeat Step 5. Press one of the following keys depending on the type of your device. For TV: press TV z. MEMORY For TV: TV operation keys Once the operation is learned successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. For playback device: press the input selection key (corresponding to the input jacks where the device is connected). SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE For playback device: SOURCE z, menu operations keys, external device operation keys Press CODE SET. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 1. Menu operation keys ENTER Perform the following steps within 10 seconds. a On this unit, press one of the following keys to which you want to assign a function. The remote control of the unit can receive remote control signals from other remote controls and learn the remote control operation. If you cannot find a remote control code for your playback device or if any key on the remote control does not work after you register the remote control code, use the learning function to assign a function to each key. AUDIO 6 5 (China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only) AV 5 Programming from other remote controls (learning) Use the numeric keys to enter “9990”. 6 Repeat step 5 until all desired operations are learned. 7 Press CODE SET. SOURCE blinks once. Note • If you press RECEIVER in step 2, you can assign functions of an external receiver to the menu operation keys, external device operation keys or numeric keys. However, it makes these keys to control the unit impossible. If you need to restore the remote control code for the unit, perform the following steps. a Press CODE SET. b Press RECEIVER. Aim the infrared transmitters of the remote controls at each other. c Use the numeric keys to enter “9992”. Remote control of external device 3 V-AUX 4 HDMI AV 2 HDMI OUT AUDIO PARTY RECEIVER 7 4 SOURCE 3 6 1 2 2 NET 1 6 5 1 USB ZONE 2 5 RADIO VOLUME NET SCENE TV MUTE POP-UP/MENU TUNER MAIN BD DVD PROGRAM TOP MENU 5 to 10 cm apart CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Controlling external devices with the remote control En 107 SOURCE RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 AV 6 TUNER MAIN 1 USB TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU 1 1 HDMI OUT SCENE BD DVD (China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only) Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 1. VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN 2 OPTION Press one of the following keys to select the device for which key assignments will be cleared. ENTER For playback device: press the input selection key. RETURN For TV: press TV z. DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING 3 4 PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 4 7 8 10 0 MUTE Press one of the following keys to select the device for which key assignments will be cleared. For playback device: press the input selection key. For TV: press TV z. 3 Use the numeric keys to enter “9992”. Once the key assignment is cleared successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. If it blinks six times, clearing failed. Repeat from Step 1. Use the numeric keys to enter “9991”. Press the key that you want to reset. ENT If it blinks six times, clearing failed. Repeat from Step 2. TV TV z INPUT TV VOL 2 Once the key assignment is cleared successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. Numeric keys MEMORY 9 Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 1. Press CODE SET. SOURCE blinks twice. RADIO Press CODE SET. SOURCE blinks twice. ■ Clearing the assignment for each key 2 NET PARTY ZONE 2 ■ Clearing the assignments for each input source Input selection keys AUDIO 5 Clearing functions learned from other remote controls TV CH CODE SET CODE SET 5 Repeat step 4 until all desired key assignments are cleared. 6 Press CODE SET. SOURCE blinks once. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Controlling external devices with the remote control En 108 SOURCE RECEIVER SOURCE Resetting remote control codes RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 You can reset a remote control code registered to each input selection key. AV Input selection keys AUDIO 5 6 TUNER MAIN 1 USB 2 1 SOURCE blinks twice. NET PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 1. SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU RADIO 2 3 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Press CODE SET. Press the input selection key. Use the numeric keys to enter “5098”. OPTION Once the remote control code is reset successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. ENTER RETURN If it blinks six times, resetting has failed. Repeat from Step 1. DISPLAY BAND To reset the remote control to factory default settings MODE TUNING PRESET a Press CODE SET. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC b Press RECEIVER. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 c Use the numeric keys to enter “9981”. 3 7 4 8 Numeric keys MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET CODE SET CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Controlling external devices with the remote control En 109 Updating the unit’s firmware RECEIVER SOURCE HDMI 1 2 5 6 3 4 7 V-AUX 3 4 New firmware that provides additional features or product improvements will be released as needed. If the unit is connected to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network and update it. AV 1 2 AUDIO 5 6 1 TUNER USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 HDMI OUT Note RADIO • Do not operate the unit or disconnect the power cable or network cable during firmware update. Firmware update takes about 20 minutes or more (depending on your Internet connection speed). SCENE BD DVD TV NET PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU Information icon VOLUME • You can also update the firmware using the USB memory device from the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu (p.104). POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN • If you want to update the firmware later, select “CLOSE” in Step 2. “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and a message will be displayed in the “System” screen (p.101). You can update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in the “System” screen. A firmware update is available if the following message is displayed after ON SCREEN is pressed. DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP Message ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 System Icon MEMORY 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH CODE SET 1 2 Read the on-screen description. To start the firmware update, use the cursor keys to select “START” and press ENTER. The on-screen display turns off. 3 If “Update Success Please Power Off!” appears on the front display, press MAIN ZONE z on the front panel. The firmware update is complete. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Updating the unit’s firmware En 110 APPENDIX Frequently asked questions The new speaker system does not provide an ideal sound balance... I want to turn off the on-screen messages displayed during operations... If you have changed speakers or have a new speaker system, use “Auto Setup” to optimize the speaker settings again (p.35). If you want to adjust the speaker settings manually, use “Manual Setup” in the “Setup” menu (p.88). By default, short messages are displayed on the TV screen when the unit is operated (such as input selection and volume adjustment). If the short messages bother you when you are watching movies or sports, configure “Short Message” (p.97) in the “Setup” menu to turn off the short messages. Since we have small children, we want to set limitations on the volume control... If a small child accidentally operates the controls on the main unit or remote control, the volume may suddenly increase. This may also cause injury or damage the unit or speakers. We recommend using “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the maximum volume level for the unit in advance (p.91). You can also set the maximum volume for Zone2 (p.97). I am occasionally startled by a sudden loud sound when turning on the unit... By default, the volume level when the unit last entered standby mode is automatically applied. If you want to fix the volume, use “Initial Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the volume to be applied when the receiver is turned on (p.92). You can also set the initial volume for Zone2 (p.97). I want to prevent accidental changes to the settings... You can protect the settings configured on the unit (such as speaker settings) by utilizing “Memory Guard” in the “Setup” menu (p.99). The unit’s remote control is simultaneously controlling another Yamaha product as well as the unit... When using multiple Yamaha products, the remote control may work on another Yamaha product or another remote control may work on the unit. If this happens, register different remote control IDs for the devices that you want to control with each remote control (p.102). I made HDMI connections but HDMI Control does not work at all... To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.123). After connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices (such as BD/DVD players) to the unit, enable HDMI Control on each device and perform the HDMI Control link setup. This setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. For information on how HDMI Control works between your TV and playback devices, refer to the instruction manuals for each device. APPENDIX ➤ Frequently asked questions En 111 Troubleshooting Refer to the table below when the unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below or if the instructions below do not help, turn off the unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. First, check the following: a The power cables of the unit, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are connected to AC wall outlets securely. b The unit, subwoofer, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are turned on. c The connectors of each cable are securely inserted in to jacks on each device. Power and system Problem Cause Remedy The power does not turn on. The protection circuitry has been activated three times consecutively. When the unit is in this condition, the standby indicator on the unit blinks if you try to turn on the power. As a safety precaution, capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your nearest Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair. The power does not turn off. The internal microcomputer has frozen, due to an external electric shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop in the power supply voltage. Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize and reboot the unit. The power turns off (standby mode) immediately. The unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and speakers (p.18). The unit enters standby mode automatically. The unit is not reacting. The sleep timer worked. Turn on the unit and start playback again. The auto-standby function kicked in because the unit was not used for the specified time. To disable the auto-standby function, set “Auto Power Down” in the “Setup” menu to “Off” (p.99). The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers (p.102). The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short circuit. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and speakers (p.18). The internal microcomputer is frozen, due to an external electric shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop in the power supply voltage. Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize and reboot the unit. APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 112 Audio Problem No sound. The volume cannot be increased. Cause Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys. Signals that the unit cannot reproduce are being input. Some digital audio formats cannot be played back on the unit. To check the audio format of the input signal, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.101). The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The maximum volume is set. Use “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the maximum volume (p.91). A device connected to the output jacks of the unit is not turned on. (This may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.) Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of the unit. The playback source does not contain a signal for the channel. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.101). The currently selected sound program/decoder does not use the speaker. To check it, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu (p.90). Audio output of the speaker is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.35) or use “Configuration” in the “Setup” menu to change the speaker settings (p.88). The volume of the speaker is set too low. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.35) or use “Level” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the speaker volume (p.90). The speaker cable connecting the unit and the speaker is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another speaker cable. The speaker is malfunctioning. To check it, replace with another speaker. If the problem persists, the unit may be malfunctioning. The extended surround is disabled. Use “Extended Surround” in the “Option” menu to select a decoder to be used (p.77). The playback source does not contain LFE or low-frequency signals. To check it, set “Extra Bass” in the “Setup” menu to “On”, in order to output the front channel low-frequency components from the subwoofer (p.89). Subwoofer output is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.35) or set “Subwoofer” in the “Setup” menu to “Use” (p.89). The volume of the subwoofer is too low. Adjust the volume on the subwoofer. The subwoofer has been turned off by its auto-standby function. Disable the auto-standby function of the subwoofer or adjust its sensitivity level. The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications. The unit is set not to output audio input through HDMI jacks from the SPEAKERS terminals. In “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu, set “Amp” to “On” (p.94). The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack exceeds the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices. No sound is coming from a specific speaker. No sound is coming from the surround back speaker. No sound is coming from the subwoofer. No sound from the playback device (connected to the unit with HDMI). Remedy Another input source is selected. APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 113 Problem No sound from the TV (when HDMI Control is used). Only the front speakers work on multichannel audio. Cause Remedy The TV is set to output audio from the TV speakers. Change the audio output setting on your TV so that the TV audio is output from the speakers connected to the unit. (If the TV is connected to the unit with an audio cable) The TV audio input setting does not match the actual connection. Use “TV Audio Input” in the “Setup” menu to select the correct audio input jack (p.93). (If you are trying to use ARC) ARC is disabled on the unit or TV. Set “ARC” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.94). Also, enable ARC on the TV. The playback device is set to output 2-channel audio (such as PCM) only. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.101). If necessary, change the digital audio output setting on the playback device. The unit is too close to another digital or radio frequency device. Move the unit further away from the device. The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. Noise/hum is heard. The sound is distorted. The volume of the unit is too high. Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” is set to “On”, set it to “Off” (p.99). A device connected to the unit’s output jacks is not turned on. (This may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.) Turn on all devices connected to the unit’s output jacks. Cause Remedy Another input source is selected on the unit. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys. Video Problem No video. No video from the playback device (connected to the unit with HDMI). Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit. The video signal output from the unit is not supported by the TV. Set “MON.CHK” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “YES” (p.103). The cable connecting the unit and TV (or playback device) is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The input video signal (resolution) is not supported by the unit. To check the information about the current video signal (resolution), use “Video Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.101). For information about video signals supported by the unit, see “HDMI signal compatibility” (p.124). The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications. The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices. The TV is not connected to the unit via HDMI. You can display the menu of the unit on the TV only when they are connected with an HDMI cable. If necessary, use an HDMI cable to connect them (p.21 to 24). Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). The menu of the unit is not displayed on the TV. APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 114 FM/AM radio Problem Cause There is multi-path interference. Remedy Adjust the FM antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location. Set “FM Mode” in the “Option” menu to “Mono” to select monaural FM radio reception (p.77). FM radio reception is weak or noisy. Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter. Use an outdoor FM antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. AM radio reception is weak or noisy. The noises may be caused by fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats, or other electrical equipment. It is difficult to completely eliminate noise. It may be reduced by using an outdoor AM antenna. Select the station manually (p.51). Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter. Use an outdoor antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. Adjust the AM antenna orientation. Radio stations cannot be selected automatically. The AM radio signal is weak. Select the station manually (p.51). Use an outdoor AM antenna. Connect it to the ANTENNA (AM) jack together with the supplied AM antenna. AM radio stations cannot be registered as presets. Auto Preset has been used. Auto Preset is for registering FM radio stations only. Register AM radio stations manually (p.52). Cause Remedy The USB device is not connected to the USB jack securely. Turn off the unit, reconnect your USB device, and turn the unit on again. USB and network Problem The unit does not detect the USB device. The file system of the USB device is not FAT16 or FAT32. Use a USB device with FAT16 or FAT32 format. Folders and files in the USB device cannot be viewed. The data in the USB device is protected by the encryption. Use a USB device without an encryption function. The network feature does not function. The network parameters (IP address) have not been obtained properly. Enable the DHCP server function on your router and set “DHCP” in the “Setup” menu to “On” on the unit (p.95). If you want to configure the network parameters manually, check that you are using an IP address which is not used by other network devices in your network (p.95). The media sharing setting is not correct. Configure the sharing setting and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.63). Some security software installed on your PC is blocking the access of the unit to your PC. Check the settings of security software installed on your PC. The unit and PC are not in the same network. Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the unit and the PC to the same network. The unit does not detect the PC. APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 115 Problem Cause Remedy The files in the PC cannot be viewed or played back. The files are not supported by the unit or the media server. Use the file format supported by both the unit and the media server. For information about the file formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.63). The selected Internet radio station is currently not available. There may be a network problem at the radio station, or the service may have been stopped. Try the station later or select another station. The selected Internet radio station is currently broadcasting silence. Some Internet radio stations broadcast silence at certain of times of the day. Try the station later or select another station. Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of your network devices (such as the router). Check the firewall settings of your network devices. The Internet radio can be played only when it passes through the port designated by each radio station. The port number varies depending on the radio station. Cause Remedy The unit is out of the operating range. Use the remote control within the operating range (p.5). The batteries are weak. Replace with new batteries. The unit’s remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight or strong lighting. Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition the unit. The remote control is set to control external devices. Press RECEIVER to set the remote control to control the unit (the key lights up in orange). The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not identical. Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.102). The remote control is set to control the unit. Press SOURCE to set the remote control to control external devices (the key lights up in green). The corresponding remote control code is not set properly. Set the remote control code again (p.105). Even if the remote control code is registered properly, some products may not respond to the remote control. The batteries of the remote control of the unit and/or the external device are weak. Replace with new batteries. The Internet radio cannot be played. Remote control Problem The unit cannot be controlled using the remote control. External devices cannot be controlled using the remote control. The distance between the two remote controls is not appropriate. The remote control does not learn new functions. The signal coding or modulation of the other remote control is not (China, Korea, U.K. and Europe models only) compatible with the remote control. Memory capacity is full. Place the remote controls at a proper distance (p.107). Learning is impossible in this case. Clear unnecessary assignments to free some memory space for new functions (p.108). APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 116 Error indications on the front display Message Cause Remedy Access denied Access to the PC is denied. Configure the sharing settings and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.63). The unit cannot access the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. The unit cannot access the iPod. Turn off the iPod and turn it on again. Access error Make sure your router and modem are turned on. There is a problem with the signal path from the network to the unit. Check the connection between the unit and your router (or hub) (p.30). Check SP Wires The speaker cables short circuit. Connect error The unit has detected the iPod, but cannot access it. Twist the bare wires of the cables firmly and connect to the unit and speakers properly. Turn off the iPod and then turn it on again. Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. No content There are no playable files in the selected folder. Select a folder that contains files supported by the unit. The unit cannot detect the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. No device The unit cannot detect the iPod. Turn off the iPod and then turn it on again. Please wait The unit is preparing for connecting to the network. Wait until the message disappears. If the message stays more than 3 minutes, turn off the unit and turn it on again. RemID Mismatch The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not identical. Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.102). The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the iPod for some reason. Check the song data. If it cannot be played on the iPod itself, the song data or storage area may be defective. The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the PC for some reason. Check if the format of files you are trying to play is supported by the unit. For information about the formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.63). If the unit supports the file format, but still cannot play back any files, the network may be overloaded with heavy traffic. Unknown iPod The connected iPod is not supported by the unit. Use an iPod supported by the unit (p.56). USB Overloaded An overcurrent is flowing through the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. Unable to play APPENDIX ➤ Error indications on the front display En 117 Ideal speaker layout Use this diagram as a guide. You do not need to adjust the speaker layout to the following diagram exactly. Q W 0.5 to 1 m (1.6 to 3.3 ft) 0.5 to 1 m (1.6 to 3.3 ft) 1.8 m (5.9 ft) 1 9 1.8 m (5.9 ft) 2 3 9 Turn it slightly inward to reduce wall reflections. Turn it slightly inward to reduce wall reflections. 4 5 10° to 30° 10° to 30° 1 Front speaker (L) 2 Front speaker (R) 3 Center speaker 6 7 4 Surround speaker (L) 5 Surround speaker (R) 6 Surround back speaker (L) 7 Surround back speaker (R) 30 cm (1 ft) or more Q Presence speaker (L) W Presence speaker (R) 9 Subwoofer APPENDIX ➤ Ideal speaker layout En 118 Glossary Audio information ■ Audio decoding format Dolby Digital Dolby Digital is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports 5.1-channel audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs. Dolby Digital EX Dolby Digital EX creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX. This decoder adds a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound. Dolby Digital Plus Dolby Digital Plus is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports 7.1-channel audio. Dolby Digital Plus remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support Dolby Digital. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). Dolby Pro Logic II Dolby Pro Logic II enables 5-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources, and “Game mode” for game sources. Dolby Pro Logic IIx DTS Express DTS Express is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel audio and allows a higher compression rate than the DTS Digital Surround format developed by DTS, Inc. This technology is developed for audio streaming services on the Internet and secondary audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). DTS-HD High Resolution Audio DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports 7.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). DTS-HD Master Audio DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio format developed to offer a high-definition home theater experience with the quality of the studio master by DTS, Inc. DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). DTS Neo:6 DTS Neo:6 enables 6-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are two modes available: “Music mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources. This technology provides discrete full-bandwidth matrix channels of surround sound. DSD (Direct Stream Digital) Dolby Pro Logic IIx enables 7-channel playback from 2-channel or multichannel sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources and “Game mode” for game sources (for 2-channel sources only). DSD (Direct Stream Digital) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as SACD (Super Audio CDs). The signals are stored at a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz. The highest frequency response is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This technology offers better audio quality than that used for CDs. Dolby TrueHD FLAC Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. to offer a high-definition home theater experience with the quality of the studio master. Dolby TrueHD can carry up to eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). FLAC is a file format for lossless audio data compression. FLAC is inferior to lossy compressed audio formats in compression rate but provides higher audio quality. DTS 96/24 DTS 96/24 is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. This format remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This technology is used for music DVDs, etc. DTS Digital Surround DTS Digital Surround is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports 5.1-channel audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs. DTS-ES DTS-ES creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with DTS-ES. This decoder adds a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound. In the DTS-ES Matrix 6.1 format, a surround back sound is recorded in the surround channels, and in the DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 format, a discrete surround back channel is recorded. MP3 One of the compressed digital audio format used by MPEG. With psychoacoustic technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing data quantity by about 1/10 maintaining a certain level of audio quality. MPEG-4 AAC An MPEG-4 audio standard. It is used for mobile telephones, portable audio players, and audio streaming services on Internet because it allows a high compression rate of data while maintaining better audio quality than MP3. PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded, and transmitted. This technology is the basis of all other audio format. This technology is used as a lossless audio format called Linear PCM for audio on a variety of media, including CDs and BD (Blu-ray discs). APPENDIX ➤ Glossary En 119 Sampling frequency/Quantization bit Sampling frequency and quantization bits indicate the quantity of information when an analog audio signal is digitized. These values are noted as in the following example: “48 kHz/24-bit”. • Sampling frequency Sampling frequency (the number of times the signal is sampled per second) is called the sampling rate. When the sampling frequency is higher, the range of frequencies that can be played back are wider. • Quantization bit The number of quantization bits indicate the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a numeric value. When the number of quantized bits is higher, the expression of the sound level is more accurate. WAV Windows standard audio file format, which defines the method of recording the digital data obtained by converting audio signals. By default, the PCM method (no compression) is used, but you can also use other compression methods. WMA (Windows Media Audio) One of the compressed digital audio formats developed by Microsoft Corporation. With psychoacoustic technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing data quantity by about 1/20 maintaining a certain level of audio quality. ■ Others Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp) A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. When you use the bi-amplification connection, the unit drives the tweeter and woofer in a speaker with the discrete amplifiers. As a consequence, the tweeter and woofer provide clear audio signal without the interference. LFE (Low Frequency Effects) 0.1 channel This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is added to the channels for all bands with Dolby Digital or DTS to enhance low frequency audio effects. This channel is labeled 0.1 because it is limited to only low frequency audio. HDMI and video information Component video signal With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and the Pb and Pr signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals is independent. Composite video signal With the composite video signal system, color, brightness, and synchronization data signals are combined and transmitted with a single cable. Deep Color Deep Color is a technology that HDMI specification supports. Deep Color increases the number of available colors within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space. Conventional color systems process the color using 8 bits. Deep Color processes the color with 10, 12, or 16 bits. This technology allows HDTVs and other displays to increase from millions of colors to billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors. HDMI HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the world-wide standard interface for digital audio/video signal transmission. This interface transmits both digital audio and digital video signals using a single cable without any loss. HDMI complies with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) and provides a secure audio/video interface. For further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http://www.hdmi.org/”. x.v.Color “x.v.Color” is a technology that the HDMI specification supports. It is a more extensive color space than sRGB and allows the expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with the color gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and thus can produce more vivid, natural images. Lip sync Video output sometimes lags behind audio output due to the complexity of signal processing caused by an increase in video signal capacity. Lip sync is a technique for automatically correcting the timing lag between audio and video output. APPENDIX ➤ Glossary En 120 Yamaha technologies CINEMA DSP (Digital Sound Field Processor) Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best experienced in a theater that has many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions (such as room size, wall material, and number of speakers) can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in the sound that you hear. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, CINEMA DSP, Yamaha’s original DSP technology provides the audiovisual experience of a movie theater in your own home. CINEMA DSP 3D The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP 3D mode achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the accurate and intensive 3D sound fields in a listening room. Compressed Music Enhancer The Compressed Music Enhancer feature compensates for missing harmonics in compression music formats (such as MP3). As a result, this technology provides improved performance for the overall sound system. SILENT CINEMA Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound programs can be enjoyed on headphones. Virtual CINEMA DSP Virtual CINEMA DSP allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with front left and right speakers. Even if the surround speakers are not connected, the unit creates the realistic sound field in a listening room. APPENDIX ➤ Glossary En 121 Video signal flow Video signals input from a video device to the unit are output to a TV as shown below. ■ Video conversion table • You can select the resolution and the aspect ratio applied to HDMI-output video processing in “Video Mode” (p.92) in the “Setup” menu. • The unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably. HDMI out Video device The unit TV Resolution 480i/ 576i 480p/ 576p 720p 1080i 1080p 4K 480i/576i m m m m m m m m m m m 720p m m m m 1080i m m m m 1080p/50, 60 Hz m m m m m m 480p/576p HDMI in HDMI out HDMI HDMI HDMI HDMI HDMI in 1080p/24 Hz COMPONENT VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO out COMPONENT VIDEO 480i/576i COMPONENT VIDEO PR PR PR PR PB PB PB PB Y Y Y Y VIDEO VIDEO in VIDEO out VIDEO VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO in m m m m m m VIDEO in 720p 1080i 480i/ 576i m m 720p 480i/576i 480p/ 576p m 480p/576p m 1080i VIDEO 480i/ 576i m 4K COMPONENT VIDEO in VIDEO out COMPONENT VIDEO out m m m m m m m m: Available APPENDIX ➤ Glossary En 122 (Example) Information on HDMI HDMI Control HDMI Control HDMI Control HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit (such as power and volume) with TV remote control operations. You can also control playback devices (such as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players) connected to the unit with an HDMI cable. For details on connections, see “Connecting a TV” (p.21) and “Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players)” (p.26). Operations available from the TV’s remote control Press SCENE (BD/DVD) To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the following HDMI Control link setup after connecting the TV and playback devices. • This setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. • Standby synchronization • Volume control including mute • Switching to input audio from the TV when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner • Switching to input video/audio from the selected playback device 1 2 • Switching between audio output devices (the unit or TV speaker) HDMI Control Playback device also turns off The unit turns off (standby) Turn off the TV Operations available from the unit’s remote control • Starting playback on the playback device and turning on the TV with a scene selection (p.44) • Switching the TV input to display the on-screen menu (when ON SCREEN is pressed) • Controlling the playback device (playback and menu operations) without registering remote control codes (p.106) Turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices. Enable HDMI Control on the unit, TV, and playback devices (such as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players). To enable HDMI Control on the unit, set “HDMI Control” (p.93) in the “Setup” menu to “On” and configure the related items (“TV Audio Input”, “ARC”, and “Standby Sync”). (Example) HDMI Control Turns on and displays video from the playback device Playback starts 3 Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off the unit and playback devices. 4 5 6 Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit. Check the followings. On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select the input source manually. On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed. APPENDIX ➤ Information on HDMI En 123 7 Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control. HDMI signal compatibility Audio signals Audio signal type Audio signal format Compatible media (example) 2ch Linear PCM 2ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio • If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on the TV. Multichannel Linear PCM 8ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit DVD-Audio, BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD • We recommend using TV and playback devices from the same manufacturer so that HDMI Control works more effectively. DSD 2/5.1ch, 2.8224 MHz, 1 bit SACD Bitstream Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video Bitstream (High definition audio) Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD High Resolution Audio, DTS Express • If HDMI Control does not work properly, try unplugging the TV in Step 2 and plugging in the TV again in Step 3. It may solve the problem. Also, HDMI Control may not work if the number of connected devices exceeds the limit. In this case, disable HDMI Control on the devices not in use. Video signals The unit is compatible with the video signals of the following resolutions: • VGA • 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz • 480i/60 Hz • 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz • 576i/50 Hz • 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz • 480p/60 Hz • 3840 x 2160p/30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz (4K signals) • 576p/50 Hz • 4096 x 2160p/24 Hz (4K signals) • When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video/audio signals may not be output, depending on the type of the DVD player. • The unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI devices. For details, refer to the instruction manual for each device. • To decode audio bitstream signals on the unit, set the input source device appropriately so that the device outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream signals on the playback device). For details, refer to the instruction manual for the playback device. APPENDIX ➤ Information on HDMI En 124 Reference diagram (rear panel) RS-232C DC OUT 5V 0.5A NETWORK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT (NET) HDMI 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 HDMI 6 HDMI 7 1 2 ARC SPEAKERS ANTENNA AM FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO (RADIO) COMPONENT VIDEO CENTER ZONE 2/PRESENCE SURROUND BACK/BI AMP SURROUND REMOTE FM PR IN PR SINGLE OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y MONITOR OUT 12V 0.1A TRIGGER OUT EXTRA SP SINGLE CENTER AC IN OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL OPTICAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (TV) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO OUT ZONE 2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 (U.S.A. model) • The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product to prevent improper connections. APPENDIX ➤ Reference diagram (rear panel) En 125 Trademarks Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. “HDMI,” the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks, or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC. x.v.Color™ “x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation. Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent Nos: 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872; 7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS-HD, the Symbol, & DTS-HD and the Symbol together are registered trademarks & DTS-HD Master Audio is a trademark of DTS, Inc. Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. “Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone,” and “Made for iPad” mean that an electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod, iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards. Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless performance. AirPlay, the AirPlay logo, iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod nano, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. “SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation. DLNA™ and DLNA CERTIFIED™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of Digital Living Network Alliance. All rights reserved. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited. Windows® Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows Media Audio, Windows Media Connect and Windows Media Player are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson. This receiver supports network connections. APPENDIX ➤ Trademarks En 126 Specifications Input jacks • Analog Audio [U.S.A. and Canada models] Audio x 5 (AV 5–6, AUDIO 1–2, V-AUX) [Other models] Audio x 6 (AV 5–6, AUDIO 1–2, PHONO, V-AUX) • Digital Audio (Supported frequencies: 32 kHz to 96 kHz) Optical x 2 (AV 1, AV 4) Coaxial x 2 (AV 2–3) • Video Composite x 5 (AV 3–6, V-AUX) • Video - Dolby TrueHD - Component x 1 - Dolby Digital Plus - Composite x 1 - Dolby Digital AV OUT - DTS-HD Master Audio - Composite x 1 - DTS-HD High Resolution Audio • HDMI Output HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT 1–2) USB x 1 [Rear Panel] • Content Protection: HDCP compatible • Link Function: CEC supported HDMI • HDMI Specification: Deep Color, “x.v.Color,” Auto Lip Sync, ARC (Audio Return Channel), 3D, 4K • Video Format (Repeater Mode) (For Yamaha Accessory, Power Supply Only) - VGA NETWORK x 1 (100Base-TX) - 480i/60 Hz Output jacks • Analog Audio - Speaker Out x 9 (7 ch) (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R*1, EXTRA SP L/R*2) *1 Note: Assignment is possible [SURROUND BACK, BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)] *2 Note: Assignment is possible [ZONE2, PRESENCE] - PCM 2-ch to 8-ch (Max. 192 kHz/24-bit) • REMOTE OUT x 1 • HDMI Input USB x 1 [Front Panel] (USB2.0) - DTS • REMOTE IN x 1 • TRIGGER OUT x 1 • Other - DTS Express - DSD 6-ch Remote jacks Component x 2 (AV 1–2) HDMI x 8 (HDMI 1–7, V-AUX) • Audio Format MONITOR OUT - 576i/50 Hz - 480p/60 Hz TUNER • Analog Tuner [U.K. and Europe models] FM/AM with Radio Data System x 1 (TUNER) [Other models] FM/AM x 1 (TUNER) USB • Capable of iPod, Mass Storage Class USB Memory - 576p/50 Hz • Current Supply Capacity: 2.1 A - 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz Network - 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz - 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz • PC Client Function - 3840 x 2160p/30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz • Compatible with DLNA ver. 1.5 - 4096 x 2160p/24 Hz • AirPlay supported - Pre Out x 7 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R) • Internet Radio - Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1–2, mono) - AV OUT x 1 - AUDIO OUT x 1 - ZONE2 OUT x 1 - Headphone x 1 APPENDIX ➤ Specifications En 127 Compatible Decoding Formats • Dynamic Power (IHF) Front L/R (8/6/4/2 • Decoding Format • Channel Separation )...................................140/180/210/250 W [Except for U.S.A. and Canada models] • Damping Factor - Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus Front L/R, 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 - Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX - DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, ............................. 100 or more • Input Sensitivity / Input Impedance DTS Express PHONO (1 kHz, 100 W/8 ) - DTS, DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 [Except for U.S.A. and Canada models]............. 3.5 mV/47 k - DTS Digital Surround AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 100 W/8 • Post Decoding Format PHONO (Input Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz) ).............................. 200 mV/47 k .................................................................60 dB/55 dB or more AV 5 etc. (Input 5.1 k Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz) .................................................................60 dB/45 dB or more • Volume Control Range..............................................MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB Step.................................................................................0.5 dB • Maximum Input Signal • Tone Control Characteristics - Dolby Pro Logic PHONO (1 kHz, 0.1% THD) - Dolby Pro Logic II Music, Dolby Pro Logic II Movie, [Except for U.S.A. and Canada models].........................60 mV Bass Boost/Cut .............................±6 dB/0.5 dB Step at 50 Hz AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD, Effect On) ............................2.3 V Bass Turnover ................................................................350 Hz Dolby Pro Logic II Game - Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game REC OUT........................................................... 200 mV/1.2 k - DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema SUBWOOFER........................................................... 1 V/1.2 k Audio Section ZONE2 OUT ...................................................... 200 mV/1.2 k • Rated Output Power (2-channel driven) (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.09% THD, 8 • Headphone Jack Rated Output / Impedance ) AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 50 mV, 8 Front L/R .............................................................100 W+100 W (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 ) Center ............................................................................. 110 W Surround L/R.......................................................110 W+110 W Surround Back L/R .............................................110 W+110 W • Rated Output Power (1-channel driven) ) Center ....................................................................... 130 W/ch Surround L/R.............................................................. 130 W/ch Surround Back L/R .................................................... 130 W/ch ) Front L/R [U.K. and Europe models] ......................... 160 W/ch • Maximum Effective Output Power (JEITA, 1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 ) [China, Asia and General models] Treble Boost/Cut.......................... ±6 dB/0.5 dB Step at 20 kHz Treble Turnover ............................................................. 3.5 kHz • Filter Characteristics (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz) H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back).......12 dB/oct. L.P.F. (Subwoofer) .....................................................24 dB/oct. Video Section • Frequency Response • Video Signal Type [U.S.A., Canada, Korea and General models] ................NTSC • Total Harmonic Distortion PHONO to AUDIO OUT (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 1 V) [Other models] ....................................................................PAL [Except for U.S.A. and Canada models]............. 0.02% or less • Video Signal Type (Video Conversion)..................... NTSC/PAL AV 5 etc. to Front (Pure Direct) • Video Signal Level (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 50 W, 8 Front L/R .................................................................... 130 W/ch (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4 ) ............................. 100 mV/560 AV 5 etc. to Front (10 Hz to 100 kHz) ..........................+0/-3 dB Front L/R .............................................................110 W+110 W (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 • Output Level / Output Impedance )............................... 0.06% or less • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network) PHONO (Input Shorted 5 mV, AUDIO OUT) [Except for U.S.A. and Canada models]............ 81 dB or more AV 5 etc. (Input Shorted 250 mV, Speaker Out) ......................................................................... 100 dB or more • Residual Noise (IHF-A Network) Front L/R (Speaker Out) ..................................... 150 µV or less Composite..............................................................1 Vp-p/75 Component Y ..........................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Pb/Pr ................................................................0.7 Vp-p/75 • Video Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off) ....................................................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more • Video Signal to Noise Ratio................................ 50 dB or more • Monitor Out Frequency Response (Video Conversion Off) Component ............................................5 Hz to 60 MHz, -3 dB Front L/R .................................................................... 160 W/ch Center ........................................................................ 160 W/ch Surround L/R.............................................................. 160 W/ch Surround Back L/R .................................................... 160 W/ch APPENDIX ➤ Specifications En 128 FM Section • Standby Power Consumption HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off ........... 0.1 W (Typical) • Tuning Range [U.S.A. and Canada models] ...................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz HDMI Control On, Standby Through On (No Signals) .......................................................................... 3.0 W (Typical) [Asia and General models] .......................................87.5/87.50 MHz to 108.0/108.00 MHz [Other models].................................87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz Network Standby On ......................................... 2.0 W (Typical) • Maximum Power Consumption [Asia and General models] .............................................590 W • 50 dB Quiet Sensitivity (IHF, 1 kHz, 100% MOD.) Mono................................................................. 3 µV (20.8 dBf) • Dimensions (W x H x D) ..................... 435 x 171 x 369 mm (17-1/8” x 6-3/4” x 14-1/2”) • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF) Mono................................................................................ 71 dB • Weight ...........................................................10.8 kg (23.8 lbs) Stereo .............................................................................. 69 dB • Harmonic Distortion (IHF, 1 kHz) Mono................................................................................. 0.3% * Specifications are subject to change without notice. Stereo ............................................................................... 0.5% • Antenna Input ................................................75 unbalanced AM section • Tuning Range [U.S.A. and Canada models] ......................... 530 to 1710 kHz [Asia and General models]...... 530/531 kHz to 1710/1611 kHz [Other models]......................................... 531 kHz to 1611 kHz General • Power Supply [U.S.A. and Canada models] ......................... AC 120 V, 60 Hz [General model]............ AC 110 to 120/220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz [China model] ................................................. AC 220 V, 50 Hz [Korea model]................................................. AC 220 V, 60 Hz [Australia model] ............................................ AC 240 V, 50 Hz [U.K. and Europe models].............................. AC 230 V, 50 Hz [Asia model] ................................... AC 220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz • Power Consumption [U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................. 400 W/500 VA [Asia and General models]............................................. 300 W [Other models]................................................................ 330 W APPENDIX ➤ Specifications En 129 Index Symbols ★ key .........................................................11 Lock icon (o) ...........................................99 Numerics 2.1-channel system (Speaker placement) ............................15 2ch Stereo (Sound program) ....................47 3.1-channel system (Speaker placement) ............................15 4.1-channel system (Speaker placement) ............................15 4K signal (Video signal resolution) .........124 5.1-channel system (Speaker placement) ............................15 5ch BI-AMP (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) ........88 6.1-channel system (Speaker connection) ............................18 6.1-channel system (Speaker placement) ............................14 7.1+2-channel system (Speaker connection) ............................17 7.1+2-channel system (Speaker placement) ............................14 7.1-channel system (Speaker connection) ............................17 7.1-channel system (Speaker placement) ............................14 7ch +1ZONE (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) ........88 7ch Stereo (Sound program) ....................47 A Access control (Network device) ..............95 Action Game (Sound program) ................ 46 Adaptive DRC (Option menu) .................. 76 Adaptive DSP Level (Sound, Setup menu) ........................... 92 Adjustment (Lipsync, Setup menu) .......... 91 ADVANCED SETUP menu ...................... 102 ADVANCED SETUP menu item list ........ 102 Adventure (Sound program) .................... 46 AirPlay ...................................................... 68 AM antenna .............................................. 30 Amp (Audio Output, Setup menu) ............ 94 ARC (Audio Return Channel) ................... 21 ARC (HDMI Control, Setup menu) ........... 94 ARC-compatible TV (Connection) ............ 21 Aspect (Video Mode, Setup menu) .......... 93 Audio Decoder (Front display) ................. 74 Audio device connection ......................... 29 Audio In (Input menu) .............................. 79 AUDIO jack .............................................. 20 AUDIO OUT jack ...................................... 31 Audio Output (HDMI, Setup menu) .......... 94 Audio Return Channel .............................. 21 Audio Signal (Information menu) ............ 101 Auto Power Down (ECO, Setup menu) .... 99 Auto Preset (FM radio) ............................. 55 Auto/Manual Select (Lipsync, Setup menu) ......................... 91 Automatic preset (FM radio) .................... 55 AV OUT jack ............................................. 31 B Banana plug ............................................. 18 Bass (Option menu) ................................. 76 Bass Cross Over (Speaker, Setup menu) ........................ 89 Battery ........................................................ 5 Bi-amp speaker connection ..................... 19 Bitrate (Audio Signal, Information menu) ....... 101 Bitstream ................................................ 124 C Cellar Club (Sound program) ................... 47 Center (Speaker, Setup menu) ................ 88 Center Image (Sound Program menu) ..... 84 Center Width (Sound Program menu) ...... 84 Chamber (Sound program) ...................... 47 CINEMA DSP ............................................ 46 CINEMA DSP 3D ...................................... 48 CINEMA DSP 3D (Option menu) .............. 76 CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (Option menu) .... 76 CLASSICAL (Sound program category) ................... 47 Clock Time (Radio Data System) ............. 53 COAXIAL jack .......................................... 20 Combination of video/audio input jacks ... 27 Component video cable ........................... 20 Component video connection (Playback device) ................................ 26 COMPONENT VIDEO jack ....................... 20 Composite AV Cable ................................ 56 Composite video connection (Playback device) ................................ 27 Compressed Music Enhancer .................. 50 Configuration (Scene function) ................ 44 Connection (Audio devices) ..................... 29 Connection (iPod) .................................... 56 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 130 Connection (NAS) .....................................30 Connection (Speaker cable) .....................18 Connection (Speaker) ...............................17 Connection (Subwoofer) ...........................18 Connection (Video devices) ......................26 Crossover frequency setting (Subwoofer) ...........................................35 D DC OUT jack .............................................10 Decode Type (Sound Program menu) ......83 Decoder Mode (Input menu) ....................79 Default Gateway ........................................95 Delay Enable (Lipsync, Setup menu) .......91 Detail (Load, Scene menu) .......................81 Device Control (Load, Scene menu) .........81 DHCP (IP Address, Setup menu) ..............95 Dialog Adjust (Option menu) ....................76 Dialog Lift (Option menu) ..........................76 Dialog Lvl (Option menu) ..........................76 Dialogue (Audio Signal, Information menu) .......101 Dialogue Adjust (Option menu) ................76 Dialogue Level (Option menu) ..................76 Dialogue Lift (Option menu) ......................76 Dialogue normalization level ...................101 Digital coaxial cable ..................................20 Digital Media Controller (DMC) .................80 Digital optical cable ..................................20 Dimension (Sound Program menu) ...........84 Dimmer (Front Display) (Display Set, Setup menu) ....................97 Direct (Sound Program menu) ..................84 Display Set (Function, Setup menu) .........97 Distance (Speaker, Setup menu) ..............90 DMC (Digital Media Controller) .................80 DMC Control (Input menu) ........................80 DNS Server .............................................. 95 Dolby Digital EX (Extended surround) ..... 77 Dolby Pro Logic (Surround decoder) ....... 49 Dolby Pro Logic II (Surround decoder) .... 49 Dolby Pro Logic IIx (Surround decoder) ............................. 49 Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie (Extended surround) ............................ 77 Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music (Extended surround) ............................ 77 Drama (Sound program) .......................... 46 DSD ........................................................ 124 DSP Level (Sound Program menu) .......... 83 DSP Program (Front display) ................... 74 DTS Neo:6 (Surround decoder) ............... 49 DTS-ES (Extended surround) ................... 77 Dynamic Range (Sound, Setup menu) .... 91 E ECO (Setup menu) ................................... 99 ECO Mode (ECO, setup menu) ................ 99 ENHANCER .............................................. 50 Enhancer (Option menu) .......................... 77 ENTERTAINMENT (Sound program category) .................. 46 Error messages (YPAO) ........................... 41 EX/ES (Extended surround) ..................... 77 EXTD Surround (Option menu) ................ 77 Extended Surround (Option menu) .......... 77 External device control (Remote control) ................................ 105 External device operation keys (Remote control) .................................. 11 External power amplifier (Connection) ..... 31 Extra Bass (Manual setup, Setup menu) ................ 89 F Firmware update (ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 104 Firmware update (on-screen) ................. 110 Firmware version (ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 104 Firmware Version (System, Information menu) ............... 101 FM antenna .............................................. 30 FM Mode (Option menu) .......................... 77 Format (Server) ........................................ 63 Format (USB storage device) ................... 60 Frequency step setting (FM/AM radio) .... 51 Front (Speaker, Setup menu) ................... 88 Front / Rear Balance (Sound Program menu) ........................ 84 Front display (Part names and functions) .................... 9 Front display information .......................... 74 Front panel (Part names and functions) ..... 8 Front Presence (Speaker, Setup menu) ... 89 Function (Setup menu) ............................. 97 G GND (Connection) .................................... 29 Ground lead ............................................. 29 H Hall in Munich (Sound program) .............. 47 Hall in Vienna (Sound program) ............... 47 HDMI (Setup menu) ................................. 93 HDMI cable .............................................. 20 HDMI connection (Playback device) ....... 26 HDMI Control .......................................... 123 HDMI Control (HDMI, Setup menu) .......... 93 HDMI Control-compatible TV (Connection) ........................................ 23 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 131 HDMI jack .................................................20 HDMI Monitor (Information menu) ...........101 HDMI OUT1 (Audio Output, Setup menu) .................94 HDMI OUT2 (Audio Output, Setup menu) .................94 HDMI output jack selection .......................43 HDMI video output (ADVANCED SETUP) ..........................103 Headphones ...............................................8 Height Balance (Sound Program menu) ...84 High definition audio ...............................124 High speed HDMI cable ...........................20 I Impedance (Speaker) ...............................13 In.Trim (Option menu) ...............................77 Indicator (Part names and functions) ..........9 INFO key ...................................................74 Information (Front display) ........................74 Information display ......................................9 Information display (Radio Data System) .............................53 Information menu ....................................100 INIT (ADVANCED SETUP) ......................103 Initial Delay (Sound Program menu) .........83 Initial setting restoration (ADVANCED SETUP) ..........................103 Initial Volume (Sound, Setup menu) ..........92 Initial Volume (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) ....97 Initialize ...................................................103 Input (Front display) ..................................74 Input menu ................................................78 Input menu item list ...................................78 Input selection keys (Remote control) ......11 Input Trim (Option menu) ..........................77 Internet radio .............................................66 IP Address ............................................... 95 IP Address (Network, Setup menu) .......... 95 iPad .......................................................... 56 iPhone ...................................................... 56 iTunes ....................................................... 68 L Language ................................................. 34 Language (Setup menu) .......................... 34 Learning (Remote control) ..................... 107 Left / Right Balance (Sound Program menu) ........................ 84 Level (Sound Program menu) .................. 84 Level (Speaker, Setup menu) ................... 90 LFE ......................................................... 120 Lip sync .................................................. 120 Lipsync (Sound, Setup menu) .................. 91 LIVE/CLUB (Sound program category) .... 47 Liveness (Sound Program menu) ............. 83 Load (Input menu) ................................... 81 Low Frequency Effects .......................... 120 M MAC Address Filter (Network, Setup menu) ........................ 95 Main Zone Set (Multi Zone, Setup menu) ..................... 96 Manual Setup (Speaker, Setup menu) ..... 88 Manual station preset (FM/AM radio) ....... 52 Mass storage class device ...................... 60 Max Volume (Sound, Setup menu) .......... 91 Max Volume (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) .... 97 Media sharing .......................................... 63 Memory Guard (Function, Setup menu) ... 99 MON.CHK (ADVANCED SETUP) ........... 103 Monaural Mix (Sound Program menu) ..... 84 Monaural reception mode (FM radio) ...... 51 Monitor check (ADVANCED SETUP) ..... 103 Mono Movie (Sound program) ................. 46 MOVIE (Sound program category) .......... 46 MOVIE THEATER (Sound program category) ................... 46 Multi measure (YPAO) .............................. 38 Multi Zone (Setup menu) .......................... 96 Multi-zone ................................................. 70 MUSIC (Sound program category) .......... 47 Music Video (Sound program) ................. 46 MUTE key ................................................. 11 Muting ...................................................... 11 N NAS (Network Attached Storage) ............ 30 NAS (Playback) ........................................ 63 Neo:6 Cinema (Surround decoder) .......... 49 Neo:6 Music (Surround decoder) ............ 49 Network (Information menu) ................... 101 Network (Setup menu) ............................. 95 Network Attached Storage ....................... 30 Network cable .......................................... 30 Network Name (Network, Setup menu) .... 96 Network Standby (Network, Setup menu) 95 NTSC (TV FORMAT, ADVANCED SETUP) ... 103 O ON SCREEN key ...................................... 11 On-screen menu ...................................... 11 OPTICAL jack ........................................... 20 OPTION key ............................................. 75 Option menu ............................................. 75 Option menu item list ............................... 75 P PAL (TV FORMAT, ADVANCED SETUP) ... 103 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 132 Panorama (Sound Program menu) ...........84 Parametric EQ (Speaker, Setup menu) .....90 PARTY (Multizone function) ......................73 Party mode ................................................73 Party Mode Set (Multi Zone, Setup menu) ......................97 PC (Connection) ........................................30 PC (Playback) ...........................................63 PHONES jack ..............................................8 PHONO jack (Connection) ........................29 Placement (Speaker) ................................13 Playback (iPod) .........................................56 Playback (NAS) .........................................63 Playback (PC) ...........................................63 Playback (USB storage device) ................60 PLII Game (Surround decoder) ................49 PLII Movie (Surround decoder) .................49 PLII Music (Surround decoder) .................49 PLIIx Game (Surround decoder) ...............49 PLIIx Movie (Extended surround) .............77 PLIIx Movie (Surround decoder) ...............49 PLIIx Music (Extended surround) .............77 PLIIx Music (Surround decoder) ...............49 PLIIxMo (Extended surround) ...................77 PLIIxMu (Extended surround) ...................77 Power Amp Assign (Manual setup, Setup menu) .................88 PRE OUT jack ...........................................31 Presence speakers (Speaker connection) ............................18 Preset (FM/AM radio) ................................52 Preset (Remote control code) .................106 Preset (TV, Remote control) ....................105 Preset stations (FM/AM radio) ...................52 Pro Logic (Surround decoder) ..................49 Program Service (Radio Data System) .....53 Program Type (Radio Data System) ........ 53 PURE DIRECT .......................................... 49 Pure Direct mode ..................................... 49 R Radio Data System (FM radio) ................. 53 Radio Text (Radio Data System) .............. 53 Rear panel (Part names and functions) ... 10 Recording device (Connection) ............... 31 Remote connection .................................. 32 Remote control (Part names and functions) .................. 11 Remote control code preset .................. 106 Remote control code preset (TV) ........... 105 Remote Control Code Search ................ 106 Remote control ID (ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 102 Remote control ID setting ...................... 102 Remote control sensor ............................... 5 Remote control signal transmitter (Remote control) .................................. 11 REMOTE ID (ADVANCED SETUP) ......... 102 Remote ID (System, Information menu) ............... 101 REMOTE IN jack ...................................... 32 REMOTE OUT jack ................................... 32 Rename (Input) ........................................ 79 Rename (Network name) ......................... 96 Rename (Scene) ...................................... 82 Rename/Icon Select (Input menu) ........... 79 Rename/Icon Select (Scene menu) ......... 82 Reset (Remote control) .......................... 109 Resolution (Video Mode, Setup menu) .... 92 Restore of the default settings (ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 103 Reverb Delay (Sound Program menu) ..... 84 Reverb Level (Sound Program menu) ...... 84 Reverb Time (Sound Program menu) ...... 83 Roleplaying Game (Sound program) ....... 46 Room Size (Sound Program menu) .......... 83 Router (Connection) ................................. 30 S Sampling (Audio Signal, Information menu) ....... 101 Save (Scene menu) .................................. 81 SCENE function ........................................ 44 Scene function ......................................... 44 Scene function configuration ................... 44 SCENE link ............................................... 32 Scene menu ............................................. 80 Scene menu item list ................................ 81 Sci-Fi (Sound program) ............................ 46 Setup menu .............................................. 85 Setup menu item list ................................. 86 Sharing setup ........................................... 63 Short Message (Display Set, Setup menu) ................... 97 SILENT CINEMA ....................................... 50 Simple play (iPod) .................................... 58 Single measure (YPAO) ........................... 37 SLEEP (Zone2) ......................................... 73 SLEEP key ................................................ 11 Sleep timer ............................................... 11 Sound (Setup menu) ................................ 91 Sound field effect ..................................... 46 Sound mode ............................................. 45 Sound program ........................................ 46 Sound program category ......................... 46 Sound Program menu .............................. 82 Sound Program menu item list ................. 83 SP IMP. (ADVANCED SETUP) .................. 16 Speaker (Setup menu) ............................. 88 Speaker connection ................................. 17 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 133 Speaker connection (Bi-amp) ...................19 Speaker impedance ..................................13 Speaker Impedance (System, Information menu) ................101 Speaker impedance setting ......................16 Speaker indicator (Front display) ................9 Speaker placement ...................................13 Spectacle (Sound program) .....................46 Sports (Sound program) ...........................46 Standard (Sound program) .......................46 Standby indicator (Front panel) ..................8 Standby Sync (HDMI Control, Setup menu) .................94 Standby Through (HDMI, Setup menu) ....94 STEREO (Sound program category) .........47 Stereo pin cable ........................................20 STP network cable ....................................30 STRAIGHT (Sound mode) .........................48 Straight decode ........................................48 Subnet Mask .............................................95 Subwoofer (Manual setup, Setup menu) .................89 Subwoofer connection ..............................18 Subwoofer Trim (Option menu) .................77 SUR.DEC (Sound mode) ...........................49 SUR.DECODE (Sound mode) ...................49 Surround (Speaker, Setup menu) .............88 Surround Back (Speaker, Setup menu) ....89 Surround Back Initial Delay (Sound Program menu) .........................83 Surround Back Liveness (Sound Program menu) .........................83 Surround Back Room Size (Sound Program menu) .........................83 Surround decoder .....................................49 Surround Initial Delay (Sound Program menu) ........................ 83 Surround Liveness (Sound Program menu) ........................ 83 Surround Room Size (Sound Program menu) ........................ 83 SW.Trim (Option menu) ............................ 77 System (Information menu) .................... 101 System ID (System, Information menu) ............... 101 T Target Zone (Trigger Output, Setup menu) .............. 98 Test Tone (Speaker, Setup menu) ........... 90 The Bottom Line (Sound program) ........... 47 The Roxy Theatre (Sound program) ......... 47 TONE CONTROL ..................................... 76 Tone Control (Option menu) .................... 76 TP (Traffic Program) ................................. 53 Traffic information .................................... 53 Traffic Program (Option menu) ................ 53 Treble (Option menu) ............................... 76 Trigger function ........................................ 32 Trigger Mode (Trigger Output, Setup menu) .............. 98 TRIGGER OUT jack .................................. 32 Trigger Output (Function, Setup menu) ... 98 TU (ADVANCED SETUP) .......................... 51 Tuning (FM/AM radio) .............................. 51 Turntable .................................................. 29 TV (Connection) ....................................... 24 TV Audio Input (HDMI Control, Setup menu) ................ 93 TV connection .......................................... 21 TV FORMAT (ADVANCED SETUP) ........ 103 TV Format (System, Information menu) ............... 101 TV operation keys (Remote control) ......... 11 TV without HDMI input jacks (Connection) ........................................ 25 U UPDATE (ADVANCED SETUP) .............. 104 Update (Firmware) ................................. 110 USB jack ..................................................... 8 USB storage device ................................. 60 V VERSION (ADVANCED SETUP) ............. 104 Video (Setup menu) ................................. 92 VIDEO AUX jacks ..................................... 29 VIDEO jack ............................................... 20 Video Mode (Option menu) ...................... 77 Video Mode (Video, Setup menu) ............ 92 Video Out (Input menu) ............................ 80 Video pin cable ........................................ 20 Video Signal (Information menu) ............ 101 Video signal type (ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 103 Video/audio input jack combination ......... 27 Virtual CINEMA DSP ................................. 48 Virtual Presence Speaker ......................... 48 VOLTAGE SELECTOR .............................. 33 Voltage selector ....................................... 33 Volume Interlock (Input menu) ................. 80 Volume Trim (Option menu) ..................... 77 VPS (Virtual Presence Speaker) ............... 48 W Wall Paper (Display Set, Setup menu) ..... 98 Warning messages (YPAO) ..................... 42 Windows Media Player ............................. 63 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 134 Y Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) ..................................35 YPAO (Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer) .............................................35 YPAO MIC jack ...........................................8 YPAO microphone ....................................35 Z Zone (Information menu) .........................101 Zone Rename (Main Zone Set, Setup menu) ...............96 Zone Rename (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) ......................97 Zone2 ........................................................70 Zone2 Set (Main Zone Set, Setup menu) ...............97 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 135 © 2012 Yamaha Corporation YE227A0/EN
1 / 1

Yamaha RX-A820 de handleiding

Categorie
AV-ontvangers
Type
de handleiding